34e77a920a
* arm.h (R_ARM_IRELATIVE): New relocation. bfd/ * reloc.c (BFD_RELOC_ARM_IRELATIVE): New relocation. * bfd-in2.h: Regenerate. * elf32-arm.c (elf32_arm_howto_table_2): Rename existing definition to elf32_arm_howto_table_3 and replace with a single R_ARM_IRELATIVE entry. (elf32_arm_howto_from_type): Update accordingly. (elf32_arm_reloc_map): Map BFD_RELOC_ARM_IRELATIVE to R_ARM_IRELATIVE. (elf32_arm_reloc_name_lookup): Handle elf32_arm_howto_table_3. (arm_plt_info): New structure, split out from elf32_arm_link_hash_entry with an extra noncall_refcount field. (arm_local_iplt_info): New structure. (elf_arm_obj_tdata): Add local_iplt. (elf32_arm_local_iplt): New accessor macro. (elf32_arm_link_hash_entry): Replace plt_thumb_refcount, plt_maybe_thumb_refcount and plt_got_offset with an arm_plt_info. Change tls_type to a bitfield and add is_iplt. (elf32_arm_link_hash_newfunc): Update accordingly. (elf32_arm_allocate_local_sym_info): New function. (elf32_arm_create_local_iplt): Likewise. (elf32_arm_get_plt_info): Likewise. (elf32_arm_plt_needs_thumb_stub_p): Likewise. (elf32_arm_get_local_dynreloc_list): Likewise. (create_ifunc_sections): Likewise. (elf32_arm_copy_indirect_symbol): Update after the changes to elf32_arm_link_hash_entry. Assert the is_iplt has not yet been set. (arm_type_of_stub): Add an st_type argument. Use elf32_arm_get_plt_info to get PLT information. Assert that all STT_GNU_IFUNC references are turned into PLT references. (arm_build_one_stub): Pass the symbol type to elf32_arm_final_link_relocate. (elf32_arm_size_stubs): Pass the symbol type to arm_type_of_stub. (elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs): New function. (elf32_arm_add_dynreloc): In static objects, use .rel.iplt for all R_ARM_IRELATIVE. (elf32_arm_allocate_plt_entry): New function. (elf32_arm_populate_plt_entry): Likewise. (elf32_arm_final_link_relocate): Add an st_type parameter. Set srelgot to null for static objects. Use separate variables to record which st_value and st_type should be used when generating a dynamic relocation. Use elf32_arm_get_plt_info to find the symbol's PLT information, setting has_iplt_entry, splt, plt_offset and gotplt_offset accordingly. Check whether STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols should resolve to an .iplt entry, and change the relocation target accordingly. Broaden assert to include .iplts. Don't set sreloc for static relocations. Assert that we only generate dynamic R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations for R_ARM_ABS32 and R_ARM_ABS32_NOI. Generate R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocations instead of R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations if the target is an STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol. Pass the symbol type to arm_type_of_stub. Conditionally resolve GOT references to the .igot.plt entry. (elf32_arm_relocate_section): Update the call to elf32_arm_final_link_relocate. (elf32_arm_gc_sweep_hook): Use elf32_arm_get_plt_info to get PLT information. Treat R_ARM_REL32 and R_ARM_REL32_NOI as call relocations in shared libraries and relocatable executables. Count non-call PLT references. Use elf32_arm_get_local_dynreloc_list to get the list of dynamic relocations for a local symbol. (elf32_arm_check_relocs): Always create ifunc sections. Set isym at the same time as setting h. Use elf32_arm_allocate_local_sym_info to allocate local symbol information. Treat R_ARM_REL32 and R_ARM_REL32_NOI as call relocations in shared libraries and relocatable executables. Record PLT information for local STT_GNU_IFUNC functions as well as global functions. Count non-call PLT references. Use elf32_arm_get_local_dynreloc_list to get the list of dynamic relocations for a local symbol. (elf32_arm_adjust_dynamic_symbol): Handle STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. Don't remove STT_GNU_IFUNC PLTs unless all references have been removed. Update after the changes to elf32_arm_link_hash_entry. (allocate_dynrelocs_for_symbol): Decide whether STT_GNU_IFUNC PLT entries should live in .plt or .iplt. Check whether the .igot.plt and .got entries can be combined. Use elf32_arm_allocate_plt_entry to allocate .plt and .(i)got.plt entries. Detect which .got entries will need R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocations and use elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs to allocate them. Likewise other non-.got dynamic relocations. (elf32_arm_size_dynamic_sections): Allocate .iplt, .igot.plt and dynamic relocations for local STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. Check whether the .igot.plt and .got entries can be combined. Detect which .got entries will need R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocations and use elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs to allocate them. Use stashed section pointers intead of strcmp checks. Handle iplt and igotplt. (elf32_arm_finish_dynamic_symbol): Use elf32_arm_populate_plt_entry to fill in .plt, .got.plt and .rel(a).plt entries. Point STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols at an .iplt entry if non-call relocations resolve to it. (elf32_arm_output_plt_map_1): New function, split out from elf32_arm_output_plt_map. Handle .iplt entries. Use elf32_arm_plt_needs_thumb_stub_p. (elf32_arm_output_plt_map): Call it. (elf32_arm_output_arch_local_syms): Add mapping symbols for local .iplt entries. (elf32_arm_swap_symbol_in): Handle Thumb STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. (elf32_arm_swap_symbol_out): Likewise. (elf32_arm_add_symbol_hook): New function. (elf_backend_add_symbol_hook): Define for all targets. opcodes/ * arm-dis.c (get_sym_code_type): Treat STT_GNU_IFUNCs as code. gas/ * config/tc-arm.c (md_pcrel_from_section): Use S_FORCE_RELOC to determine whether a relocation is needed. (md_apply_fix, arm_apply_sym_value): Likewise. ld/testsuite/ * ld-arm/ifunc-1.s, ld-arm/ifunc-1.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-1.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-1.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-2.s, ld-arm/ifunc-2.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-2.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-2.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-3.s, ld-arm/ifunc-3.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-3.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-3.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-4.s, ld-arm/ifunc-4.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-4.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-4.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-5.s, ld-arm/ifunc-5.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-5.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-5.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-6.s, ld-arm/ifunc-6.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-6.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-6.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-7.s, ld-arm/ifunc-7.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-7.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-7.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-8.s, ld-arm/ifunc-8.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-8.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-8.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-9.s, ld-arm/ifunc-9.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-9.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-9.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-10.s, ld-arm/ifunc-10.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-10.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-10.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-11.s, ld-arm/ifunc-11.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-11.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-11.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-12.s, ld-arm/ifunc-12.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-12.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-12.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-13.s, ld-arm/ifunc-13.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-13.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-13.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-14.s, ld-arm/ifunc-14.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-14.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-14.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-15.s, ld-arm/ifunc-15.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-15.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-15.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-16.s, ld-arm/ifunc-16.dd, ld-arm/ifunc-16.gd, ld-arm/ifunc-16.rd, ld-arm/ifunc-dynamic.ld, ld-arm/ifunc-static.ld: New tests. * ld-arm/farcall-group.d, ld-arm/farcall-group-size2.d, ld-arm/farcall-mixed-lib-v4t.d, ld-arm/farcall-mixed-lib.d: Update for new stub hashes. * ld-arm/arm-elf.exp: Run them.
15801 lines
471 KiB
C
15801 lines
471 KiB
C
/* 32-bit ELF support for ARM
|
|
Copyright 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
|
|
2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
|
|
|
This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
|
|
|
|
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
|
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
|
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
|
|
(at your option) any later version.
|
|
|
|
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
|
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
|
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
|
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
|
|
|
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
|
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
|
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
|
|
MA 02110-1301, USA. */
|
|
|
|
#include "sysdep.h"
|
|
#include <limits.h>
|
|
|
|
#include "bfd.h"
|
|
#include "libiberty.h"
|
|
#include "libbfd.h"
|
|
#include "elf-bfd.h"
|
|
#include "elf-vxworks.h"
|
|
#include "elf/arm.h"
|
|
|
|
/* Return the relocation section associated with NAME. HTAB is the
|
|
bfd's elf32_arm_link_hash_entry. */
|
|
#define RELOC_SECTION(HTAB, NAME) \
|
|
((HTAB)->use_rel ? ".rel" NAME : ".rela" NAME)
|
|
|
|
/* Return size of a relocation entry. HTAB is the bfd's
|
|
elf32_arm_link_hash_entry. */
|
|
#define RELOC_SIZE(HTAB) \
|
|
((HTAB)->use_rel \
|
|
? sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel) \
|
|
: sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))
|
|
|
|
/* Return function to swap relocations in. HTAB is the bfd's
|
|
elf32_arm_link_hash_entry. */
|
|
#define SWAP_RELOC_IN(HTAB) \
|
|
((HTAB)->use_rel \
|
|
? bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in \
|
|
: bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in)
|
|
|
|
/* Return function to swap relocations out. HTAB is the bfd's
|
|
elf32_arm_link_hash_entry. */
|
|
#define SWAP_RELOC_OUT(HTAB) \
|
|
((HTAB)->use_rel \
|
|
? bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out \
|
|
: bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out)
|
|
|
|
#define elf_info_to_howto 0
|
|
#define elf_info_to_howto_rel elf32_arm_info_to_howto
|
|
|
|
#define ARM_ELF_ABI_VERSION 0
|
|
#define ARM_ELF_OS_ABI_VERSION ELFOSABI_ARM
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean elf32_arm_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
|
asection *sec,
|
|
bfd_byte *contents);
|
|
|
|
/* Note: code such as elf32_arm_reloc_type_lookup expect to use e.g.
|
|
R_ARM_PC24 as an index into this, and find the R_ARM_PC24 HOWTO
|
|
in that slot. */
|
|
|
|
static reloc_howto_type elf32_arm_howto_table_1[] =
|
|
{
|
|
/* No relocation. */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_NONE, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_NONE", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_PC24, /* type */
|
|
2, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_PC24", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* 32 bit absolute */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ABS32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ABS32", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* standard 32bit pc-relative reloc */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_REL32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_REL32", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* 8 bit absolute - R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0 in AAELF */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* 16 bit absolute */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ABS16, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ABS16", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* 12 bit absolute */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ABS12, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ABS12", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_ABS5, /* type */
|
|
6, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
5, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_ABS5", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000007e0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000007e0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* 8 bit absolute */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ABS8, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
8, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ABS8", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000000ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000000ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_SBREL32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_SBREL32", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_CALL, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_CALL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x07ff07ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x07ff07ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_PC8, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
8, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_PC8", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000000ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000000ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_BREL_ADJ, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_BREL_ADJ", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_DESC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_DESC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_SWI8, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_SWI8", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000000, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000000, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* BLX instruction for the ARM. */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_XPC25, /* type */
|
|
2, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
25, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_XPC25", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* BLX instruction for the Thumb. */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_XPC22, /* type */
|
|
2, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
22, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_XPC22", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x07ff07ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x07ff07ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* Dynamic TLS relocations. */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* Relocs used in ARM Linux */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_COPY, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_COPY", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GLOB_DAT, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GLOB_DAT", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_RELATIVE, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_RELATIVE", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GOTOFF32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GOTOFF32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GOTPC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GOTPC", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GOT32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GOT32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_PLT32, /* type */
|
|
2, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_PLT32", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_CALL, /* type */
|
|
2, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_CALL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_JUMP24, /* type */
|
|
2, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_JUMP24", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_JUMP24, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_JUMP24", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x07ff2fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x07ff2fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_BASE_ABS, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_BASE_ABS", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PCREL7_0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PCREL_7_0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PCREL15_8, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
8, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PCREL_15_8",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PCREL23_15, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
16, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PCREL_23_15",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDR_SBREL_11_0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDR_SBREL_11_0",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_19_12, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
8, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
12, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_19_12",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000ff000, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000ff000, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_27_20, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
8, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
20, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_27_20",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x0ff00000, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x0ff00000, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TARGET1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TARGET1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ROSEGREL32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ROSEGREL32", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_V4BX, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_V4BX", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TARGET2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TARGET2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_PREL31, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
31, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_PREL31", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x7fffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x7fffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_MOVT_ABS, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_MOVT_ABS", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_MOVT_PREL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_MOVT_PREL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000f0fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC,/* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_JUMP19, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
19, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_JUMP19", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x043f2fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x043f2fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_JUMP6, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
6, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_unsigned,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_JUMP6", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x02f8, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x02f8, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* These are declared as 13-bit signed relocations because we can
|
|
address -4095 .. 4095(base) by altering ADDW to SUBW or vice
|
|
versa. */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0,/* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
13, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_PC12, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
13, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_PC12", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ABS32_NOI, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ABS32_NOI", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_REL32_NOI, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_REL32_NOI", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* Group relocations. */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* End of group relocations. */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_MOVT_BREL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_MOVT_BREL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_MOVW_BREL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_MOVW_BREL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x0000ffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC,/* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
16, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x040f70ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
NULL, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_CALL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_CALL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00ffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000000, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000000, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
24, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x07ff07ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x07ff07ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_PLT32_ABS, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_PLT32_ABS", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GOT_ABS, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GOT_ABS", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GOT_PREL, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont, /* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GOT_PREL", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GOT_BREL12, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GOT_BREL12", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GOTOFF12, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GOTOFF12", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (R_ARM_GOTRELAX), /* reserved for future GOT-load optimizations */
|
|
|
|
/* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont, /* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
_bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont, /* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
NULL, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_JUMP11, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
11, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed, /* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_JUMP11", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000007ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000007ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_JUMP8, /* type */
|
|
1, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
8, /* bitsize */
|
|
TRUE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_signed, /* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_JUMP8", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x000000ff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x000000ff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
TRUE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* TLS relocations */
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_GD32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
NULL, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_GD32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_LDM32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_LDM32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_LDO32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_LDO32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_IE32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
NULL, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_IE32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_LE32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_LE32", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_LDO12, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_LDO12", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_LE12, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_LE12", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_TLS_IE12GP, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
12, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_TLS_IE12GP", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000fff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
/* 112-127 private relocations. */
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (112),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (113),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (114),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (115),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (116),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (117),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (118),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (119),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (120),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (121),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (122),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (123),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (124),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (125),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (126),
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (127),
|
|
|
|
/* R_ARM_ME_TOO, obsolete. */
|
|
EMPTY_HOWTO (128),
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
1, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ",/* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0x00000000, /* src_mask */
|
|
0x00000000, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* 160 onwards: */
|
|
static reloc_howto_type elf32_arm_howto_table_2[1] =
|
|
{
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_IRELATIVE, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
2, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
32, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_bitfield,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_IRELATIVE", /* name */
|
|
TRUE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* src_mask */
|
|
0xffffffff, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE) /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* 249-255 extended, currently unused, relocations: */
|
|
static reloc_howto_type elf32_arm_howto_table_3[4] =
|
|
{
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_RREL32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_RREL32", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_RABS32, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_RABS32", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_RPC24, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_RPC24", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE), /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
|
|
HOWTO (R_ARM_RBASE, /* type */
|
|
0, /* rightshift */
|
|
0, /* size (0 = byte, 1 = short, 2 = long) */
|
|
0, /* bitsize */
|
|
FALSE, /* pc_relative */
|
|
0, /* bitpos */
|
|
complain_overflow_dont,/* complain_on_overflow */
|
|
bfd_elf_generic_reloc, /* special_function */
|
|
"R_ARM_RBASE", /* name */
|
|
FALSE, /* partial_inplace */
|
|
0, /* src_mask */
|
|
0, /* dst_mask */
|
|
FALSE) /* pcrel_offset */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static reloc_howto_type *
|
|
elf32_arm_howto_from_type (unsigned int r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
if (r_type < ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_howto_table_1))
|
|
return &elf32_arm_howto_table_1[r_type];
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_IRELATIVE)
|
|
return &elf32_arm_howto_table_2[r_type - R_ARM_IRELATIVE];
|
|
|
|
if (r_type >= R_ARM_RREL32
|
|
&& r_type < R_ARM_RREL32 + ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_howto_table_3))
|
|
return &elf32_arm_howto_table_3[r_type - R_ARM_RREL32];
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_info_to_howto (bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent * bfd_reloc,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela * elf_reloc)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int r_type;
|
|
|
|
r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_reloc->r_info);
|
|
bfd_reloc->howto = elf32_arm_howto_from_type (r_type);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct elf32_arm_reloc_map
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_reloc_code_real_type bfd_reloc_val;
|
|
unsigned char elf_reloc_val;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* All entries in this list must also be present in elf32_arm_howto_table. */
|
|
static const struct elf32_arm_reloc_map elf32_arm_reloc_map[] =
|
|
{
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_NONE, R_ARM_NONE},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_PCREL_BRANCH, R_ARM_PC24},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_PCREL_CALL, R_ARM_CALL},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_PCREL_JUMP, R_ARM_JUMP24},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_PCREL_BLX, R_ARM_XPC25},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_THUMB_PCREL_BLX, R_ARM_THM_XPC22},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_32, R_ARM_ABS32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL, R_ARM_REL32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_8, R_ARM_ABS8},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_16, R_ARM_ABS16},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_OFFSET_IMM, R_ARM_ABS12},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_THUMB_OFFSET, R_ARM_THM_ABS5},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_THUMB_PCREL_BRANCH25, R_ARM_THM_JUMP24},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_THUMB_PCREL_BRANCH23, R_ARM_THM_CALL},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_THUMB_PCREL_BRANCH12, R_ARM_THM_JUMP11},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_THUMB_PCREL_BRANCH20, R_ARM_THM_JUMP19},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_THUMB_PCREL_BRANCH9, R_ARM_THM_JUMP8},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_THUMB_PCREL_BRANCH7, R_ARM_THM_JUMP6},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_GLOB_DAT, R_ARM_GLOB_DAT},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_JUMP_SLOT, R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_RELATIVE, R_ARM_RELATIVE},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_GOTOFF, R_ARM_GOTOFF32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_GOTPC, R_ARM_GOTPC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_GOT_PREL, R_ARM_GOT_PREL},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_GOT32, R_ARM_GOT32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_PLT32, R_ARM_PLT32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TARGET1, R_ARM_TARGET1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ROSEGREL32, R_ARM_ROSEGREL32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_SBREL32, R_ARM_SBREL32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_PREL31, R_ARM_PREL31},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TARGET2, R_ARM_TARGET2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_PLT32, R_ARM_PLT32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC, R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_CALL, R_ARM_TLS_CALL},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL, R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ, R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ, R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_DESC, R_ARM_TLS_DESC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_GD32, R_ARM_TLS_GD32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_LDO32, R_ARM_TLS_LDO32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_LDM32, R_ARM_TLS_LDM32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32, R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32, R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32, R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_IE32, R_ARM_TLS_IE32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_TLS_LE32, R_ARM_TLS_LE32},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_IRELATIVE, R_ARM_IRELATIVE},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT, R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY, R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_MOVW, R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_MOVT, R_ARM_MOVT_ABS},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_MOVW_PCREL, R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_MOVT_PCREL, R_ARM_MOVT_PREL},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_THUMB_MOVW, R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_THUMB_MOVT, R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_THUMB_MOVW_PCREL, R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_THUMB_MOVT_PCREL, R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC, R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_PC_G0, R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC, R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_PC_G1, R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_PC_G2, R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDR_PC_G0, R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDR_PC_G1, R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDR_PC_G2, R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0, R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1, R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2, R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDC_PC_G0, R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDC_PC_G1, R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDC_PC_G2, R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC, R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_SB_G0, R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC, R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_SB_G1, R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_ALU_SB_G2, R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDR_SB_G0, R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDR_SB_G1, R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDR_SB_G2, R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0, R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1, R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2, R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDC_SB_G0, R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDC_SB_G1, R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_LDC_SB_G2, R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2},
|
|
{BFD_RELOC_ARM_V4BX, R_ARM_V4BX}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static reloc_howto_type *
|
|
elf32_arm_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
|
bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_reloc_map); i ++)
|
|
if (elf32_arm_reloc_map[i].bfd_reloc_val == code)
|
|
return elf32_arm_howto_from_type (elf32_arm_reloc_map[i].elf_reloc_val);
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static reloc_howto_type *
|
|
elf32_arm_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
|
const char *r_name)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_howto_table_1); i++)
|
|
if (elf32_arm_howto_table_1[i].name != NULL
|
|
&& strcasecmp (elf32_arm_howto_table_1[i].name, r_name) == 0)
|
|
return &elf32_arm_howto_table_1[i];
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_howto_table_2); i++)
|
|
if (elf32_arm_howto_table_2[i].name != NULL
|
|
&& strcasecmp (elf32_arm_howto_table_2[i].name, r_name) == 0)
|
|
return &elf32_arm_howto_table_2[i];
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_howto_table_3); i++)
|
|
if (elf32_arm_howto_table_3[i].name != NULL
|
|
&& strcasecmp (elf32_arm_howto_table_3[i].name, r_name) == 0)
|
|
return &elf32_arm_howto_table_3[i];
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_nabi_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
|
|
{
|
|
int offset;
|
|
size_t size;
|
|
|
|
switch (note->descsz)
|
|
{
|
|
default:
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
case 148: /* Linux/ARM 32-bit. */
|
|
/* pr_cursig */
|
|
elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
|
|
|
|
/* pr_pid */
|
|
elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
|
|
|
|
/* pr_reg */
|
|
offset = 72;
|
|
size = 72;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
|
|
return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
|
|
size, note->descpos + offset);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_nabi_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (note->descsz)
|
|
{
|
|
default:
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
case 124: /* Linux/ARM elf_prpsinfo. */
|
|
elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
|
|
= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 28, 16);
|
|
elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
|
|
= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 44, 80);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
|
|
onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
|
|
implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
|
|
{
|
|
char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command;
|
|
int n = strlen (command);
|
|
|
|
if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
|
|
command[n - 1] = '\0';
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM bfd_elf32_littlearm_vec
|
|
#define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-littlearm"
|
|
#define TARGET_BIG_SYM bfd_elf32_bigarm_vec
|
|
#define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-bigarm"
|
|
|
|
#define elf_backend_grok_prstatus elf32_arm_nabi_grok_prstatus
|
|
#define elf_backend_grok_psinfo elf32_arm_nabi_grok_psinfo
|
|
|
|
typedef unsigned long int insn32;
|
|
typedef unsigned short int insn16;
|
|
|
|
/* In lieu of proper flags, assume all EABIv4 or later objects are
|
|
interworkable. */
|
|
#define INTERWORK_FLAG(abfd) \
|
|
(EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags) >= EF_ARM_EABI_VER4 \
|
|
|| (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK) \
|
|
|| ((abfd)->flags & BFD_LINKER_CREATED))
|
|
|
|
/* The linker script knows the section names for placement.
|
|
The entry_names are used to do simple name mangling on the stubs.
|
|
Given a function name, and its type, the stub can be found. The
|
|
name can be changed. The only requirement is the %s be present. */
|
|
#define THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SECTION_NAME ".glue_7t"
|
|
#define THUMB2ARM_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME "__%s_from_thumb"
|
|
|
|
#define ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME ".glue_7"
|
|
#define ARM2THUMB_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME "__%s_from_arm"
|
|
|
|
#define VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SECTION_NAME ".vfp11_veneer"
|
|
#define VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_ENTRY_NAME "__vfp11_veneer_%x"
|
|
|
|
#define ARM_BX_GLUE_SECTION_NAME ".v4_bx"
|
|
#define ARM_BX_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME "__bx_r%d"
|
|
|
|
#define STUB_ENTRY_NAME "__%s_veneer"
|
|
|
|
/* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
|
|
section. */
|
|
#define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
|
|
|
|
static const unsigned long tls_trampoline [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe08e0000, /* add r0, lr, r0 */
|
|
0xe5901004, /* ldr r1, [r0,#4] */
|
|
0xe12fff11, /* bx r1 */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static const unsigned long dl_tlsdesc_lazy_trampoline [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe52d2004, /* push {r2} */
|
|
0xe59f200c, /* ldr r2, [pc, #3f - . - 8] */
|
|
0xe59f100c, /* ldr r1, [pc, #4f - . - 8] */
|
|
0xe79f2002, /* 1: ldr r2, [pc, r2] */
|
|
0xe081100f, /* 2: add r1, pc */
|
|
0xe12fff12, /* bx r2 */
|
|
0x00000014, /* 3: .word _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ - 1b - 8
|
|
+ dl_tlsdesc_lazy_resolver(GOT) */
|
|
0x00000018, /* 4: .word _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ - 2b - 8 */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
|
|
/* The first entry in a procedure linkage table looks like
|
|
this. It is set up so that any shared library function that is
|
|
called before the relocation has been set up calls the dynamic
|
|
linker first. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_plt0_entry [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe52de004, /* str lr, [sp, #-4]! */
|
|
0xe59fe010, /* ldr lr, [pc, #16] */
|
|
0xe08fe00e, /* add lr, pc, lr */
|
|
0xe5bef008, /* ldr pc, [lr, #8]! */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Subsequent entries in a procedure linkage table look like
|
|
this. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_plt_entry [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe28fc600, /* add ip, pc, #NN */
|
|
0xe28cca00, /* add ip, ip, #NN */
|
|
0xe5bcf000, /* ldr pc, [ip, #NN]! */
|
|
0x00000000, /* unused */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
/* The first entry in a procedure linkage table looks like
|
|
this. It is set up so that any shared library function that is
|
|
called before the relocation has been set up calls the dynamic
|
|
linker first. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_plt0_entry [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe52de004, /* str lr, [sp, #-4]! */
|
|
0xe59fe004, /* ldr lr, [pc, #4] */
|
|
0xe08fe00e, /* add lr, pc, lr */
|
|
0xe5bef008, /* ldr pc, [lr, #8]! */
|
|
0x00000000, /* &GOT[0] - . */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Subsequent entries in a procedure linkage table look like
|
|
this. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_plt_entry [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe28fc600, /* add ip, pc, #0xNN00000 */
|
|
0xe28cca00, /* add ip, ip, #0xNN000 */
|
|
0xe5bcf000, /* ldr pc, [ip, #0xNNN]! */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
/* The format of the first entry in the procedure linkage table
|
|
for a VxWorks executable. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe52dc008, /* str ip,[sp,#-8]! */
|
|
0xe59fc000, /* ldr ip,[pc] */
|
|
0xe59cf008, /* ldr pc,[ip,#8] */
|
|
0x00000000, /* .long _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* The format of subsequent entries in a VxWorks executable. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe59fc000, /* ldr ip,[pc] */
|
|
0xe59cf000, /* ldr pc,[ip] */
|
|
0x00000000, /* .long @got */
|
|
0xe59fc000, /* ldr ip,[pc] */
|
|
0xea000000, /* b _PLT */
|
|
0x00000000, /* .long @pltindex*sizeof(Elf32_Rela) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* The format of entries in a VxWorks shared library. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe59fc000, /* ldr ip,[pc] */
|
|
0xe79cf009, /* ldr pc,[ip,r9] */
|
|
0x00000000, /* .long @got */
|
|
0xe59fc000, /* ldr ip,[pc] */
|
|
0xe599f008, /* ldr pc,[r9,#8] */
|
|
0x00000000, /* .long @pltindex*sizeof(Elf32_Rela) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* An initial stub used if the PLT entry is referenced from Thumb code. */
|
|
#define PLT_THUMB_STUB_SIZE 4
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_plt_thumb_stub [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0x4778, /* bx pc */
|
|
0x46c0 /* nop */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* The entries in a PLT when using a DLL-based target with multiple
|
|
address spaces. */
|
|
static const bfd_vma elf32_arm_symbian_plt_entry [] =
|
|
{
|
|
0xe51ff004, /* ldr pc, [pc, #-4] */
|
|
0x00000000, /* dcd R_ARM_GLOB_DAT(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#define ARM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET ((((1 << 23) - 1) << 2) + 8)
|
|
#define ARM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET ((-((1 << 23) << 2)) + 8)
|
|
#define THM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET ((1 << 22) -2 + 4)
|
|
#define THM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET (-(1 << 22) + 4)
|
|
#define THM2_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET (((1 << 24) - 2) + 4)
|
|
#define THM2_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET (-(1 << 24) + 4)
|
|
|
|
enum stub_insn_type
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_TYPE = 1,
|
|
THUMB32_TYPE,
|
|
ARM_TYPE,
|
|
DATA_TYPE
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#define THUMB16_INSN(X) {(X), THUMB16_TYPE, R_ARM_NONE, 0}
|
|
/* A bit of a hack. A Thumb conditional branch, in which the proper condition
|
|
is inserted in arm_build_one_stub(). */
|
|
#define THUMB16_BCOND_INSN(X) {(X), THUMB16_TYPE, R_ARM_NONE, 1}
|
|
#define THUMB32_INSN(X) {(X), THUMB32_TYPE, R_ARM_NONE, 0}
|
|
#define THUMB32_B_INSN(X, Z) {(X), THUMB32_TYPE, R_ARM_THM_JUMP24, (Z)}
|
|
#define ARM_INSN(X) {(X), ARM_TYPE, R_ARM_NONE, 0}
|
|
#define ARM_REL_INSN(X, Z) {(X), ARM_TYPE, R_ARM_JUMP24, (Z)}
|
|
#define DATA_WORD(X,Y,Z) {(X), DATA_TYPE, (Y), (Z)}
|
|
|
|
typedef struct
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma data;
|
|
enum stub_insn_type type;
|
|
unsigned int r_type;
|
|
int reloc_addend;
|
|
} insn_sequence;
|
|
|
|
/* Arm/Thumb -> Arm/Thumb long branch stub. On V5T and above, use blx
|
|
to reach the stub if necessary. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_any_any[] =
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe51ff004), /* ldr pc, [pc, #-4] */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_ABS32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_ABS32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T Arm -> Thumb long branch stub. Used on V4T where blx is not
|
|
available. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb[] =
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59fc000), /* ldr ip, [pc, #0] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe12fff1c), /* bx ip */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_ABS32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_ABS32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub. Used on M-profile architectures. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0xb401), /* push {r0} */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4802), /* ldr r0, [pc, #8] */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4684), /* mov ip, r0 */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0xbc01), /* pop {r0} */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4760), /* bx ip */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0xbf00), /* nop */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_ABS32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_ABS32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub. Using the stack is not
|
|
allowed. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4778), /* bx pc */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x46c0), /* nop */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59fc000), /* ldr ip, [pc, #0] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe12fff1c), /* bx ip */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_ABS32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_ABS32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T Thumb -> ARM long branch stub. Used on V4T where blx is not
|
|
available. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4778), /* bx pc */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x46c0), /* nop */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe51ff004), /* ldr pc, [pc, #-4] */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_ABS32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_ABS32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T Thumb -> ARM short branch stub. Shorter variant of the above
|
|
one, when the destination is close enough. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4778), /* bx pc */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x46c0), /* nop */
|
|
ARM_REL_INSN(0xea000000, -8), /* b (X-8) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* ARM/Thumb -> ARM long branch stub, PIC. On V5T and above, use
|
|
blx to reach the stub if necessary. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_any_arm_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59fc000), /* ldr ip, [pc] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe08ff00c), /* add pc, pc, ip */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, -4), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X-4) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* ARM/Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub, PIC. On V5T and above, use
|
|
blx to reach the stub if necessary. We can not add into pc;
|
|
it is not guaranteed to mode switch (different in ARMv6 and
|
|
ARMv7). */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_any_thumb_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59fc004), /* ldr ip, [pc, #4] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe08fc00c), /* add ip, pc, ip */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe12fff1c), /* bx ip */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T ARM -> ARM long branch stub, PIC. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59fc004), /* ldr ip, [pc, #4] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe08fc00c), /* add ip, pc, ip */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe12fff1c), /* bx ip */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T Thumb -> ARM long branch stub, PIC. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4778), /* bx pc */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x46c0), /* nop */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59fc000), /* ldr ip, [pc, #0] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe08cf00f), /* add pc, ip, pc */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, -4), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub, PIC. Used on M-profile
|
|
architectures. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0xb401), /* push {r0} */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4802), /* ldr r0, [pc, #8] */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x46fc), /* mov ip, pc */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4484), /* add ip, r0 */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0xbc01), /* pop {r0} */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4760), /* bx ip */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, 4), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub, PIC. Using the stack is not
|
|
allowed. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4778), /* bx pc */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x46c0), /* nop */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59fc004), /* ldr ip, [pc, #4] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe08fc00c), /* add ip, pc, ip */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe12fff1c), /* bx ip */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, 0), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Thumb2/ARM -> TLS trampoline. Lowest common denominator, which is a
|
|
long PIC stub. We can use r1 as a scratch -- and cannot use ip. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_any_tls_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59f1000), /* ldr r1, [pc] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe08ff001), /* add pc, pc, r1 */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, -4), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X-4) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* V4T Thumb -> TLS trampoline. lowest common denominator, which is a
|
|
long PIC stub. We can use r1 as a scratch -- and cannot use ip. */
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_tls_pic[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x4778), /* bx pc */
|
|
THUMB16_INSN(0x46c0), /* nop */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe59f1000), /* ldr r1, [pc, #0] */
|
|
ARM_INSN(0xe081f00f), /* add pc, r1, pc */
|
|
DATA_WORD(0, R_ARM_REL32, -4), /* dcd R_ARM_REL32(X) */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Cortex-A8 erratum-workaround stubs. */
|
|
|
|
/* Stub used for conditional branches (which may be beyond +/-1MB away, so we
|
|
can't use a conditional branch to reach this stub). */
|
|
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB16_BCOND_INSN(0xd001), /* b<cond>.n true. */
|
|
THUMB32_B_INSN(0xf000b800, -4), /* b.w insn_after_original_branch. */
|
|
THUMB32_B_INSN(0xf000b800, -4) /* true: b.w original_branch_dest. */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Stub used for b.w and bl.w instructions. */
|
|
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_b[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB32_B_INSN(0xf000b800, -4) /* b.w original_branch_dest. */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl[] =
|
|
{
|
|
THUMB32_B_INSN(0xf000b800, -4) /* b.w original_branch_dest. */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Stub used for Thumb-2 blx.w instructions. We modified the original blx.w
|
|
instruction (which switches to ARM mode) to point to this stub. Jump to the
|
|
real destination using an ARM-mode branch. */
|
|
|
|
static const insn_sequence elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx[] =
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_REL_INSN(0xea000000, -8) /* b original_branch_dest. */
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Section name for stubs is the associated section name plus this
|
|
string. */
|
|
#define STUB_SUFFIX ".stub"
|
|
|
|
/* One entry per long/short branch stub defined above. */
|
|
#define DEF_STUBS \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_any_any) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_thumb_only) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_any_arm_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_any_thumb_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_thumb_only_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_any_tls_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_tls_pic) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_b_cond) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_b) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_bl) \
|
|
DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_blx)
|
|
|
|
#define DEF_STUB(x) arm_stub_##x,
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type {
|
|
arm_stub_none,
|
|
DEF_STUBS
|
|
/* Note the first a8_veneer type */
|
|
arm_stub_a8_veneer_lwm = arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond
|
|
};
|
|
#undef DEF_STUB
|
|
|
|
typedef struct
|
|
{
|
|
const insn_sequence* template_sequence;
|
|
int template_size;
|
|
} stub_def;
|
|
|
|
#define DEF_STUB(x) {elf32_arm_stub_##x, ARRAY_SIZE(elf32_arm_stub_##x)},
|
|
static const stub_def stub_definitions[] = {
|
|
{NULL, 0},
|
|
DEF_STUBS
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry
|
|
{
|
|
/* Base hash table entry structure. */
|
|
struct bfd_hash_entry root;
|
|
|
|
/* The stub section. */
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
|
|
/* Offset within stub_sec of the beginning of this stub. */
|
|
bfd_vma stub_offset;
|
|
|
|
/* Given the symbol's value and its section we can determine its final
|
|
value when building the stubs (so the stub knows where to jump). */
|
|
bfd_vma target_value;
|
|
asection *target_section;
|
|
|
|
/* Offset to apply to relocation referencing target_value. */
|
|
bfd_vma target_addend;
|
|
|
|
/* The instruction which caused this stub to be generated (only valid for
|
|
Cortex-A8 erratum workaround stubs at present). */
|
|
unsigned long orig_insn;
|
|
|
|
/* The stub type. */
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type;
|
|
/* Its encoding size in bytes. */
|
|
int stub_size;
|
|
/* Its template. */
|
|
const insn_sequence *stub_template;
|
|
/* The size of the template (number of entries). */
|
|
int stub_template_size;
|
|
|
|
/* The symbol table entry, if any, that this was derived from. */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *h;
|
|
|
|
/* Type of branch. */
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type branch_type;
|
|
|
|
/* Where this stub is being called from, or, in the case of combined
|
|
stub sections, the first input section in the group. */
|
|
asection *id_sec;
|
|
|
|
/* The name for the local symbol at the start of this stub. The
|
|
stub name in the hash table has to be unique; this does not, so
|
|
it can be friendlier. */
|
|
char *output_name;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Used to build a map of a section. This is required for mixed-endian
|
|
code/data. */
|
|
|
|
typedef struct elf32_elf_section_map
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma vma;
|
|
char type;
|
|
}
|
|
elf32_arm_section_map;
|
|
|
|
/* Information about a VFP11 erratum veneer, or a branch to such a veneer. */
|
|
|
|
typedef enum
|
|
{
|
|
VFP11_ERRATUM_BRANCH_TO_ARM_VENEER,
|
|
VFP11_ERRATUM_BRANCH_TO_THUMB_VENEER,
|
|
VFP11_ERRATUM_ARM_VENEER,
|
|
VFP11_ERRATUM_THUMB_VENEER
|
|
}
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_type;
|
|
|
|
typedef struct elf32_vfp11_erratum_list
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *next;
|
|
bfd_vma vma;
|
|
union
|
|
{
|
|
struct
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *veneer;
|
|
unsigned int vfp_insn;
|
|
} b;
|
|
struct
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *branch;
|
|
unsigned int id;
|
|
} v;
|
|
} u;
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_type type;
|
|
}
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_list;
|
|
|
|
typedef enum
|
|
{
|
|
DELETE_EXIDX_ENTRY,
|
|
INSERT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND_AT_END
|
|
}
|
|
arm_unwind_edit_type;
|
|
|
|
/* A (sorted) list of edits to apply to an unwind table. */
|
|
typedef struct arm_unwind_table_edit
|
|
{
|
|
arm_unwind_edit_type type;
|
|
/* Note: we sometimes want to insert an unwind entry corresponding to a
|
|
section different from the one we're currently writing out, so record the
|
|
(text) section this edit relates to here. */
|
|
asection *linked_section;
|
|
unsigned int index;
|
|
struct arm_unwind_table_edit *next;
|
|
}
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit;
|
|
|
|
typedef struct _arm_elf_section_data
|
|
{
|
|
/* Information about mapping symbols. */
|
|
struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
|
|
unsigned int mapcount;
|
|
unsigned int mapsize;
|
|
elf32_arm_section_map *map;
|
|
/* Information about CPU errata. */
|
|
unsigned int erratumcount;
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *erratumlist;
|
|
/* Information about unwind tables. */
|
|
union
|
|
{
|
|
/* Unwind info attached to a text section. */
|
|
struct
|
|
{
|
|
asection *arm_exidx_sec;
|
|
} text;
|
|
|
|
/* Unwind info attached to an .ARM.exidx section. */
|
|
struct
|
|
{
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit *unwind_edit_list;
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit *unwind_edit_tail;
|
|
} exidx;
|
|
} u;
|
|
}
|
|
_arm_elf_section_data;
|
|
|
|
#define elf32_arm_section_data(sec) \
|
|
((_arm_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
|
|
|
|
/* A fix which might be required for Cortex-A8 Thumb-2 branch/TLB erratum.
|
|
These fixes are subject to a relaxation procedure (in elf32_arm_size_stubs),
|
|
so may be created multiple times: we use an array of these entries whilst
|
|
relaxing which we can refresh easily, then create stubs for each potentially
|
|
erratum-triggering instruction once we've settled on a solution. */
|
|
|
|
struct a8_erratum_fix {
|
|
bfd *input_bfd;
|
|
asection *section;
|
|
bfd_vma offset;
|
|
bfd_vma addend;
|
|
unsigned long orig_insn;
|
|
char *stub_name;
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type;
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type branch_type;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* A table of relocs applied to branches which might trigger Cortex-A8
|
|
erratum. */
|
|
|
|
struct a8_erratum_reloc {
|
|
bfd_vma from;
|
|
bfd_vma destination;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *hash;
|
|
const char *sym_name;
|
|
unsigned int r_type;
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type branch_type;
|
|
bfd_boolean non_a8_stub;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* The size of the thread control block. */
|
|
#define TCB_SIZE 8
|
|
|
|
/* ARM-specific information about a PLT entry, over and above the usual
|
|
gotplt_union. */
|
|
struct arm_plt_info {
|
|
/* We reference count Thumb references to a PLT entry separately,
|
|
so that we can emit the Thumb trampoline only if needed. */
|
|
bfd_signed_vma thumb_refcount;
|
|
|
|
/* Some references from Thumb code may be eliminated by BL->BLX
|
|
conversion, so record them separately. */
|
|
bfd_signed_vma maybe_thumb_refcount;
|
|
|
|
/* How many of the recorded PLT accesses were from non-call relocations.
|
|
This information is useful when deciding whether anything takes the
|
|
address of an STT_GNU_IFUNC PLT. A value of 0 means that all
|
|
non-call references to the function should resolve directly to the
|
|
real runtime target. */
|
|
unsigned int noncall_refcount;
|
|
|
|
/* Since PLT entries have variable size if the Thumb prologue is
|
|
used, we need to record the index into .got.plt instead of
|
|
recomputing it from the PLT offset. */
|
|
bfd_signed_vma got_offset;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Information about an .iplt entry for a local STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol. */
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info {
|
|
/* The information that is usually found in the generic ELF part of
|
|
the hash table entry. */
|
|
union gotplt_union root;
|
|
|
|
/* The information that is usually found in the ARM-specific part of
|
|
the hash table entry. */
|
|
struct arm_plt_info arm;
|
|
|
|
/* A list of all potential dynamic relocations against this symbol. */
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
struct elf_arm_obj_tdata
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_obj_tdata root;
|
|
|
|
/* tls_type for each local got entry. */
|
|
char *local_got_tls_type;
|
|
|
|
/* GOTPLT entries for TLS descriptors. */
|
|
bfd_vma *local_tlsdesc_gotent;
|
|
|
|
/* Information for local symbols that need entries in .iplt. */
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info **local_iplt;
|
|
|
|
/* Zero to warn when linking objects with incompatible enum sizes. */
|
|
int no_enum_size_warning;
|
|
|
|
/* Zero to warn when linking objects with incompatible wchar_t sizes. */
|
|
int no_wchar_size_warning;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#define elf_arm_tdata(bfd) \
|
|
((struct elf_arm_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
|
|
|
|
#define elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type(bfd) \
|
|
(elf_arm_tdata (bfd)->local_got_tls_type)
|
|
|
|
#define elf32_arm_local_tlsdesc_gotent(bfd) \
|
|
(elf_arm_tdata (bfd)->local_tlsdesc_gotent)
|
|
|
|
#define elf32_arm_local_iplt(bfd) \
|
|
(elf_arm_tdata (bfd)->local_iplt)
|
|
|
|
#define is_arm_elf(bfd) \
|
|
(bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
|
|
&& elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
|
|
&& elf_object_id (bfd) == ARM_ELF_DATA)
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_arm_obj_tdata),
|
|
ARM_ELF_DATA);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#define elf32_arm_hash_entry(ent) ((struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *)(ent))
|
|
|
|
/* Arm ELF linker hash entry. */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
|
|
|
|
/* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
|
|
|
|
/* ARM-specific PLT information. */
|
|
struct arm_plt_info plt;
|
|
|
|
#define GOT_UNKNOWN 0
|
|
#define GOT_NORMAL 1
|
|
#define GOT_TLS_GD 2
|
|
#define GOT_TLS_IE 4
|
|
#define GOT_TLS_GDESC 8
|
|
#define GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P(type) ((type & GOT_TLS_GD) || (type & GOT_TLS_GDESC))
|
|
unsigned int tls_type : 8;
|
|
|
|
/* True if the symbol's PLT entry is in .iplt rather than .plt. */
|
|
unsigned int is_iplt : 1;
|
|
|
|
unsigned int unused : 23;
|
|
|
|
/* Offset of the GOTPLT entry reserved for the TLS descriptor,
|
|
starting at the end of the jump table. */
|
|
bfd_vma tlsdesc_got;
|
|
|
|
/* The symbol marking the real symbol location for exported thumb
|
|
symbols with Arm stubs. */
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *export_glue;
|
|
|
|
/* A pointer to the most recently used stub hash entry against this
|
|
symbol. */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_cache;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Traverse an arm ELF linker hash table. */
|
|
#define elf32_arm_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
|
|
(elf_link_hash_traverse \
|
|
(&(table)->root, \
|
|
(bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
|
|
(info)))
|
|
|
|
/* Get the ARM elf linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
|
|
#define elf32_arm_hash_table(info) \
|
|
(elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((info)->hash)) \
|
|
== ARM_ELF_DATA ? ((struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *) ((info)->hash)) : NULL)
|
|
|
|
#define arm_stub_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
|
|
((struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *) \
|
|
bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
|
|
|
|
/* Array to keep track of which stub sections have been created, and
|
|
information on stub grouping. */
|
|
struct map_stub
|
|
{
|
|
/* This is the section to which stubs in the group will be
|
|
attached. */
|
|
asection *link_sec;
|
|
/* The stub section. */
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#define elf32_arm_compute_jump_table_size(htab) \
|
|
((htab)->next_tls_desc_index * 4)
|
|
|
|
/* ARM ELF linker hash table. */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table
|
|
{
|
|
/* The main hash table. */
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_table root;
|
|
|
|
/* The size in bytes of the section containing the Thumb-to-ARM glue. */
|
|
bfd_size_type thumb_glue_size;
|
|
|
|
/* The size in bytes of the section containing the ARM-to-Thumb glue. */
|
|
bfd_size_type arm_glue_size;
|
|
|
|
/* The size in bytes of section containing the ARMv4 BX veneers. */
|
|
bfd_size_type bx_glue_size;
|
|
|
|
/* Offsets of ARMv4 BX veneers. Bit1 set if present, and Bit0 set when
|
|
veneer has been populated. */
|
|
bfd_vma bx_glue_offset[15];
|
|
|
|
/* The size in bytes of the section containing glue for VFP11 erratum
|
|
veneers. */
|
|
bfd_size_type vfp11_erratum_glue_size;
|
|
|
|
/* A table of fix locations for Cortex-A8 Thumb-2 branch/TLB erratum. This
|
|
holds Cortex-A8 erratum fix locations between elf32_arm_size_stubs() and
|
|
elf32_arm_write_section(). */
|
|
struct a8_erratum_fix *a8_erratum_fixes;
|
|
unsigned int num_a8_erratum_fixes;
|
|
|
|
/* An arbitrary input BFD chosen to hold the glue sections. */
|
|
bfd * bfd_of_glue_owner;
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero to output a BE8 image. */
|
|
int byteswap_code;
|
|
|
|
/* Zero if R_ARM_TARGET1 means R_ARM_ABS32.
|
|
Nonzero if R_ARM_TARGET1 means R_ARM_REL32. */
|
|
int target1_is_rel;
|
|
|
|
/* The relocation to use for R_ARM_TARGET2 relocations. */
|
|
int target2_reloc;
|
|
|
|
/* 0 = Ignore R_ARM_V4BX.
|
|
1 = Convert BX to MOV PC.
|
|
2 = Generate v4 interworing stubs. */
|
|
int fix_v4bx;
|
|
|
|
/* Whether we should fix the Cortex-A8 Thumb-2 branch/TLB erratum. */
|
|
int fix_cortex_a8;
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if the ARM/Thumb BLX instructions are available for use. */
|
|
int use_blx;
|
|
|
|
/* What sort of code sequences we should look for which may trigger the
|
|
VFP11 denorm erratum. */
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_fix vfp11_fix;
|
|
|
|
/* Global counter for the number of fixes we have emitted. */
|
|
int num_vfp11_fixes;
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero to force PIC branch veneers. */
|
|
int pic_veneer;
|
|
|
|
/* The number of bytes in the initial entry in the PLT. */
|
|
bfd_size_type plt_header_size;
|
|
|
|
/* The number of bytes in the subsequent PLT etries. */
|
|
bfd_size_type plt_entry_size;
|
|
|
|
/* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
|
|
int vxworks_p;
|
|
|
|
/* True if the target system is Symbian OS. */
|
|
int symbian_p;
|
|
|
|
/* True if the target uses REL relocations. */
|
|
int use_rel;
|
|
|
|
/* The index of the next unused R_ARM_TLS_DESC slot in .rel.plt. */
|
|
bfd_vma next_tls_desc_index;
|
|
|
|
/* How many R_ARM_TLS_DESC relocations were generated so far. */
|
|
bfd_vma num_tls_desc;
|
|
|
|
/* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
|
|
asection *sdynbss;
|
|
asection *srelbss;
|
|
|
|
/* The (unloaded but important) VxWorks .rela.plt.unloaded section. */
|
|
asection *srelplt2;
|
|
|
|
/* The offset into splt of the PLT entry for the TLS descriptor
|
|
resolver. Special values are 0, if not necessary (or not found
|
|
to be necessary yet), and -1 if needed but not determined
|
|
yet. */
|
|
bfd_vma dt_tlsdesc_plt;
|
|
|
|
/* The offset into sgot of the GOT entry used by the PLT entry
|
|
above. */
|
|
bfd_vma dt_tlsdesc_got;
|
|
|
|
/* Offset in .plt section of tls_arm_trampoline. */
|
|
bfd_vma tls_trampoline;
|
|
|
|
/* Data for R_ARM_TLS_LDM32 relocations. */
|
|
union
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma refcount;
|
|
bfd_vma offset;
|
|
} tls_ldm_got;
|
|
|
|
/* Small local sym cache. */
|
|
struct sym_cache sym_cache;
|
|
|
|
/* For convenience in allocate_dynrelocs. */
|
|
bfd * obfd;
|
|
|
|
/* The amount of space used by the reserved portion of the sgotplt
|
|
section, plus whatever space is used by the jump slots. */
|
|
bfd_vma sgotplt_jump_table_size;
|
|
|
|
/* The stub hash table. */
|
|
struct bfd_hash_table stub_hash_table;
|
|
|
|
/* Linker stub bfd. */
|
|
bfd *stub_bfd;
|
|
|
|
/* Linker call-backs. */
|
|
asection * (*add_stub_section) (const char *, asection *);
|
|
void (*layout_sections_again) (void);
|
|
|
|
/* Array to keep track of which stub sections have been created, and
|
|
information on stub grouping. */
|
|
struct map_stub *stub_group;
|
|
|
|
/* Number of elements in stub_group. */
|
|
int top_id;
|
|
|
|
/* Assorted information used by elf32_arm_size_stubs. */
|
|
unsigned int bfd_count;
|
|
int top_index;
|
|
asection **input_list;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Create an entry in an ARM ELF linker hash table. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bfd_hash_entry *
|
|
elf32_arm_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry * entry,
|
|
struct bfd_hash_table * table,
|
|
const char * string)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry * ret =
|
|
(struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) entry;
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
|
|
subclass. */
|
|
if (ret == NULL)
|
|
ret = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *)
|
|
bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry));
|
|
if (ret == NULL)
|
|
return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
|
|
|
|
/* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
|
|
ret = ((struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *)
|
|
_bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
|
|
table, string));
|
|
if (ret != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
ret->dyn_relocs = NULL;
|
|
ret->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
ret->tlsdesc_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
ret->plt.thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
ret->plt.maybe_thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
ret->plt.noncall_refcount = 0;
|
|
ret->plt.got_offset = -1;
|
|
ret->is_iplt = FALSE;
|
|
ret->export_glue = NULL;
|
|
|
|
ret->stub_cache = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Ensure that we have allocated bookkeeping structures for ABFD's local
|
|
symbols. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
if (elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_size_type num_syms;
|
|
bfd_size_type size;
|
|
char *data;
|
|
|
|
num_syms = elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_info;
|
|
size = num_syms * (sizeof (bfd_signed_vma)
|
|
+ sizeof (struct arm_local_iplt_info *)
|
|
+ sizeof (bfd_vma)
|
|
+ sizeof (char));
|
|
data = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
|
|
if (data == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = (bfd_signed_vma *) data;
|
|
data += num_syms * sizeof (bfd_signed_vma);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_local_iplt (abfd) = (struct arm_local_iplt_info **) data;
|
|
data += num_syms * sizeof (struct arm_local_iplt_info *);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_local_tlsdesc_gotent (abfd) = (bfd_vma *) data;
|
|
data += num_syms * sizeof (bfd_vma);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type (abfd) = data;
|
|
}
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return the .iplt information for local symbol R_SYMNDX, which belongs
|
|
to input bfd ABFD. Create the information if it doesn't already exist.
|
|
Return null if an allocation fails. */
|
|
|
|
static struct arm_local_iplt_info *
|
|
elf32_arm_create_local_iplt (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
|
|
{
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info **ptr;
|
|
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_allocate_local_sym_info (abfd))
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (r_symndx < elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_info);
|
|
ptr = &elf32_arm_local_iplt (abfd)[r_symndx];
|
|
if (*ptr == NULL)
|
|
*ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (**ptr));
|
|
return *ptr;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Try to obtain PLT information for the symbol with index R_SYMNDX
|
|
in ABFD's symbol table. If the symbol is global, H points to its
|
|
hash table entry, otherwise H is null.
|
|
|
|
Return true if the symbol does have PLT information. When returning
|
|
true, point *ROOT_PLT at the target-independent reference count/offset
|
|
union and *ARM_PLT at the ARM-specific information. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_get_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *h,
|
|
unsigned long r_symndx, union gotplt_union **root_plt,
|
|
struct arm_plt_info **arm_plt)
|
|
{
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info *local_iplt;
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
*root_plt = &h->root.plt;
|
|
*arm_plt = &h->plt;
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (elf32_arm_local_iplt (abfd) == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
local_iplt = elf32_arm_local_iplt (abfd)[r_symndx];
|
|
if (local_iplt == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
*root_plt = &local_iplt->root;
|
|
*arm_plt = &local_iplt->arm;
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return true if the PLT described by ARM_PLT requires a Thumb stub
|
|
before it. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_plt_needs_thumb_stub_p (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
return (arm_plt->thumb_refcount != 0
|
|
|| (!htab->use_blx && arm_plt->maybe_thumb_refcount != 0));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return a pointer to the head of the dynamic reloc list that should
|
|
be used for local symbol ISYM, which is symbol number R_SYMNDX in
|
|
ABFD's symbol table. Return null if an error occurs. */
|
|
|
|
static struct elf_dyn_relocs **
|
|
elf32_arm_get_local_dynreloc_list (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *isym)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ELF32_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
{
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info *local_iplt;
|
|
|
|
local_iplt = elf32_arm_create_local_iplt (abfd, r_symndx);
|
|
if (local_iplt == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
return &local_iplt->dyn_relocs;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
|
|
We really need local syms available to do this
|
|
easily. Oh well. */
|
|
asection *s;
|
|
void *vpp;
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
|
|
if (s == NULL)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
|
|
return (struct elf_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize an entry in the stub hash table. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bfd_hash_entry *
|
|
stub_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
|
|
struct bfd_hash_table *table,
|
|
const char *string)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
|
|
subclass. */
|
|
if (entry == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
entry = (struct bfd_hash_entry *)
|
|
bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry));
|
|
if (entry == NULL)
|
|
return entry;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
|
|
entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
|
|
if (entry != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize the local fields. */
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *) entry;
|
|
eh->stub_sec = NULL;
|
|
eh->stub_offset = 0;
|
|
eh->target_value = 0;
|
|
eh->target_section = NULL;
|
|
eh->target_addend = 0;
|
|
eh->orig_insn = 0;
|
|
eh->stub_type = arm_stub_none;
|
|
eh->stub_size = 0;
|
|
eh->stub_template = NULL;
|
|
eh->stub_template_size = 0;
|
|
eh->h = NULL;
|
|
eh->id_sec = NULL;
|
|
eh->output_name = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return entry;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create .got, .gotplt, and .rel(a).got sections in DYNOBJ, and set up
|
|
shortcuts to them in our hash table. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
create_got_section (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* BPABI objects never have a GOT, or associated sections. */
|
|
if (htab->symbian_p)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (! _bfd_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create the .iplt, .rel(a).iplt and .igot.plt sections. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
create_ifunc_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
|
|
bfd *dynobj;
|
|
asection *s;
|
|
flagword flags;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
dynobj = htab->root.dynobj;
|
|
bed = get_elf_backend_data (dynobj);
|
|
flags = bed->dynamic_sec_flags;
|
|
|
|
if (htab->root.iplt == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, ".iplt",
|
|
flags | SEC_READONLY | SEC_CODE);
|
|
if (s == NULL
|
|
|| !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, bed->plt_alignment))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
htab->root.iplt = s;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->root.irelplt == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, RELOC_SECTION (htab, ".iplt"),
|
|
flags | SEC_READONLY);
|
|
if (s == NULL
|
|
|| !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, bed->s->log_file_align))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
htab->root.irelplt = s;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->root.igotplt == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, ".igot.plt", flags);
|
|
if (s == NULL
|
|
|| !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, s, bed->s->log_file_align))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
htab->root.igotplt = s;
|
|
}
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create .plt, .rel(a).plt, .got, .got.plt, .rel(a).got, .dynbss, and
|
|
.rel(a).bss sections in DYNOBJ, and set up shortcuts to them in our
|
|
hash table. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (!htab->root.sgot && !create_got_section (dynobj, info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (dynobj, info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynbss");
|
|
if (!info->shared)
|
|
htab->srelbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
|
|
RELOC_SECTION (htab, ".bss"));
|
|
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (dynobj, info, &htab->srelplt2))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (info->shared)
|
|
{
|
|
htab->plt_header_size = 0;
|
|
htab->plt_entry_size
|
|
= 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
htab->plt_header_size
|
|
= 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
|
|
htab->plt_entry_size
|
|
= 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!htab->root.splt
|
|
|| !htab->root.srelplt
|
|
|| !htab->sdynbss
|
|
|| (!info->shared && !htab->srelbss))
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
|
|
|
|
edir = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) dir;
|
|
eind = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) ind;
|
|
|
|
if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
|
|
|
|
/* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
|
|
list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
|
|
for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
|
|
|
|
for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
|
|
if (q->sec == p->sec)
|
|
{
|
|
q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
|
|
q->count += p->count;
|
|
*pp = p->next;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (q == NULL)
|
|
pp = &p->next;
|
|
}
|
|
*pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
|
|
eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ind->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Copy over PLT info. */
|
|
edir->plt.thumb_refcount += eind->plt.thumb_refcount;
|
|
eind->plt.thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
edir->plt.maybe_thumb_refcount += eind->plt.maybe_thumb_refcount;
|
|
eind->plt.maybe_thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
edir->plt.noncall_refcount += eind->plt.noncall_refcount;
|
|
eind->plt.noncall_refcount = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* We should only allocate a function to .iplt once the final
|
|
symbol information is known. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (!eind->is_iplt);
|
|
|
|
if (dir->got.refcount <= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
edir->tls_type = eind->tls_type;
|
|
eind->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
_bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Create an ARM elf linker hash table. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
|
|
elf32_arm_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *ret;
|
|
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table);
|
|
|
|
ret = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *) bfd_malloc (amt);
|
|
if (ret == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (& ret->root, abfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_link_hash_newfunc,
|
|
sizeof (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry),
|
|
ARM_ELF_DATA))
|
|
{
|
|
free (ret);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ret->sdynbss = NULL;
|
|
ret->srelbss = NULL;
|
|
ret->srelplt2 = NULL;
|
|
ret->dt_tlsdesc_plt = 0;
|
|
ret->dt_tlsdesc_got = 0;
|
|
ret->tls_trampoline = 0;
|
|
ret->next_tls_desc_index = 0;
|
|
ret->num_tls_desc = 0;
|
|
ret->thumb_glue_size = 0;
|
|
ret->arm_glue_size = 0;
|
|
ret->bx_glue_size = 0;
|
|
memset (ret->bx_glue_offset, 0, sizeof (ret->bx_glue_offset));
|
|
ret->vfp11_fix = BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_NONE;
|
|
ret->vfp11_erratum_glue_size = 0;
|
|
ret->num_vfp11_fixes = 0;
|
|
ret->fix_cortex_a8 = 0;
|
|
ret->bfd_of_glue_owner = NULL;
|
|
ret->byteswap_code = 0;
|
|
ret->target1_is_rel = 0;
|
|
ret->target2_reloc = R_ARM_NONE;
|
|
#ifdef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
ret->plt_header_size = 16;
|
|
ret->plt_entry_size = 16;
|
|
#else
|
|
ret->plt_header_size = 20;
|
|
ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
|
|
#endif
|
|
ret->fix_v4bx = 0;
|
|
ret->use_blx = 0;
|
|
ret->vxworks_p = 0;
|
|
ret->symbian_p = 0;
|
|
ret->use_rel = 1;
|
|
ret->sym_cache.abfd = NULL;
|
|
ret->obfd = abfd;
|
|
ret->tls_ldm_got.refcount = 0;
|
|
ret->stub_bfd = NULL;
|
|
ret->add_stub_section = NULL;
|
|
ret->layout_sections_again = NULL;
|
|
ret->stub_group = NULL;
|
|
ret->top_id = 0;
|
|
ret->bfd_count = 0;
|
|
ret->top_index = 0;
|
|
ret->input_list = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&ret->stub_hash_table, stub_hash_newfunc,
|
|
sizeof (struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry)))
|
|
{
|
|
free (ret);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return &ret->root.root;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Free the derived linker hash table. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_hash_table_free (struct bfd_link_hash_table *hash)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *ret
|
|
= (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *) hash;
|
|
|
|
bfd_hash_table_free (&ret->stub_hash_table);
|
|
_bfd_generic_link_hash_table_free (hash);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine if we're dealing with a Thumb only architecture. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
using_thumb_only (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals)
|
|
{
|
|
int arch = bfd_elf_get_obj_attr_int (globals->obfd, OBJ_ATTR_PROC,
|
|
Tag_CPU_arch);
|
|
int profile;
|
|
|
|
if (arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6_M || arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6S_M)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (arch != TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7 && arch != TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7E_M)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
profile = bfd_elf_get_obj_attr_int (globals->obfd, OBJ_ATTR_PROC,
|
|
Tag_CPU_arch_profile);
|
|
|
|
return profile == 'M';
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine if we're dealing with a Thumb-2 object. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
using_thumb2 (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals)
|
|
{
|
|
int arch = bfd_elf_get_obj_attr_int (globals->obfd, OBJ_ATTR_PROC,
|
|
Tag_CPU_arch);
|
|
return arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6T2 || arch >= TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine what kind of NOPs are available. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arch_has_arm_nop (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals)
|
|
{
|
|
const int arch = bfd_elf_get_obj_attr_int (globals->obfd, OBJ_ATTR_PROC,
|
|
Tag_CPU_arch);
|
|
return arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6T2
|
|
|| arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6K
|
|
|| arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7
|
|
|| arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7E_M;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arch_has_thumb2_nop (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals)
|
|
{
|
|
const int arch = bfd_elf_get_obj_attr_int (globals->obfd, OBJ_ATTR_PROC,
|
|
Tag_CPU_arch);
|
|
return (arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6T2 || arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7
|
|
|| arch == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7E_M);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arm_stub_is_thumb (enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm:
|
|
case arm_stub_short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only_pic:
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
case arm_stub_none:
|
|
BFD_FAIL ();
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine the type of stub needed, if any, for a call. */
|
|
|
|
static enum elf32_arm_stub_type
|
|
arm_type_of_stub (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
asection *input_sec,
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
|
|
unsigned char st_type,
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type *actual_branch_type,
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *hash,
|
|
bfd_vma destination,
|
|
asection *sym_sec,
|
|
bfd *input_bfd,
|
|
const char *name)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma location;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma branch_offset;
|
|
unsigned int r_type;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
int thumb2;
|
|
int thumb_only;
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type = arm_stub_none;
|
|
int use_plt = 0;
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type branch_type = *actual_branch_type;
|
|
union gotplt_union *root_plt;
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt;
|
|
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_LONG)
|
|
return stub_type;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return stub_type;
|
|
|
|
thumb_only = using_thumb_only (globals);
|
|
|
|
thumb2 = using_thumb2 (globals);
|
|
|
|
/* Determine where the call point is. */
|
|
location = (input_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ input_sec->output_section->vma
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
|
|
|
|
/* For TLS call relocs, it is the caller's responsibility to provide
|
|
the address of the appropriate trampoline. */
|
|
if (r_type != R_ARM_TLS_CALL
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL
|
|
&& elf32_arm_get_plt_info (input_bfd, hash, ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info),
|
|
&root_plt, &arm_plt)
|
|
&& root_plt->offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *splt;
|
|
|
|
if (hash == NULL || hash->is_iplt)
|
|
splt = globals->root.iplt;
|
|
else
|
|
splt = globals->root.splt;
|
|
if (splt != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
use_plt = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Note when dealing with PLT entries: the main PLT stub is in
|
|
ARM mode, so if the branch is in Thumb mode, another
|
|
Thumb->ARM stub will be inserted later just before the ARM
|
|
PLT stub. We don't take this extra distance into account
|
|
here, because if a long branch stub is needed, we'll add a
|
|
Thumb->Arm one and branch directly to the ARM PLT entry
|
|
because it avoids spreading offset corrections in several
|
|
places. */
|
|
|
|
destination = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ root_plt->offset);
|
|
st_type = STT_FUNC;
|
|
branch_type = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/* Calls to STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols should go through a PLT. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (st_type != STT_GNU_IFUNC);
|
|
|
|
branch_offset = (bfd_signed_vma)(destination - location);
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL || r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP24
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Handle cases where:
|
|
- this call goes too far (different Thumb/Thumb2 max
|
|
distance)
|
|
- it's a Thumb->Arm call and blx is not available, or it's a
|
|
Thumb->Arm branch (not bl). A stub is needed in this case,
|
|
but only if this call is not through a PLT entry. Indeed,
|
|
PLT stubs handle mode switching already.
|
|
*/
|
|
if ((!thumb2
|
|
&& (branch_offset > THM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET
|
|
|| (branch_offset < THM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)))
|
|
|| (thumb2
|
|
&& (branch_offset > THM2_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET
|
|
|| (branch_offset < THM2_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)))
|
|
|| (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM
|
|
&& (((r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL) && !globals->use_blx)
|
|
|| (r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP24))
|
|
&& !use_plt))
|
|
{
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Thumb to thumb. */
|
|
if (!thumb_only)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_type = (info->shared | globals->pic_veneer)
|
|
/* PIC stubs. */
|
|
? ((globals->use_blx
|
|
&& (r_type ==R_ARM_THM_CALL))
|
|
/* V5T and above. Stub starts with ARM code, so
|
|
we must be able to switch mode before
|
|
reaching it, which is only possible for 'bl'
|
|
(ie R_ARM_THM_CALL relocation). */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_any_thumb_pic
|
|
/* On V4T, use Thumb code only. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb_pic)
|
|
|
|
/* non-PIC stubs. */
|
|
: ((globals->use_blx
|
|
&& (r_type ==R_ARM_THM_CALL))
|
|
/* V5T and above. */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_any_any
|
|
/* V4T. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
stub_type = (info->shared | globals->pic_veneer)
|
|
/* PIC stub. */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only_pic
|
|
/* non-PIC stub. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Thumb to arm. */
|
|
if (sym_sec != NULL
|
|
&& sym_sec->owner != NULL
|
|
&& !INTERWORK_FLAG (sym_sec->owner))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%s): warning: interworking not enabled.\n"
|
|
" first occurrence: %B: Thumb call to ARM"),
|
|
sym_sec->owner, input_bfd, name);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
stub_type =
|
|
(info->shared | globals->pic_veneer)
|
|
/* PIC stubs. */
|
|
? (r_type == R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL
|
|
/* TLS PIC stubs */
|
|
? (globals->use_blx ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_tls_pic
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_tls_pic)
|
|
: ((globals->use_blx && r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
/* V5T PIC and above. */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_any_arm_pic
|
|
/* V4T PIC stub. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic))
|
|
|
|
/* non-PIC stubs. */
|
|
: ((globals->use_blx && r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
/* V5T and above. */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_any_any
|
|
/* V4T. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm);
|
|
|
|
/* Handle v4t short branches. */
|
|
if ((stub_type == arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm)
|
|
&& (branch_offset <= THM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)
|
|
&& (branch_offset >= THM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET))
|
|
stub_type = arm_stub_short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (r_type == R_ARM_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_JUMP24
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_PLT32
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_TLS_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Arm to thumb. */
|
|
|
|
if (sym_sec != NULL
|
|
&& sym_sec->owner != NULL
|
|
&& !INTERWORK_FLAG (sym_sec->owner))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%s): warning: interworking not enabled.\n"
|
|
" first occurrence: %B: ARM call to Thumb"),
|
|
sym_sec->owner, input_bfd, name);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We have an extra 2-bytes reach because of
|
|
the mode change (bit 24 (H) of BLX encoding). */
|
|
if (branch_offset > (ARM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET + 2)
|
|
|| (branch_offset < ARM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)
|
|
|| (r_type == R_ARM_CALL && !globals->use_blx)
|
|
|| (r_type == R_ARM_JUMP24)
|
|
|| (r_type == R_ARM_PLT32))
|
|
{
|
|
stub_type = (info->shared | globals->pic_veneer)
|
|
/* PIC stubs. */
|
|
? ((globals->use_blx)
|
|
/* V5T and above. */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_any_thumb_pic
|
|
/* V4T stub. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb_pic)
|
|
|
|
/* non-PIC stubs. */
|
|
: ((globals->use_blx)
|
|
/* V5T and above. */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_any_any
|
|
/* V4T. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Arm to arm. */
|
|
if (branch_offset > ARM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET
|
|
|| (branch_offset < ARM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET))
|
|
{
|
|
stub_type =
|
|
(info->shared | globals->pic_veneer)
|
|
/* PIC stubs. */
|
|
? (r_type == R_ARM_TLS_CALL
|
|
/* TLS PIC Stub */
|
|
? arm_stub_long_branch_any_tls_pic
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_any_arm_pic)
|
|
/* non-PIC stubs. */
|
|
: arm_stub_long_branch_any_any;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If a stub is needed, record the actual destination type. */
|
|
if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
|
|
*actual_branch_type = branch_type;
|
|
|
|
return stub_type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Build a name for an entry in the stub hash table. */
|
|
|
|
static char *
|
|
elf32_arm_stub_name (const asection *input_section,
|
|
const asection *sym_sec,
|
|
const struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *hash,
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
char *stub_name;
|
|
bfd_size_type len;
|
|
|
|
if (hash)
|
|
{
|
|
len = 8 + 1 + strlen (hash->root.root.root.string) + 1 + 8 + 1 + 2 + 1;
|
|
stub_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (len);
|
|
if (stub_name != NULL)
|
|
sprintf (stub_name, "%08x_%s+%x_%d",
|
|
input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
|
|
hash->root.root.root.string,
|
|
(int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff,
|
|
(int) stub_type);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
len = 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 2 + 1;
|
|
stub_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (len);
|
|
if (stub_name != NULL)
|
|
sprintf (stub_name, "%08x_%x:%x+%x_%d",
|
|
input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
|
|
sym_sec->id & 0xffffffff,
|
|
ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_ARM_TLS_CALL
|
|
|| ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL
|
|
? 0 : (int) ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info) & 0xffffffff,
|
|
(int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff,
|
|
(int) stub_type);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return stub_name;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Look up an entry in the stub hash. Stub entries are cached because
|
|
creating the stub name takes a bit of time. */
|
|
|
|
static struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *
|
|
elf32_arm_get_stub_entry (const asection *input_section,
|
|
const asection *sym_sec,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash,
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab,
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *h = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) hash;
|
|
const asection *id_sec;
|
|
|
|
if ((input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* If this input section is part of a group of sections sharing one
|
|
stub section, then use the id of the first section in the group.
|
|
Stub names need to include a section id, as there may well be
|
|
more than one stub used to reach say, printf, and we need to
|
|
distinguish between them. */
|
|
id_sec = htab->stub_group[input_section->id].link_sec;
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL && h->stub_cache != NULL
|
|
&& h->stub_cache->h == h
|
|
&& h->stub_cache->id_sec == id_sec
|
|
&& h->stub_cache->stub_type == stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_entry = h->stub_cache;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
char *stub_name;
|
|
|
|
stub_name = elf32_arm_stub_name (id_sec, sym_sec, h, rel, stub_type);
|
|
if (stub_name == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
stub_entry = arm_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
|
|
stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
h->stub_cache = stub_entry;
|
|
|
|
free (stub_name);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return stub_entry;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Find or create a stub section. Returns a pointer to the stub section, and
|
|
the section to which the stub section will be attached (in *LINK_SEC_P).
|
|
LINK_SEC_P may be NULL. */
|
|
|
|
static asection *
|
|
elf32_arm_create_or_find_stub_sec (asection **link_sec_p, asection *section,
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *link_sec;
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
|
|
link_sec = htab->stub_group[section->id].link_sec;
|
|
stub_sec = htab->stub_group[section->id].stub_sec;
|
|
if (stub_sec == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_sec = htab->stub_group[link_sec->id].stub_sec;
|
|
if (stub_sec == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
size_t namelen;
|
|
bfd_size_type len;
|
|
char *s_name;
|
|
|
|
namelen = strlen (link_sec->name);
|
|
len = namelen + sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX);
|
|
s_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (htab->stub_bfd, len);
|
|
if (s_name == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
memcpy (s_name, link_sec->name, namelen);
|
|
memcpy (s_name + namelen, STUB_SUFFIX, sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX));
|
|
stub_sec = (*htab->add_stub_section) (s_name, link_sec);
|
|
if (stub_sec == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
htab->stub_group[link_sec->id].stub_sec = stub_sec;
|
|
}
|
|
htab->stub_group[section->id].stub_sec = stub_sec;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (link_sec_p)
|
|
*link_sec_p = link_sec;
|
|
|
|
return stub_sec;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add a new stub entry to the stub hash. Not all fields of the new
|
|
stub entry are initialised. */
|
|
|
|
static struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *
|
|
elf32_arm_add_stub (const char *stub_name,
|
|
asection *section,
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *link_sec;
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
|
|
stub_sec = elf32_arm_create_or_find_stub_sec (&link_sec, section, htab);
|
|
if (stub_sec == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Enter this entry into the linker stub hash table. */
|
|
stub_entry = arm_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
|
|
TRUE, FALSE);
|
|
if (stub_entry == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%s: cannot create stub entry %s"),
|
|
section->owner,
|
|
stub_name);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
stub_entry->stub_sec = stub_sec;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_offset = 0;
|
|
stub_entry->id_sec = link_sec;
|
|
|
|
return stub_entry;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Store an Arm insn into an output section not processed by
|
|
elf32_arm_write_section. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
put_arm_insn (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * htab,
|
|
bfd * output_bfd, bfd_vma val, void * ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
if (htab->byteswap_code != bfd_little_endian (output_bfd))
|
|
bfd_putl32 (val, ptr);
|
|
else
|
|
bfd_putb32 (val, ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Store a 16-bit Thumb insn into an output section not processed by
|
|
elf32_arm_write_section. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
put_thumb_insn (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * htab,
|
|
bfd * output_bfd, bfd_vma val, void * ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
if (htab->byteswap_code != bfd_little_endian (output_bfd))
|
|
bfd_putl16 (val, ptr);
|
|
else
|
|
bfd_putb16 (val, ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If it's possible to change R_TYPE to a more efficient access
|
|
model, return the new reloc type. */
|
|
|
|
static unsigned
|
|
elf32_arm_tls_transition (struct bfd_link_info *info, int r_type,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
|
|
{
|
|
int is_local = (h == NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (info->shared || (h && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
|
|
return r_type;
|
|
|
|
/* We do not support relaxations for Old TLS models. */
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
return is_local ? R_ARM_TLS_LE32 : R_ARM_TLS_IE32;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return r_type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_reloc_status_type elf32_arm_final_link_relocate
|
|
(reloc_howto_type *, bfd *, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd_vma, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *,
|
|
const char *, unsigned char, enum arm_st_branch_type,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *, bfd_boolean *, char **);
|
|
|
|
static unsigned int
|
|
arm_stub_required_alignment (enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond:
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_b:
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl:
|
|
return 2;
|
|
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_any_any:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm:
|
|
case arm_stub_short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_any_arm_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_any_thumb_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_any_tls_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_tls_pic:
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx:
|
|
return 4;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort (); /* Should be unreachable. */
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arm_build_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry,
|
|
void * in_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
#define MAXRELOCS 2
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info;
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
bfd *stub_bfd;
|
|
bfd_byte *loc;
|
|
bfd_vma sym_value;
|
|
int template_size;
|
|
int size;
|
|
const insn_sequence *template_sequence;
|
|
int i;
|
|
int stub_reloc_idx[MAXRELOCS] = {-1, -1};
|
|
int stub_reloc_offset[MAXRELOCS] = {0, 0};
|
|
int nrelocs = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
|
|
stub_entry = (struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
|
|
info = (struct bfd_link_info *) in_arg;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
stub_sec = stub_entry->stub_sec;
|
|
|
|
if ((globals->fix_cortex_a8 < 0)
|
|
!= (arm_stub_required_alignment (stub_entry->stub_type) == 2))
|
|
/* We have to do less-strictly-aligned fixes last. */
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Make a note of the offset within the stubs for this entry. */
|
|
stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_sec->size;
|
|
loc = stub_sec->contents + stub_entry->stub_offset;
|
|
|
|
stub_bfd = stub_sec->owner;
|
|
|
|
/* This is the address of the stub destination. */
|
|
sym_value = (stub_entry->target_value
|
|
+ stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
|
|
|
|
template_sequence = stub_entry->stub_template;
|
|
template_size = stub_entry->stub_template_size;
|
|
|
|
size = 0;
|
|
for (i = 0; i < template_size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (template_sequence[i].type)
|
|
{
|
|
case THUMB16_TYPE:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma data = (bfd_vma) template_sequence[i].data;
|
|
if (template_sequence[i].reloc_addend != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We've borrowed the reloc_addend field to mean we should
|
|
insert a condition code into this (Thumb-1 branch)
|
|
instruction. See THUMB16_BCOND_INSN. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT ((data & 0xff00) == 0xd000);
|
|
data |= ((stub_entry->orig_insn >> 22) & 0xf) << 8;
|
|
}
|
|
bfd_put_16 (stub_bfd, data, loc + size);
|
|
size += 2;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case THUMB32_TYPE:
|
|
bfd_put_16 (stub_bfd,
|
|
(template_sequence[i].data >> 16) & 0xffff,
|
|
loc + size);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (stub_bfd, template_sequence[i].data & 0xffff,
|
|
loc + size + 2);
|
|
if (template_sequence[i].r_type != R_ARM_NONE)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_reloc_idx[nrelocs] = i;
|
|
stub_reloc_offset[nrelocs++] = size;
|
|
}
|
|
size += 4;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case ARM_TYPE:
|
|
bfd_put_32 (stub_bfd, template_sequence[i].data,
|
|
loc + size);
|
|
/* Handle cases where the target is encoded within the
|
|
instruction. */
|
|
if (template_sequence[i].r_type == R_ARM_JUMP24)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_reloc_idx[nrelocs] = i;
|
|
stub_reloc_offset[nrelocs++] = size;
|
|
}
|
|
size += 4;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DATA_TYPE:
|
|
bfd_put_32 (stub_bfd, template_sequence[i].data, loc + size);
|
|
stub_reloc_idx[nrelocs] = i;
|
|
stub_reloc_offset[nrelocs++] = size;
|
|
size += 4;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
BFD_FAIL ();
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
stub_sec->size += size;
|
|
|
|
/* Stub size has already been computed in arm_size_one_stub. Check
|
|
consistency. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (size == stub_entry->stub_size);
|
|
|
|
/* Destination is Thumb. Force bit 0 to 1 to reflect this. */
|
|
if (stub_entry->branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
sym_value |= 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Assume there is at least one and at most MAXRELOCS entries to relocate
|
|
in each stub. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (nrelocs != 0 && nrelocs <= MAXRELOCS);
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < nrelocs; i++)
|
|
if (template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP24
|
|
|| template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP19
|
|
|| template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL
|
|
|| template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type == R_ARM_THM_XPC22)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
|
|
bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc;
|
|
char *error_message;
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type branch_type
|
|
= (template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type != R_ARM_THM_XPC22
|
|
? ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB : ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM);
|
|
bfd_vma points_to = sym_value + stub_entry->target_addend;
|
|
|
|
rel.r_offset = stub_entry->stub_offset + stub_reloc_offset[i];
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0,
|
|
template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type);
|
|
rel.r_addend = template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].reloc_addend;
|
|
|
|
if (stub_entry->stub_type == arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond && i == 0)
|
|
/* The first relocation in the elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond[]
|
|
template should refer back to the instruction after the original
|
|
branch. */
|
|
points_to = sym_value;
|
|
|
|
/* There may be unintended consequences if this is not true. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (stub_entry->h == NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Note: _bfd_final_link_relocate doesn't handle these relocations
|
|
properly. We should probably use this function unconditionally,
|
|
rather than only for certain relocations listed in the enclosing
|
|
conditional, for the sake of consistency. */
|
|
elf32_arm_final_link_relocate (elf32_arm_howto_from_type
|
|
(template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type),
|
|
stub_bfd, info->output_bfd, stub_sec, stub_sec->contents, &rel,
|
|
points_to, info, stub_entry->target_section, "", STT_FUNC,
|
|
branch_type, (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) stub_entry->h,
|
|
&unresolved_reloc, &error_message);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
|
|
bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc;
|
|
char *error_message;
|
|
bfd_vma points_to = sym_value + stub_entry->target_addend
|
|
+ template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].reloc_addend;
|
|
|
|
rel.r_offset = stub_entry->stub_offset + stub_reloc_offset[i];
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0,
|
|
template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type);
|
|
rel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_final_link_relocate (elf32_arm_howto_from_type
|
|
(template_sequence[stub_reloc_idx[i]].r_type),
|
|
stub_bfd, info->output_bfd, stub_sec, stub_sec->contents, &rel,
|
|
points_to, info, stub_entry->target_section, "", STT_FUNC,
|
|
stub_entry->branch_type,
|
|
(struct elf_link_hash_entry *) stub_entry->h, &unresolved_reloc,
|
|
&error_message);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
#undef MAXRELOCS
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the template, template size and instruction size for a stub.
|
|
Return value is the instruction size. */
|
|
|
|
static unsigned int
|
|
find_stub_size_and_template (enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type,
|
|
const insn_sequence **stub_template,
|
|
int *stub_template_size)
|
|
{
|
|
const insn_sequence *template_sequence = NULL;
|
|
int template_size = 0, i;
|
|
unsigned int size;
|
|
|
|
template_sequence = stub_definitions[stub_type].template_sequence;
|
|
if (stub_template)
|
|
*stub_template = template_sequence;
|
|
|
|
template_size = stub_definitions[stub_type].template_size;
|
|
if (stub_template_size)
|
|
*stub_template_size = template_size;
|
|
|
|
size = 0;
|
|
for (i = 0; i < template_size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (template_sequence[i].type)
|
|
{
|
|
case THUMB16_TYPE:
|
|
size += 2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case ARM_TYPE:
|
|
case THUMB32_TYPE:
|
|
case DATA_TYPE:
|
|
size += 4;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
BFD_FAIL ();
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* As above, but don't actually build the stub. Just bump offset so
|
|
we know stub section sizes. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arm_size_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry,
|
|
void *in_arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
const insn_sequence *template_sequence;
|
|
int template_size, size;
|
|
|
|
/* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
|
|
stub_entry = (struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT((stub_entry->stub_type > arm_stub_none)
|
|
&& stub_entry->stub_type < ARRAY_SIZE(stub_definitions));
|
|
|
|
size = find_stub_size_and_template (stub_entry->stub_type, &template_sequence,
|
|
&template_size);
|
|
|
|
stub_entry->stub_size = size;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_template = template_sequence;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_template_size = template_size;
|
|
|
|
size = (size + 7) & ~7;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_sec->size += size;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* External entry points for sizing and building linker stubs. */
|
|
|
|
/* Set up various things so that we can make a list of input sections
|
|
for each output section included in the link. Returns -1 on error,
|
|
0 when no stubs will be needed, and 1 on success. */
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
elf32_arm_setup_section_lists (bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd *input_bfd;
|
|
unsigned int bfd_count;
|
|
int top_id, top_index;
|
|
asection *section;
|
|
asection **input_list, **list;
|
|
bfd_size_type amt;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
if (! is_elf_hash_table (htab))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Count the number of input BFDs and find the top input section id. */
|
|
for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds, bfd_count = 0, top_id = 0;
|
|
input_bfd != NULL;
|
|
input_bfd = input_bfd->link_next)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_count += 1;
|
|
for (section = input_bfd->sections;
|
|
section != NULL;
|
|
section = section->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (top_id < section->id)
|
|
top_id = section->id;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
htab->bfd_count = bfd_count;
|
|
|
|
amt = sizeof (struct map_stub) * (top_id + 1);
|
|
htab->stub_group = (struct map_stub *) bfd_zmalloc (amt);
|
|
if (htab->stub_group == NULL)
|
|
return -1;
|
|
htab->top_id = top_id;
|
|
|
|
/* We can't use output_bfd->section_count here to find the top output
|
|
section index as some sections may have been removed, and
|
|
_bfd_strip_section_from_output doesn't renumber the indices. */
|
|
for (section = output_bfd->sections, top_index = 0;
|
|
section != NULL;
|
|
section = section->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (top_index < section->index)
|
|
top_index = section->index;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
htab->top_index = top_index;
|
|
amt = sizeof (asection *) * (top_index + 1);
|
|
input_list = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
|
|
htab->input_list = input_list;
|
|
if (input_list == NULL)
|
|
return -1;
|
|
|
|
/* For sections we aren't interested in, mark their entries with a
|
|
value we can check later. */
|
|
list = input_list + top_index;
|
|
do
|
|
*list = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
|
|
while (list-- != input_list);
|
|
|
|
for (section = output_bfd->sections;
|
|
section != NULL;
|
|
section = section->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if ((section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
|
|
input_list[section->index] = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each input section,
|
|
in the order that input sections are linked into output sections.
|
|
Build lists of input sections to determine groupings between which
|
|
we may insert linker stubs. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
elf32_arm_next_input_section (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
asection *isec)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (isec->output_section->index <= htab->top_index)
|
|
{
|
|
asection **list = htab->input_list + isec->output_section->index;
|
|
|
|
if (*list != bfd_abs_section_ptr && (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Steal the link_sec pointer for our list. */
|
|
#define PREV_SEC(sec) (htab->stub_group[(sec)->id].link_sec)
|
|
/* This happens to make the list in reverse order,
|
|
which we reverse later. */
|
|
PREV_SEC (isec) = *list;
|
|
*list = isec;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* See whether we can group stub sections together. Grouping stub
|
|
sections may result in fewer stubs. More importantly, we need to
|
|
put all .init* and .fini* stubs at the end of the .init or
|
|
.fini output sections respectively, because glibc splits the
|
|
_init and _fini functions into multiple parts. Putting a stub in
|
|
the middle of a function is not a good idea. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
group_sections (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab,
|
|
bfd_size_type stub_group_size,
|
|
bfd_boolean stubs_always_after_branch)
|
|
{
|
|
asection **list = htab->input_list;
|
|
|
|
do
|
|
{
|
|
asection *tail = *list;
|
|
asection *head;
|
|
|
|
if (tail == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Reverse the list: we must avoid placing stubs at the
|
|
beginning of the section because the beginning of the text
|
|
section may be required for an interrupt vector in bare metal
|
|
code. */
|
|
#define NEXT_SEC PREV_SEC
|
|
head = NULL;
|
|
while (tail != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Pop from tail. */
|
|
asection *item = tail;
|
|
tail = PREV_SEC (item);
|
|
|
|
/* Push on head. */
|
|
NEXT_SEC (item) = head;
|
|
head = item;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
while (head != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *curr;
|
|
asection *next;
|
|
bfd_vma stub_group_start = head->output_offset;
|
|
bfd_vma end_of_next;
|
|
|
|
curr = head;
|
|
while (NEXT_SEC (curr) != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
next = NEXT_SEC (curr);
|
|
end_of_next = next->output_offset + next->size;
|
|
if (end_of_next - stub_group_start >= stub_group_size)
|
|
/* End of NEXT is too far from start, so stop. */
|
|
break;
|
|
/* Add NEXT to the group. */
|
|
curr = next;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* OK, the size from the start to the start of CURR is less
|
|
than stub_group_size and thus can be handled by one stub
|
|
section. (Or the head section is itself larger than
|
|
stub_group_size, in which case we may be toast.)
|
|
We should really be keeping track of the total size of
|
|
stubs added here, as stubs contribute to the final output
|
|
section size. */
|
|
do
|
|
{
|
|
next = NEXT_SEC (head);
|
|
/* Set up this stub group. */
|
|
htab->stub_group[head->id].link_sec = curr;
|
|
}
|
|
while (head != curr && (head = next) != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* But wait, there's more! Input sections up to stub_group_size
|
|
bytes after the stub section can be handled by it too. */
|
|
if (!stubs_always_after_branch)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_group_start = curr->output_offset + curr->size;
|
|
|
|
while (next != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
end_of_next = next->output_offset + next->size;
|
|
if (end_of_next - stub_group_start >= stub_group_size)
|
|
/* End of NEXT is too far from stubs, so stop. */
|
|
break;
|
|
/* Add NEXT to the stub group. */
|
|
head = next;
|
|
next = NEXT_SEC (head);
|
|
htab->stub_group[head->id].link_sec = curr;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
head = next;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
while (list++ != htab->input_list + htab->top_index);
|
|
|
|
free (htab->input_list);
|
|
#undef PREV_SEC
|
|
#undef NEXT_SEC
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Comparison function for sorting/searching relocations relating to Cortex-A8
|
|
erratum fix. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
a8_reloc_compare (const void *a, const void *b)
|
|
{
|
|
const struct a8_erratum_reloc *ra = (const struct a8_erratum_reloc *) a;
|
|
const struct a8_erratum_reloc *rb = (const struct a8_erratum_reloc *) b;
|
|
|
|
if (ra->from < rb->from)
|
|
return -1;
|
|
else if (ra->from > rb->from)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
else
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *find_thumb_glue (struct bfd_link_info *,
|
|
const char *, char **);
|
|
|
|
/* Helper function to scan code for sequences which might trigger the Cortex-A8
|
|
branch/TLB erratum. Fill in the table described by A8_FIXES_P,
|
|
NUM_A8_FIXES_P, A8_FIX_TABLE_SIZE_P. Returns true if an error occurs, false
|
|
otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
cortex_a8_erratum_scan (bfd *input_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
struct a8_erratum_fix **a8_fixes_p,
|
|
unsigned int *num_a8_fixes_p,
|
|
unsigned int *a8_fix_table_size_p,
|
|
struct a8_erratum_reloc *a8_relocs,
|
|
unsigned int num_a8_relocs,
|
|
unsigned prev_num_a8_fixes,
|
|
bfd_boolean *stub_changed_p)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *section;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
struct a8_erratum_fix *a8_fixes = *a8_fixes_p;
|
|
unsigned int num_a8_fixes = *num_a8_fixes_p;
|
|
unsigned int a8_fix_table_size = *a8_fix_table_size_p;
|
|
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
for (section = input_bfd->sections;
|
|
section != NULL;
|
|
section = section->next)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *sec_data;
|
|
unsigned int span;
|
|
bfd_vma base_vma;
|
|
|
|
if (elf_section_type (section) != SHT_PROGBITS
|
|
|| (elf_section_flags (section) & SHF_EXECINSTR) == 0
|
|
|| (section->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0
|
|
|| (section->sec_info_type == ELF_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS)
|
|
|| (section->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
base_vma = section->output_section->vma + section->output_offset;
|
|
|
|
if (elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
|
|
contents = elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr.contents;
|
|
else if (! bfd_malloc_and_get_section (input_bfd, section, &contents))
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
sec_data = elf32_arm_section_data (section);
|
|
|
|
for (span = 0; span < sec_data->mapcount; span++)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int span_start = sec_data->map[span].vma;
|
|
unsigned int span_end = (span == sec_data->mapcount - 1)
|
|
? section->size : sec_data->map[span + 1].vma;
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
|
char span_type = sec_data->map[span].type;
|
|
bfd_boolean last_was_32bit = FALSE, last_was_branch = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (span_type != 't')
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Span is entirely within a single 4KB region: skip scanning. */
|
|
if (((base_vma + span_start) & ~0xfff)
|
|
== ((base_vma + span_end) & ~0xfff))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Scan for 32-bit Thumb-2 branches which span two 4K regions, where:
|
|
|
|
* The opcode is BLX.W, BL.W, B.W, Bcc.W
|
|
* The branch target is in the same 4KB region as the
|
|
first half of the branch.
|
|
* The instruction before the branch is a 32-bit
|
|
length non-branch instruction. */
|
|
for (i = span_start; i < span_end;)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int insn = bfd_getl16 (&contents[i]);
|
|
bfd_boolean insn_32bit = FALSE, is_blx = FALSE, is_b = FALSE;
|
|
bfd_boolean is_bl = FALSE, is_bcc = FALSE, is_32bit_branch;
|
|
|
|
if ((insn & 0xe000) == 0xe000 && (insn & 0x1800) != 0x0000)
|
|
insn_32bit = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (insn_32bit)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Load the rest of the insn (in manual-friendly order). */
|
|
insn = (insn << 16) | bfd_getl16 (&contents[i + 2]);
|
|
|
|
/* Encoding T4: B<c>.W. */
|
|
is_b = (insn & 0xf800d000) == 0xf0009000;
|
|
/* Encoding T1: BL<c>.W. */
|
|
is_bl = (insn & 0xf800d000) == 0xf000d000;
|
|
/* Encoding T2: BLX<c>.W. */
|
|
is_blx = (insn & 0xf800d000) == 0xf000c000;
|
|
/* Encoding T3: B<c>.W (not permitted in IT block). */
|
|
is_bcc = (insn & 0xf800d000) == 0xf0008000
|
|
&& (insn & 0x07f00000) != 0x03800000;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
is_32bit_branch = is_b || is_bl || is_blx || is_bcc;
|
|
|
|
if (((base_vma + i) & 0xfff) == 0xffe
|
|
&& insn_32bit
|
|
&& is_32bit_branch
|
|
&& last_was_32bit
|
|
&& ! last_was_branch)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma offset = 0;
|
|
bfd_boolean force_target_arm = FALSE;
|
|
bfd_boolean force_target_thumb = FALSE;
|
|
bfd_vma target;
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type = arm_stub_none;
|
|
struct a8_erratum_reloc key, *found;
|
|
|
|
key.from = base_vma + i;
|
|
found = (struct a8_erratum_reloc *)
|
|
bsearch (&key, a8_relocs, num_a8_relocs,
|
|
sizeof (struct a8_erratum_reloc),
|
|
&a8_reloc_compare);
|
|
|
|
if (found)
|
|
{
|
|
char *error_message = NULL;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry;
|
|
bfd_boolean use_plt = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* We don't care about the error returned from this
|
|
function, only if there is glue or not. */
|
|
entry = find_thumb_glue (info, found->sym_name,
|
|
&error_message);
|
|
|
|
if (entry)
|
|
found->non_a8_stub = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Keep a simpler condition, for the sake of clarity. */
|
|
if (htab->root.splt != NULL && found->hash != NULL
|
|
&& found->hash->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
use_plt = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (found->r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (found->branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM
|
|
|| use_plt)
|
|
force_target_arm = TRUE;
|
|
else
|
|
force_target_thumb = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Check if we have an offending branch instruction. */
|
|
|
|
if (found && found->non_a8_stub)
|
|
/* We've already made a stub for this instruction, e.g.
|
|
it's a long branch or a Thumb->ARM stub. Assume that
|
|
stub will suffice to work around the A8 erratum (see
|
|
setting of always_after_branch above). */
|
|
;
|
|
else if (is_bcc)
|
|
{
|
|
offset = (insn & 0x7ff) << 1;
|
|
offset |= (insn & 0x3f0000) >> 4;
|
|
offset |= (insn & 0x2000) ? 0x40000 : 0;
|
|
offset |= (insn & 0x800) ? 0x80000 : 0;
|
|
offset |= (insn & 0x4000000) ? 0x100000 : 0;
|
|
if (offset & 0x100000)
|
|
offset |= ~ ((bfd_signed_vma) 0xfffff);
|
|
stub_type = arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (is_b || is_bl || is_blx)
|
|
{
|
|
int s = (insn & 0x4000000) != 0;
|
|
int j1 = (insn & 0x2000) != 0;
|
|
int j2 = (insn & 0x800) != 0;
|
|
int i1 = !(j1 ^ s);
|
|
int i2 = !(j2 ^ s);
|
|
|
|
offset = (insn & 0x7ff) << 1;
|
|
offset |= (insn & 0x3ff0000) >> 4;
|
|
offset |= i2 << 22;
|
|
offset |= i1 << 23;
|
|
offset |= s << 24;
|
|
if (offset & 0x1000000)
|
|
offset |= ~ ((bfd_signed_vma) 0xffffff);
|
|
|
|
if (is_blx)
|
|
offset &= ~ ((bfd_signed_vma) 3);
|
|
|
|
stub_type = is_blx ? arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx :
|
|
is_bl ? arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl : arm_stub_a8_veneer_b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma pc_for_insn = base_vma + i + 4;
|
|
|
|
/* The original instruction is a BL, but the target is
|
|
an ARM instruction. If we were not making a stub,
|
|
the BL would have been converted to a BLX. Use the
|
|
BLX stub instead in that case. */
|
|
if (htab->use_blx && force_target_arm
|
|
&& stub_type == arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_type = arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx;
|
|
is_blx = TRUE;
|
|
is_bl = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Conversely, if the original instruction was
|
|
BLX but the target is Thumb mode, use the BL
|
|
stub. */
|
|
else if (force_target_thumb
|
|
&& stub_type == arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_type = arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl;
|
|
is_blx = FALSE;
|
|
is_bl = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (is_blx)
|
|
pc_for_insn &= ~ ((bfd_vma) 3);
|
|
|
|
/* If we found a relocation, use the proper destination,
|
|
not the offset in the (unrelocated) instruction.
|
|
Note this is always done if we switched the stub type
|
|
above. */
|
|
if (found)
|
|
offset =
|
|
(bfd_signed_vma) (found->destination - pc_for_insn);
|
|
|
|
target = pc_for_insn + offset;
|
|
|
|
/* The BLX stub is ARM-mode code. Adjust the offset to
|
|
take the different PC value (+8 instead of +4) into
|
|
account. */
|
|
if (stub_type == arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx)
|
|
offset += 4;
|
|
|
|
if (((base_vma + i) & ~0xfff) == (target & ~0xfff))
|
|
{
|
|
char *stub_name = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (num_a8_fixes == a8_fix_table_size)
|
|
{
|
|
a8_fix_table_size *= 2;
|
|
a8_fixes = (struct a8_erratum_fix *)
|
|
bfd_realloc (a8_fixes,
|
|
sizeof (struct a8_erratum_fix)
|
|
* a8_fix_table_size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (num_a8_fixes < prev_num_a8_fixes)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we're doing a subsequent scan,
|
|
check if we've found the same fix as
|
|
before, and try and reuse the stub
|
|
name. */
|
|
stub_name = a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].stub_name;
|
|
if ((a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].section != section)
|
|
|| (a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].offset != i))
|
|
{
|
|
free (stub_name);
|
|
stub_name = NULL;
|
|
*stub_changed_p = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!stub_name)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (8 + 1 + 8 + 1);
|
|
if (stub_name != NULL)
|
|
sprintf (stub_name, "%x:%x", section->id, i);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].input_bfd = input_bfd;
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].section = section;
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].offset = i;
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].addend = offset;
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].orig_insn = insn;
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].stub_name = stub_name;
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].stub_type = stub_type;
|
|
a8_fixes[num_a8_fixes].branch_type =
|
|
is_blx ? ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM : ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB;
|
|
|
|
num_a8_fixes++;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
i += insn_32bit ? 4 : 2;
|
|
last_was_32bit = insn_32bit;
|
|
last_was_branch = is_32bit_branch;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr.contents == NULL)
|
|
free (contents);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
*a8_fixes_p = a8_fixes;
|
|
*num_a8_fixes_p = num_a8_fixes;
|
|
*a8_fix_table_size_p = a8_fix_table_size;
|
|
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine and set the size of the stub section for a final link.
|
|
|
|
The basic idea here is to examine all the relocations looking for
|
|
PC-relative calls to a target that is unreachable with a "bl"
|
|
instruction. */
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_size_stubs (bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
bfd *stub_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
bfd_signed_vma group_size,
|
|
asection * (*add_stub_section) (const char *, asection *),
|
|
void (*layout_sections_again) (void))
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_size_type stub_group_size;
|
|
bfd_boolean stubs_always_after_branch;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
struct a8_erratum_fix *a8_fixes = NULL;
|
|
unsigned int num_a8_fixes = 0, a8_fix_table_size = 10;
|
|
struct a8_erratum_reloc *a8_relocs = NULL;
|
|
unsigned int num_a8_relocs = 0, a8_reloc_table_size = 10, i;
|
|
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
{
|
|
a8_fixes = (struct a8_erratum_fix *)
|
|
bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct a8_erratum_fix) * a8_fix_table_size);
|
|
a8_relocs = (struct a8_erratum_reloc *)
|
|
bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct a8_erratum_reloc) * a8_reloc_table_size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Propagate mach to stub bfd, because it may not have been
|
|
finalized when we created stub_bfd. */
|
|
bfd_set_arch_mach (stub_bfd, bfd_get_arch (output_bfd),
|
|
bfd_get_mach (output_bfd));
|
|
|
|
/* Stash our params away. */
|
|
htab->stub_bfd = stub_bfd;
|
|
htab->add_stub_section = add_stub_section;
|
|
htab->layout_sections_again = layout_sections_again;
|
|
stubs_always_after_branch = group_size < 0;
|
|
|
|
/* The Cortex-A8 erratum fix depends on stubs not being in the same 4K page
|
|
as the first half of a 32-bit branch straddling two 4K pages. This is a
|
|
crude way of enforcing that. */
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
stubs_always_after_branch = 1;
|
|
|
|
if (group_size < 0)
|
|
stub_group_size = -group_size;
|
|
else
|
|
stub_group_size = group_size;
|
|
|
|
if (stub_group_size == 1)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Default values. */
|
|
/* Thumb branch range is +-4MB has to be used as the default
|
|
maximum size (a given section can contain both ARM and Thumb
|
|
code, so the worst case has to be taken into account).
|
|
|
|
This value is 24K less than that, which allows for 2025
|
|
12-byte stubs. If we exceed that, then we will fail to link.
|
|
The user will have to relink with an explicit group size
|
|
option. */
|
|
stub_group_size = 4170000;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
group_sections (htab, stub_group_size, stubs_always_after_branch);
|
|
|
|
/* If we're applying the cortex A8 fix, we need to determine the
|
|
program header size now, because we cannot change it later --
|
|
that could alter section placements. Notice the A8 erratum fix
|
|
ends up requiring the section addresses to remain unchanged
|
|
modulo the page size. That's something we cannot represent
|
|
inside BFD, and we don't want to force the section alignment to
|
|
be the page size. */
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
(*htab->layout_sections_again) ();
|
|
|
|
while (1)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd *input_bfd;
|
|
unsigned int bfd_indx;
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
bfd_boolean stub_changed = FALSE;
|
|
unsigned prev_num_a8_fixes = num_a8_fixes;
|
|
|
|
num_a8_fixes = 0;
|
|
for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds, bfd_indx = 0;
|
|
input_bfd != NULL;
|
|
input_bfd = input_bfd->link_next, bfd_indx++)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
|
asection *section;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
|
|
|
|
num_a8_relocs = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* We'll need the symbol table in a second. */
|
|
symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
|
|
if (symtab_hdr->sh_info == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Walk over each section attached to the input bfd. */
|
|
for (section = input_bfd->sections;
|
|
section != NULL;
|
|
section = section->next)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irelaend, *irela;
|
|
|
|
/* If there aren't any relocs, then there's nothing more
|
|
to do. */
|
|
if ((section->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
|
|
|| section->reloc_count == 0
|
|
|| (section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* If this section is a link-once section that will be
|
|
discarded, then don't create any stubs. */
|
|
if (section->output_section == NULL
|
|
|| section->output_section->owner != output_bfd)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the relocs. */
|
|
internal_relocs
|
|
= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (input_bfd, section, NULL,
|
|
NULL, info->keep_memory);
|
|
if (internal_relocs == NULL)
|
|
goto error_ret_free_local;
|
|
|
|
/* Now examine each relocation. */
|
|
irela = internal_relocs;
|
|
irelaend = irela + section->reloc_count;
|
|
for (; irela < irelaend; irela++)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int r_type, r_indx;
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
asection *sym_sec;
|
|
bfd_vma sym_value;
|
|
bfd_vma destination;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *hash;
|
|
const char *sym_name;
|
|
char *stub_name;
|
|
const asection *id_sec;
|
|
unsigned char st_type;
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type branch_type;
|
|
bfd_boolean created_stub = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irela->r_info);
|
|
r_indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
|
|
|
|
if (r_type >= (unsigned int) R_ARM_max)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
|
error_ret_free_internal:
|
|
if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs == NULL)
|
|
free (internal_relocs);
|
|
goto error_ret_free_local;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
hash = NULL;
|
|
if (r_indx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
|
|
hash = elf32_arm_hash_entry
|
|
(elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd)
|
|
[r_indx - symtab_hdr->sh_info]);
|
|
|
|
/* Only look for stubs on branch instructions, or
|
|
non-relaxed TLSCALL */
|
|
if ((r_type != (unsigned int) R_ARM_CALL)
|
|
&& (r_type != (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
&& (r_type != (unsigned int) R_ARM_JUMP24)
|
|
&& (r_type != (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_JUMP19)
|
|
&& (r_type != (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_XPC22)
|
|
&& (r_type != (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_JUMP24)
|
|
&& (r_type != (unsigned int) R_ARM_PLT32)
|
|
&& !((r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_TLS_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL)
|
|
&& r_type == elf32_arm_tls_transition
|
|
(info, r_type, &hash->root)
|
|
&& ((hash ? hash->tls_type
|
|
: (elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type
|
|
(input_bfd)[r_indx]))
|
|
& GOT_TLS_GDESC) != 0))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Now determine the call target, its name, value,
|
|
section. */
|
|
sym_sec = NULL;
|
|
sym_value = 0;
|
|
destination = 0;
|
|
sym_name = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_TLS_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* A non-relaxed TLS call. The target is the
|
|
plt-resident trampoline and nothing to do
|
|
with the symbol. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (htab->tls_trampoline > 0);
|
|
sym_sec = htab->root.splt;
|
|
sym_value = htab->tls_trampoline;
|
|
hash = 0;
|
|
st_type = STT_FUNC;
|
|
branch_type = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!hash)
|
|
{
|
|
/* It's a local symbol. */
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
|
|
|
|
if (local_syms == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
local_syms
|
|
= (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
|
|
if (local_syms == NULL)
|
|
local_syms
|
|
= bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
|
|
symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
|
|
NULL, NULL, NULL);
|
|
if (local_syms == NULL)
|
|
goto error_ret_free_internal;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
sym = local_syms + r_indx;
|
|
if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
|
|
sym_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
|
|
else if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
|
|
sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
|
|
else if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
|
|
sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
|
|
else
|
|
sym_sec =
|
|
bfd_section_from_elf_index (input_bfd, sym->st_shndx);
|
|
|
|
if (!sym_sec)
|
|
/* This is an undefined symbol. It can never
|
|
be resolved. */
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION)
|
|
sym_value = sym->st_value;
|
|
destination = (sym_value + irela->r_addend
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_section->vma);
|
|
st_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
|
|
branch_type = ARM_SYM_BRANCH_TYPE (sym);
|
|
sym_name
|
|
= bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
|
|
symtab_hdr->sh_link,
|
|
sym->st_name);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* It's an external symbol. */
|
|
while (hash->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
|
|| hash->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
|
hash = ((struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *)
|
|
hash->root.root.u.i.link);
|
|
|
|
if (hash->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
|
|| hash->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
|
|
{
|
|
sym_sec = hash->root.root.u.def.section;
|
|
sym_value = hash->root.root.u.def.value;
|
|
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals =
|
|
elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
|
|
/* For a destination in a shared library,
|
|
use the PLT stub as target address to
|
|
decide whether a branch stub is
|
|
needed. */
|
|
if (globals != NULL
|
|
&& globals->root.splt != NULL
|
|
&& hash != NULL
|
|
&& hash->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
sym_sec = globals->root.splt;
|
|
sym_value = hash->root.plt.offset;
|
|
if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
|
|
destination = (sym_value
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_section->vma);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
|
|
destination = (sym_value + irela->r_addend
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_section->vma);
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((hash->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
|
|
|| (hash->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
|
|
{
|
|
/* For a shared library, use the PLT stub as
|
|
target address to decide whether a long
|
|
branch stub is needed.
|
|
For absolute code, they cannot be handled. */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals =
|
|
elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
|
|
if (globals != NULL
|
|
&& globals->root.splt != NULL
|
|
&& hash != NULL
|
|
&& hash->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
sym_sec = globals->root.splt;
|
|
sym_value = hash->root.plt.offset;
|
|
if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
|
|
destination = (sym_value
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ sym_sec->output_section->vma);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
|
goto error_ret_free_internal;
|
|
}
|
|
st_type = hash->root.type;
|
|
branch_type = hash->root.target_internal;
|
|
sym_name = hash->root.root.root.string;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
do
|
|
{
|
|
/* Determine what (if any) linker stub is needed. */
|
|
stub_type = arm_type_of_stub (info, section, irela,
|
|
st_type, &branch_type,
|
|
hash, destination, sym_sec,
|
|
input_bfd, sym_name);
|
|
if (stub_type == arm_stub_none)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* Support for grouping stub sections. */
|
|
id_sec = htab->stub_group[section->id].link_sec;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the name of this stub. */
|
|
stub_name = elf32_arm_stub_name (id_sec, sym_sec, hash,
|
|
irela, stub_type);
|
|
if (!stub_name)
|
|
goto error_ret_free_internal;
|
|
|
|
/* We've either created a stub for this reloc already,
|
|
or we are about to. */
|
|
created_stub = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
stub_entry = arm_stub_hash_lookup
|
|
(&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
|
|
FALSE, FALSE);
|
|
if (stub_entry != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The proper stub has already been created. */
|
|
free (stub_name);
|
|
stub_entry->target_value = sym_value;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
stub_entry = elf32_arm_add_stub (stub_name, section,
|
|
htab);
|
|
if (stub_entry == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
free (stub_name);
|
|
goto error_ret_free_internal;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
stub_entry->target_value = sym_value;
|
|
stub_entry->target_section = sym_sec;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
|
|
stub_entry->h = hash;
|
|
stub_entry->branch_type = branch_type;
|
|
|
|
if (sym_name == NULL)
|
|
sym_name = "unnamed";
|
|
stub_entry->output_name = (char *)
|
|
bfd_alloc (htab->stub_bfd,
|
|
sizeof (THUMB2ARM_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME)
|
|
+ strlen (sym_name));
|
|
if (stub_entry->output_name == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
free (stub_name);
|
|
goto error_ret_free_internal;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* For historical reasons, use the existing names for
|
|
ARM-to-Thumb and Thumb-to-ARM stubs. */
|
|
if ((r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_JUMP24)
|
|
&& branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM)
|
|
sprintf (stub_entry->output_name,
|
|
THUMB2ARM_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME, sym_name);
|
|
else if ((r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_JUMP24)
|
|
&& branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
sprintf (stub_entry->output_name,
|
|
ARM2THUMB_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME, sym_name);
|
|
else
|
|
sprintf (stub_entry->output_name, STUB_ENTRY_NAME,
|
|
sym_name);
|
|
|
|
stub_changed = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
while (0);
|
|
|
|
/* Look for relocations which might trigger Cortex-A8
|
|
erratum. */
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8
|
|
&& (r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_JUMP24
|
|
|| r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_JUMP19
|
|
|| r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == (unsigned int) R_ARM_THM_XPC22))
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma from = section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ section->output_offset
|
|
+ irela->r_offset;
|
|
|
|
if ((from & 0xfff) == 0xffe)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Found a candidate. Note we haven't checked the
|
|
destination is within 4K here: if we do so (and
|
|
don't create an entry in a8_relocs) we can't tell
|
|
that a branch should have been relocated when
|
|
scanning later. */
|
|
if (num_a8_relocs == a8_reloc_table_size)
|
|
{
|
|
a8_reloc_table_size *= 2;
|
|
a8_relocs = (struct a8_erratum_reloc *)
|
|
bfd_realloc (a8_relocs,
|
|
sizeof (struct a8_erratum_reloc)
|
|
* a8_reloc_table_size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
a8_relocs[num_a8_relocs].from = from;
|
|
a8_relocs[num_a8_relocs].destination = destination;
|
|
a8_relocs[num_a8_relocs].r_type = r_type;
|
|
a8_relocs[num_a8_relocs].branch_type = branch_type;
|
|
a8_relocs[num_a8_relocs].sym_name = sym_name;
|
|
a8_relocs[num_a8_relocs].non_a8_stub = created_stub;
|
|
a8_relocs[num_a8_relocs].hash = hash;
|
|
|
|
num_a8_relocs++;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We're done with the internal relocs, free them. */
|
|
if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs == NULL)
|
|
free (internal_relocs);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Sort relocs which might apply to Cortex-A8 erratum. */
|
|
qsort (a8_relocs, num_a8_relocs,
|
|
sizeof (struct a8_erratum_reloc),
|
|
&a8_reloc_compare);
|
|
|
|
/* Scan for branches which might trigger Cortex-A8 erratum. */
|
|
if (cortex_a8_erratum_scan (input_bfd, info, &a8_fixes,
|
|
&num_a8_fixes, &a8_fix_table_size,
|
|
a8_relocs, num_a8_relocs,
|
|
prev_num_a8_fixes, &stub_changed)
|
|
!= 0)
|
|
goto error_ret_free_local;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (prev_num_a8_fixes != num_a8_fixes)
|
|
stub_changed = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (!stub_changed)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* OK, we've added some stubs. Find out the new size of the
|
|
stub sections. */
|
|
for (stub_sec = htab->stub_bfd->sections;
|
|
stub_sec != NULL;
|
|
stub_sec = stub_sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Ignore non-stub sections. */
|
|
if (!strstr (stub_sec->name, STUB_SUFFIX))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
stub_sec->size = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, arm_size_one_stub, htab);
|
|
|
|
/* Add Cortex-A8 erratum veneers to stub section sizes too. */
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
for (i = 0; i < num_a8_fixes; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
stub_sec = elf32_arm_create_or_find_stub_sec (NULL,
|
|
a8_fixes[i].section, htab);
|
|
|
|
if (stub_sec == NULL)
|
|
goto error_ret_free_local;
|
|
|
|
stub_sec->size
|
|
+= find_stub_size_and_template (a8_fixes[i].stub_type, NULL,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Ask the linker to do its stuff. */
|
|
(*htab->layout_sections_again) ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add stubs for Cortex-A8 erratum fixes now. */
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
{
|
|
for (i = 0; i < num_a8_fixes; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
char *stub_name = a8_fixes[i].stub_name;
|
|
asection *section = a8_fixes[i].section;
|
|
unsigned int section_id = a8_fixes[i].section->id;
|
|
asection *link_sec = htab->stub_group[section_id].link_sec;
|
|
asection *stub_sec = htab->stub_group[section_id].stub_sec;
|
|
const insn_sequence *template_sequence;
|
|
int template_size, size = 0;
|
|
|
|
stub_entry = arm_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
|
|
TRUE, FALSE);
|
|
if (stub_entry == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%s: cannot create stub entry %s"),
|
|
section->owner,
|
|
stub_name);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
stub_entry->stub_sec = stub_sec;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_offset = 0;
|
|
stub_entry->id_sec = link_sec;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_type = a8_fixes[i].stub_type;
|
|
stub_entry->target_section = a8_fixes[i].section;
|
|
stub_entry->target_value = a8_fixes[i].offset;
|
|
stub_entry->target_addend = a8_fixes[i].addend;
|
|
stub_entry->orig_insn = a8_fixes[i].orig_insn;
|
|
stub_entry->branch_type = a8_fixes[i].branch_type;
|
|
|
|
size = find_stub_size_and_template (a8_fixes[i].stub_type,
|
|
&template_sequence,
|
|
&template_size);
|
|
|
|
stub_entry->stub_size = size;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_template = template_sequence;
|
|
stub_entry->stub_template_size = template_size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Stash the Cortex-A8 erratum fix array for use later in
|
|
elf32_arm_write_section(). */
|
|
htab->a8_erratum_fixes = a8_fixes;
|
|
htab->num_a8_erratum_fixes = num_a8_fixes;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
htab->a8_erratum_fixes = NULL;
|
|
htab->num_a8_erratum_fixes = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
error_ret_free_local:
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Build all the stubs associated with the current output file. The
|
|
stubs are kept in a hash table attached to the main linker hash
|
|
table. We also set up the .plt entries for statically linked PIC
|
|
functions here. This function is called via arm_elf_finish in the
|
|
linker. */
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_build_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
struct bfd_hash_table *table;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
for (stub_sec = htab->stub_bfd->sections;
|
|
stub_sec != NULL;
|
|
stub_sec = stub_sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_size_type size;
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore non-stub sections. */
|
|
if (!strstr (stub_sec->name, STUB_SUFFIX))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate memory to hold the linker stubs. */
|
|
size = stub_sec->size;
|
|
stub_sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_zalloc (htab->stub_bfd, size);
|
|
if (stub_sec->contents == NULL && size != 0)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
stub_sec->size = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Build the stubs as directed by the stub hash table. */
|
|
table = &htab->stub_hash_table;
|
|
bfd_hash_traverse (table, arm_build_one_stub, info);
|
|
if (htab->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Place the cortex a8 stubs last. */
|
|
htab->fix_cortex_a8 = -1;
|
|
bfd_hash_traverse (table, arm_build_one_stub, info);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Locate the Thumb encoded calling stub for NAME. */
|
|
|
|
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
|
|
find_thumb_glue (struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
|
const char *name,
|
|
char **error_message)
|
|
{
|
|
char *tmp_name;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *hash_table;
|
|
|
|
/* We need a pointer to the armelf specific hash table. */
|
|
hash_table = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
if (hash_table == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
tmp_name = (char *) bfd_malloc ((bfd_size_type) strlen (name)
|
|
+ strlen (THUMB2ARM_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME) + 1);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, THUMB2ARM_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME, name);
|
|
|
|
hash = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(hash_table)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
|
|
|
if (hash == NULL
|
|
&& asprintf (error_message, _("unable to find THUMB glue '%s' for '%s'"),
|
|
tmp_name, name) == -1)
|
|
*error_message = (char *) bfd_errmsg (bfd_error_system_call);
|
|
|
|
free (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
return hash;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Locate the ARM encoded calling stub for NAME. */
|
|
|
|
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
|
|
find_arm_glue (struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
|
const char *name,
|
|
char **error_message)
|
|
{
|
|
char *tmp_name;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *myh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *hash_table;
|
|
|
|
/* We need a pointer to the elfarm specific hash table. */
|
|
hash_table = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
if (hash_table == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
tmp_name = (char *) bfd_malloc ((bfd_size_type) strlen (name)
|
|
+ strlen (ARM2THUMB_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME) + 1);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, ARM2THUMB_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME, name);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(hash_table)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
|
|
|
if (myh == NULL
|
|
&& asprintf (error_message, _("unable to find ARM glue '%s' for '%s'"),
|
|
tmp_name, name) == -1)
|
|
*error_message = (char *) bfd_errmsg (bfd_error_system_call);
|
|
|
|
free (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
return myh;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* ARM->Thumb glue (static images):
|
|
|
|
.arm
|
|
__func_from_arm:
|
|
ldr r12, __func_addr
|
|
bx r12
|
|
__func_addr:
|
|
.word func @ behave as if you saw a ARM_32 reloc.
|
|
|
|
(v5t static images)
|
|
.arm
|
|
__func_from_arm:
|
|
ldr pc, __func_addr
|
|
__func_addr:
|
|
.word func @ behave as if you saw a ARM_32 reloc.
|
|
|
|
(relocatable images)
|
|
.arm
|
|
__func_from_arm:
|
|
ldr r12, __func_offset
|
|
add r12, r12, pc
|
|
bx r12
|
|
__func_offset:
|
|
.word func - . */
|
|
|
|
#define ARM2THUMB_STATIC_GLUE_SIZE 12
|
|
static const insn32 a2t1_ldr_insn = 0xe59fc000;
|
|
static const insn32 a2t2_bx_r12_insn = 0xe12fff1c;
|
|
static const insn32 a2t3_func_addr_insn = 0x00000001;
|
|
|
|
#define ARM2THUMB_V5_STATIC_GLUE_SIZE 8
|
|
static const insn32 a2t1v5_ldr_insn = 0xe51ff004;
|
|
static const insn32 a2t2v5_func_addr_insn = 0x00000001;
|
|
|
|
#define ARM2THUMB_PIC_GLUE_SIZE 16
|
|
static const insn32 a2t1p_ldr_insn = 0xe59fc004;
|
|
static const insn32 a2t2p_add_pc_insn = 0xe08cc00f;
|
|
static const insn32 a2t3p_bx_r12_insn = 0xe12fff1c;
|
|
|
|
/* Thumb->ARM: Thumb->(non-interworking aware) ARM
|
|
|
|
.thumb .thumb
|
|
.align 2 .align 2
|
|
__func_from_thumb: __func_from_thumb:
|
|
bx pc push {r6, lr}
|
|
nop ldr r6, __func_addr
|
|
.arm mov lr, pc
|
|
b func bx r6
|
|
.arm
|
|
;; back_to_thumb
|
|
ldmia r13! {r6, lr}
|
|
bx lr
|
|
__func_addr:
|
|
.word func */
|
|
|
|
#define THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SIZE 8
|
|
static const insn16 t2a1_bx_pc_insn = 0x4778;
|
|
static const insn16 t2a2_noop_insn = 0x46c0;
|
|
static const insn32 t2a3_b_insn = 0xea000000;
|
|
|
|
#define VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SIZE 8
|
|
|
|
#define ARM_BX_VENEER_SIZE 12
|
|
static const insn32 armbx1_tst_insn = 0xe3100001;
|
|
static const insn32 armbx2_moveq_insn = 0x01a0f000;
|
|
static const insn32 armbx3_bx_insn = 0xe12fff10;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef ELFARM_NABI_C_INCLUDED
|
|
static void
|
|
arm_allocate_glue_section_space (bfd * abfd, bfd_size_type size, const char * name)
|
|
{
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
bfd_byte * contents;
|
|
|
|
if (size == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Do not include empty glue sections in the output. */
|
|
if (abfd != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
|
|
if (s != NULL)
|
|
s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
|
}
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL);
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
|
|
contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->size == size);
|
|
s->contents = contents;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_allocate_interworking_sections (struct bfd_link_info * info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
|
|
arm_allocate_glue_section_space (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
globals->arm_glue_size,
|
|
ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
arm_allocate_glue_section_space (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
globals->thumb_glue_size,
|
|
THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
arm_allocate_glue_section_space (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
globals->vfp11_erratum_glue_size,
|
|
VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
arm_allocate_glue_section_space (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
globals->bx_glue_size,
|
|
ARM_BX_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate space and symbols for calling a Thumb function from Arm mode.
|
|
returns the symbol identifying the stub. */
|
|
|
|
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
|
|
record_arm_to_thumb_glue (struct bfd_link_info * link_info,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)
|
|
{
|
|
const char * name = h->root.root.string;
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
char * tmp_name;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * myh;
|
|
struct bfd_link_hash_entry * bh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
bfd_vma val;
|
|
bfd_size_type size;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name
|
|
(globals->bfd_of_glue_owner, ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
|
|
tmp_name = (char *) bfd_malloc ((bfd_size_type) strlen (name)
|
|
+ strlen (ARM2THUMB_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME) + 1);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, ARM2THUMB_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME, name);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(globals)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
|
|
|
if (myh != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We've already seen this guy. */
|
|
free (tmp_name);
|
|
return myh;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The only trick here is using hash_table->arm_glue_size as the value.
|
|
Even though the section isn't allocated yet, this is where we will be
|
|
putting it. The +1 on the value marks that the stub has not been
|
|
output yet - not that it is a Thumb function. */
|
|
bh = NULL;
|
|
val = globals->arm_glue_size + 1;
|
|
_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (link_info, globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
tmp_name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, val,
|
|
NULL, TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
|
|
|
|
myh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
|
myh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
|
|
myh->forced_local = 1;
|
|
|
|
free (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
if (link_info->shared || globals->root.is_relocatable_executable
|
|
|| globals->pic_veneer)
|
|
size = ARM2THUMB_PIC_GLUE_SIZE;
|
|
else if (globals->use_blx)
|
|
size = ARM2THUMB_V5_STATIC_GLUE_SIZE;
|
|
else
|
|
size = ARM2THUMB_STATIC_GLUE_SIZE;
|
|
|
|
s->size += size;
|
|
globals->arm_glue_size += size;
|
|
|
|
return myh;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate space for ARMv4 BX veneers. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
record_arm_bx_glue (struct bfd_link_info * link_info, int reg)
|
|
{
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
char *tmp_name;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *myh;
|
|
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
|
|
bfd_vma val;
|
|
|
|
/* BX PC does not need a veneer. */
|
|
if (reg == 15)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Check if this veneer has already been allocated. */
|
|
if (globals->bx_glue_offset[reg])
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name
|
|
(globals->bfd_of_glue_owner, ARM_BX_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Add symbol for veneer. */
|
|
tmp_name = (char *)
|
|
bfd_malloc ((bfd_size_type) strlen (ARM_BX_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME) + 1);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, ARM_BX_GLUE_ENTRY_NAME, reg);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(globals)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (myh == NULL);
|
|
|
|
bh = NULL;
|
|
val = globals->bx_glue_size;
|
|
_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (link_info, globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
tmp_name, BSF_FUNCTION | BSF_LOCAL, s, val,
|
|
NULL, TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
|
|
|
|
myh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
|
myh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
|
|
myh->forced_local = 1;
|
|
|
|
s->size += ARM_BX_VENEER_SIZE;
|
|
globals->bx_glue_offset[reg] = globals->bx_glue_size | 2;
|
|
globals->bx_glue_size += ARM_BX_VENEER_SIZE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Add an entry to the code/data map for section SEC. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_section_map_add (asection *sec, char type, bfd_vma vma)
|
|
{
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf32_arm_section_data (sec);
|
|
unsigned int newidx;
|
|
|
|
if (sec_data->map == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
sec_data->map = (elf32_arm_section_map *)
|
|
bfd_malloc (sizeof (elf32_arm_section_map));
|
|
sec_data->mapcount = 0;
|
|
sec_data->mapsize = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
newidx = sec_data->mapcount++;
|
|
|
|
if (sec_data->mapcount > sec_data->mapsize)
|
|
{
|
|
sec_data->mapsize *= 2;
|
|
sec_data->map = (elf32_arm_section_map *)
|
|
bfd_realloc_or_free (sec_data->map, sec_data->mapsize
|
|
* sizeof (elf32_arm_section_map));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (sec_data->map)
|
|
{
|
|
sec_data->map[newidx].vma = vma;
|
|
sec_data->map[newidx].type = type;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Record information about a VFP11 denorm-erratum veneer. Only ARM-mode
|
|
veneers are handled for now. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_vma
|
|
record_vfp11_erratum_veneer (struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *branch,
|
|
bfd *branch_bfd,
|
|
asection *branch_sec,
|
|
unsigned int offset)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *s;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *hash_table;
|
|
char *tmp_name;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *myh;
|
|
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
|
|
bfd_vma val;
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *sec_data;
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *newerr;
|
|
|
|
hash_table = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (hash_table != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (hash_table->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name
|
|
(hash_table->bfd_of_glue_owner, VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
sec_data = elf32_arm_section_data (s);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
|
|
tmp_name = (char *) bfd_malloc ((bfd_size_type) strlen
|
|
(VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_ENTRY_NAME) + 10);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_ENTRY_NAME,
|
|
hash_table->num_vfp11_fixes);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(hash_table)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (myh == NULL);
|
|
|
|
bh = NULL;
|
|
val = hash_table->vfp11_erratum_glue_size;
|
|
_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (link_info, hash_table->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
tmp_name, BSF_FUNCTION | BSF_LOCAL, s, val,
|
|
NULL, TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
|
|
|
|
myh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
|
myh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
|
|
myh->forced_local = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Link veneer back to calling location. */
|
|
sec_data->erratumcount += 1;
|
|
newerr = (elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *)
|
|
bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (elf32_vfp11_erratum_list));
|
|
|
|
newerr->type = VFP11_ERRATUM_ARM_VENEER;
|
|
newerr->vma = -1;
|
|
newerr->u.v.branch = branch;
|
|
newerr->u.v.id = hash_table->num_vfp11_fixes;
|
|
branch->u.b.veneer = newerr;
|
|
|
|
newerr->next = sec_data->erratumlist;
|
|
sec_data->erratumlist = newerr;
|
|
|
|
/* A symbol for the return from the veneer. */
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_ENTRY_NAME "_r",
|
|
hash_table->num_vfp11_fixes);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(hash_table)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
|
|
|
|
if (myh != NULL)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
bh = NULL;
|
|
val = offset + 4;
|
|
_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (link_info, branch_bfd, tmp_name, BSF_LOCAL,
|
|
branch_sec, val, NULL, TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
|
|
|
|
myh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
|
myh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
|
|
myh->forced_local = 1;
|
|
|
|
free (tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
/* Generate a mapping symbol for the veneer section, and explicitly add an
|
|
entry for that symbol to the code/data map for the section. */
|
|
if (hash_table->vfp11_erratum_glue_size == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
bh = NULL;
|
|
/* FIXME: Creates an ARM symbol. Thumb mode will need attention if it
|
|
ever requires this erratum fix. */
|
|
_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (link_info,
|
|
hash_table->bfd_of_glue_owner, "$a",
|
|
BSF_LOCAL, s, 0, NULL,
|
|
TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
|
|
|
|
myh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
|
myh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_NOTYPE);
|
|
myh->forced_local = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* The elf32_arm_init_maps function only cares about symbols from input
|
|
BFDs. We must make a note of this generated mapping symbol
|
|
ourselves so that code byteswapping works properly in
|
|
elf32_arm_write_section. */
|
|
elf32_arm_section_map_add (s, 'a', 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
s->size += VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SIZE;
|
|
hash_table->vfp11_erratum_glue_size += VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SIZE;
|
|
hash_table->num_vfp11_fixes++;
|
|
|
|
/* The offset of the veneer. */
|
|
return val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#define ARM_GLUE_SECTION_FLAGS \
|
|
(SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_CODE \
|
|
| SEC_READONLY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
|
|
|
|
/* Create a fake section for use by the ARM backend of the linker. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arm_make_glue_section (bfd * abfd, const char * name)
|
|
{
|
|
asection * sec;
|
|
|
|
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
|
|
if (sec != NULL)
|
|
/* Already made. */
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, ARM_GLUE_SECTION_FLAGS);
|
|
|
|
if (sec == NULL
|
|
|| !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, sec, 2))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the gc mark to prevent the section from being removed by garbage
|
|
collection, despite the fact that no relocs refer to this section. */
|
|
sec->gc_mark = 1;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add the glue sections to ABFD. This function is called from the
|
|
linker scripts in ld/emultempl/{armelf}.em. */
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_add_glue_sections_to_bfd (bfd *abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we are only performing a partial
|
|
link do not bother adding the glue. */
|
|
if (info->relocatable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
return arm_make_glue_section (abfd, ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME)
|
|
&& arm_make_glue_section (abfd, THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SECTION_NAME)
|
|
&& arm_make_glue_section (abfd, VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SECTION_NAME)
|
|
&& arm_make_glue_section (abfd, ARM_BX_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Select a BFD to be used to hold the sections used by the glue code.
|
|
This function is called from the linker scripts in ld/emultempl/
|
|
{armelf/pe}.em. */
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_get_bfd_for_interworking (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
|
|
/* If we are only performing a partial link
|
|
do not bother getting a bfd to hold the glue. */
|
|
if (info->relocatable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure we don't attach the glue sections to a dynamic object. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (!(abfd->flags & DYNAMIC));
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Save the bfd for later use. */
|
|
globals->bfd_of_glue_owner = abfd;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
check_use_blx (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals)
|
|
{
|
|
if (bfd_elf_get_obj_attr_int (globals->obfd, OBJ_ATTR_PROC,
|
|
Tag_CPU_arch) > 2)
|
|
globals->use_blx = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_process_before_allocation (bfd *abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
|
|
bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
|
|
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
|
|
/* If we are only performing a partial link do not bother
|
|
to construct any glue. */
|
|
if (link_info->relocatable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Here we have a bfd that is to be included on the link. We have a
|
|
hook to do reloc rummaging, before section sizes are nailed down. */
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
|
|
check_use_blx (globals);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->byteswap_code && !bfd_big_endian (abfd))
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler (_("%B: BE8 images only valid in big-endian mode."),
|
|
abfd);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* PR 5398: If we have not decided to include any loadable sections in
|
|
the output then we will not have a glue owner bfd. This is OK, it
|
|
just means that there is nothing else for us to do here. */
|
|
if (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner == NULL)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Rummage around all the relocs and map the glue vectors. */
|
|
sec = abfd->sections;
|
|
|
|
if (sec == NULL)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
for (; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (sec->reloc_count == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
symtab_hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
|
|
|
|
/* Load the relocs. */
|
|
internal_relocs
|
|
= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
|
|
|
|
if (internal_relocs == NULL)
|
|
goto error_return;
|
|
|
|
irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
|
|
for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
|
|
{
|
|
long r_type;
|
|
unsigned long r_index;
|
|
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
|
|
|
r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
|
|
r_index = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
|
|
|
|
/* These are the only relocation types we care about. */
|
|
if ( r_type != R_ARM_PC24
|
|
&& (r_type != R_ARM_V4BX || globals->fix_v4bx < 2))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
|
|
if (contents == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Get cached copy if it exists. */
|
|
if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
|
|
contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Go get them off disk. */
|
|
if (! bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
|
|
goto error_return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_V4BX)
|
|
{
|
|
int reg;
|
|
|
|
reg = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset) & 0xf;
|
|
record_arm_bx_glue (link_info, reg);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If the relocation is not against a symbol it cannot concern us. */
|
|
h = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* We don't care about local symbols. */
|
|
if (r_index < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* This is an external symbol. */
|
|
r_index -= symtab_hdr->sh_info;
|
|
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
|
elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[r_index];
|
|
|
|
/* If the relocation is against a static symbol it must be within
|
|
the current section and so cannot be a cross ARM/Thumb relocation. */
|
|
if (h == NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* If the call will go through a PLT entry then we do not need
|
|
glue. */
|
|
if (globals->root.splt != NULL && h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_PC24:
|
|
/* This one is a call from arm code. We need to look up
|
|
the target of the call. If it is a thumb target, we
|
|
insert glue. */
|
|
if (h->target_internal == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
record_arm_to_thumb_glue (link_info, h);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (contents != NULL
|
|
&& elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
|
|
free (contents);
|
|
contents = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (internal_relocs != NULL
|
|
&& elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
|
|
free (internal_relocs);
|
|
internal_relocs = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
error_return:
|
|
if (contents != NULL
|
|
&& elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
|
|
free (contents);
|
|
if (internal_relocs != NULL
|
|
&& elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
|
|
free (internal_relocs);
|
|
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialise maps of ARM/Thumb/data for input BFDs. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_init_maps (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
|
|
unsigned int i, localsyms;
|
|
|
|
/* PR 7093: Make sure that we are dealing with an arm elf binary. */
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (abfd))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
|
|
localsyms = hdr->sh_info;
|
|
|
|
/* Obtain a buffer full of symbols for this BFD. The hdr->sh_info field
|
|
should contain the number of local symbols, which should come before any
|
|
global symbols. Mapping symbols are always local. */
|
|
isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, localsyms, 0, NULL, NULL,
|
|
NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* No internal symbols read? Skip this BFD. */
|
|
if (isymbuf == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < localsyms; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = &isymbuf[i];
|
|
asection *sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
|
|
const char *name;
|
|
|
|
if (sec != NULL
|
|
&& ELF_ST_BIND (isym->st_info) == STB_LOCAL)
|
|
{
|
|
name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
|
|
hdr->sh_link, isym->st_name);
|
|
|
|
if (bfd_is_arm_special_symbol_name (name,
|
|
BFD_ARM_SPECIAL_SYM_TYPE_MAP))
|
|
elf32_arm_section_map_add (sec, name[1], isym->st_value);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Auto-select enabling of Cortex-A8 erratum fix if the user didn't explicitly
|
|
say what they wanted. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_set_cortex_a8_fix (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
obj_attribute *out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd);
|
|
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (globals->fix_cortex_a8 == -1)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Turn on Cortex-A8 erratum workaround for ARMv7-A. */
|
|
if (out_attr[Tag_CPU_arch].i == TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7
|
|
&& (out_attr[Tag_CPU_arch_profile].i == 'A'
|
|
|| out_attr[Tag_CPU_arch_profile].i == 0))
|
|
globals->fix_cortex_a8 = 1;
|
|
else
|
|
globals->fix_cortex_a8 = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_set_vfp11_fix (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
obj_attribute *out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd);
|
|
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
/* We assume that ARMv7+ does not need the VFP11 denorm erratum fix. */
|
|
if (out_attr[Tag_CPU_arch].i >= TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (globals->vfp11_fix)
|
|
{
|
|
case BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_DEFAULT:
|
|
case BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_NONE:
|
|
globals->vfp11_fix = BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_NONE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
/* Give a warning, but do as the user requests anyway. */
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: warning: selected VFP11 erratum "
|
|
"workaround is not necessary for target architecture"), obfd);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (globals->vfp11_fix == BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_DEFAULT)
|
|
/* For earlier architectures, we might need the workaround, but do not
|
|
enable it by default. If users is running with broken hardware, they
|
|
must enable the erratum fix explicitly. */
|
|
globals->vfp11_fix = BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_NONE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
enum bfd_arm_vfp11_pipe
|
|
{
|
|
VFP11_FMAC,
|
|
VFP11_LS,
|
|
VFP11_DS,
|
|
VFP11_BAD
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Return a VFP register number. This is encoded as RX:X for single-precision
|
|
registers, or X:RX for double-precision registers, where RX is the group of
|
|
four bits in the instruction encoding and X is the single extension bit.
|
|
RX and X fields are specified using their lowest (starting) bit. The return
|
|
value is:
|
|
|
|
0...31: single-precision registers s0...s31
|
|
32...63: double-precision registers d0...d31.
|
|
|
|
Although X should be zero for VFP11 (encoding d0...d15 only), we might
|
|
encounter VFP3 instructions, so we allow the full range for DP registers. */
|
|
|
|
static unsigned int
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (unsigned int insn, bfd_boolean is_double, unsigned int rx,
|
|
unsigned int x)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_double)
|
|
return (((insn >> rx) & 0xf) | (((insn >> x) & 1) << 4)) + 32;
|
|
else
|
|
return (((insn >> rx) & 0xf) << 1) | ((insn >> x) & 1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set bits in *WMASK according to a register number REG as encoded by
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_regno(). Ignore d16-d31. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (unsigned int *wmask, unsigned int reg)
|
|
{
|
|
if (reg < 32)
|
|
*wmask |= 1 << reg;
|
|
else if (reg < 48)
|
|
*wmask |= 3 << ((reg - 32) * 2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return TRUE if WMASK overwrites anything in REGS. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_antidependency (unsigned int wmask, int *regs, int numregs)
|
|
{
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < numregs; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int reg = regs[i];
|
|
|
|
if (reg < 32 && (wmask & (1 << reg)) != 0)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
reg -= 32;
|
|
|
|
if (reg >= 16)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ((wmask & (3 << (reg * 2))) != 0)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* In this function, we're interested in two things: finding input registers
|
|
for VFP data-processing instructions, and finding the set of registers which
|
|
arbitrary VFP instructions may write to. We use a 32-bit unsigned int to
|
|
hold the written set, so FLDM etc. are easy to deal with (we're only
|
|
interested in 32 SP registers or 16 dp registers, due to the VFP version
|
|
implemented by the chip in question). DP registers are marked by setting
|
|
both SP registers in the write mask). */
|
|
|
|
static enum bfd_arm_vfp11_pipe
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_insn_decode (unsigned int insn, unsigned int *destmask, int *regs,
|
|
int *numregs)
|
|
{
|
|
enum bfd_arm_vfp11_pipe vpipe = VFP11_BAD;
|
|
bfd_boolean is_double = ((insn & 0xf00) == 0xb00) ? 1 : 0;
|
|
|
|
if ((insn & 0x0f000e10) == 0x0e000a00) /* A data-processing insn. */
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int pqrs;
|
|
unsigned int fd = bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (insn, is_double, 12, 22);
|
|
unsigned int fm = bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (insn, is_double, 0, 5);
|
|
|
|
pqrs = ((insn & 0x00800000) >> 20)
|
|
| ((insn & 0x00300000) >> 19)
|
|
| ((insn & 0x00000040) >> 6);
|
|
|
|
switch (pqrs)
|
|
{
|
|
case 0: /* fmac[sd]. */
|
|
case 1: /* fnmac[sd]. */
|
|
case 2: /* fmsc[sd]. */
|
|
case 3: /* fnmsc[sd]. */
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_FMAC;
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fd);
|
|
regs[0] = fd;
|
|
regs[1] = bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (insn, is_double, 16, 7); /* Fn. */
|
|
regs[2] = fm;
|
|
*numregs = 3;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 4: /* fmul[sd]. */
|
|
case 5: /* fnmul[sd]. */
|
|
case 6: /* fadd[sd]. */
|
|
case 7: /* fsub[sd]. */
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_FMAC;
|
|
goto vfp_binop;
|
|
|
|
case 8: /* fdiv[sd]. */
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_DS;
|
|
vfp_binop:
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fd);
|
|
regs[0] = bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (insn, is_double, 16, 7); /* Fn. */
|
|
regs[1] = fm;
|
|
*numregs = 2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 15: /* extended opcode. */
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int extn = ((insn >> 15) & 0x1e)
|
|
| ((insn >> 7) & 1);
|
|
|
|
switch (extn)
|
|
{
|
|
case 0: /* fcpy[sd]. */
|
|
case 1: /* fabs[sd]. */
|
|
case 2: /* fneg[sd]. */
|
|
case 8: /* fcmp[sd]. */
|
|
case 9: /* fcmpe[sd]. */
|
|
case 10: /* fcmpz[sd]. */
|
|
case 11: /* fcmpez[sd]. */
|
|
case 16: /* fuito[sd]. */
|
|
case 17: /* fsito[sd]. */
|
|
case 24: /* ftoui[sd]. */
|
|
case 25: /* ftouiz[sd]. */
|
|
case 26: /* ftosi[sd]. */
|
|
case 27: /* ftosiz[sd]. */
|
|
/* These instructions will not bounce due to underflow. */
|
|
*numregs = 0;
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_FMAC;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 3: /* fsqrt[sd]. */
|
|
/* fsqrt cannot underflow, but it can (perhaps) overwrite
|
|
registers to cause the erratum in previous instructions. */
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fd);
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_DS;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 15: /* fcvt{ds,sd}. */
|
|
{
|
|
int rnum = 0;
|
|
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fd);
|
|
|
|
/* Only FCVTSD can underflow. */
|
|
if ((insn & 0x100) != 0)
|
|
regs[rnum++] = fm;
|
|
|
|
*numregs = rnum;
|
|
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_FMAC;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
return VFP11_BAD;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
return VFP11_BAD;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/* Two-register transfer. */
|
|
else if ((insn & 0x0fe00ed0) == 0x0c400a10)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int fm = bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (insn, is_double, 0, 5);
|
|
|
|
if ((insn & 0x100000) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_double)
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fm);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fm);
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fm + 1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_LS;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((insn & 0x0e100e00) == 0x0c100a00) /* A load insn. */
|
|
{
|
|
int fd = bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (insn, is_double, 12, 22);
|
|
unsigned int puw = ((insn >> 21) & 0x1) | (((insn >> 23) & 3) << 1);
|
|
|
|
switch (puw)
|
|
{
|
|
case 0: /* Two-reg transfer. We should catch these above. */
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
case 2: /* fldm[sdx]. */
|
|
case 3:
|
|
case 5:
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i, offset = insn & 0xff;
|
|
|
|
if (is_double)
|
|
offset >>= 1;
|
|
|
|
for (i = fd; i < fd + offset; i++)
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, i);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 4: /* fld[sd]. */
|
|
case 6:
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fd);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
return VFP11_BAD;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_LS;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Single-register transfer. Note L==0. */
|
|
else if ((insn & 0x0f100e10) == 0x0e000a10)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int opcode = (insn >> 21) & 7;
|
|
unsigned int fn = bfd_arm_vfp11_regno (insn, is_double, 16, 7);
|
|
|
|
switch (opcode)
|
|
{
|
|
case 0: /* fmsr/fmdlr. */
|
|
case 1: /* fmdhr. */
|
|
/* Mark fmdhr and fmdlr as writing to the whole of the DP
|
|
destination register. I don't know if this is exactly right,
|
|
but it is the conservative choice. */
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_write_mask (destmask, fn);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 7: /* fmxr. */
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
vpipe = VFP11_LS;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return vpipe;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int elf32_arm_compare_mapping (const void * a, const void * b);
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Look for potentially-troublesome code sequences which might trigger the
|
|
VFP11 denormal/antidependency erratum. See, e.g., the ARM1136 errata sheet
|
|
(available from ARM) for details of the erratum. A short version is
|
|
described in ld.texinfo. */
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_vfp11_erratum_scan (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
|
|
int state = 0;
|
|
int regs[3], numregs = 0;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
int use_vector = (globals->vfp11_fix == BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_VECTOR);
|
|
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* We use a simple FSM to match troublesome VFP11 instruction sequences.
|
|
The states transition as follows:
|
|
|
|
0 -> 1 (vector) or 0 -> 2 (scalar)
|
|
A VFP FMAC-pipeline instruction has been seen. Fill
|
|
regs[0]..regs[numregs-1] with its input operands. Remember this
|
|
instruction in 'first_fmac'.
|
|
|
|
1 -> 2
|
|
Any instruction, except for a VFP instruction which overwrites
|
|
regs[*].
|
|
|
|
1 -> 3 [ -> 0 ] or
|
|
2 -> 3 [ -> 0 ]
|
|
A VFP instruction has been seen which overwrites any of regs[*].
|
|
We must make a veneer! Reset state to 0 before examining next
|
|
instruction.
|
|
|
|
2 -> 0
|
|
If we fail to match anything in state 2, reset to state 0 and reset
|
|
the instruction pointer to the instruction after 'first_fmac'.
|
|
|
|
If the VFP11 vector mode is in use, there must be at least two unrelated
|
|
instructions between anti-dependent VFP11 instructions to properly avoid
|
|
triggering the erratum, hence the use of the extra state 1. */
|
|
|
|
/* If we are only performing a partial link do not bother
|
|
to construct any glue. */
|
|
if (link_info->relocatable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip if this bfd does not correspond to an ELF image. */
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (abfd))
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* We should have chosen a fix type by the time we get here. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->vfp11_fix != BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_DEFAULT);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->vfp11_fix == BFD_ARM_VFP11_FIX_NONE)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip this BFD if it corresponds to an executable or dynamic object. */
|
|
if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i, span, first_fmac = 0, veneer_of_insn = 0;
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *sec_data;
|
|
|
|
/* If we don't have executable progbits, we're not interested in this
|
|
section. Also skip if section is to be excluded. */
|
|
if (elf_section_type (sec) != SHT_PROGBITS
|
|
|| (elf_section_flags (sec) & SHF_EXECINSTR) == 0
|
|
|| (sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0
|
|
|| sec->sec_info_type == ELF_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS
|
|
|| sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr
|
|
|| strcmp (sec->name, VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SECTION_NAME) == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
sec_data = elf32_arm_section_data (sec);
|
|
|
|
if (sec_data->mapcount == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
|
|
contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
|
|
else if (! bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
|
|
goto error_return;
|
|
|
|
qsort (sec_data->map, sec_data->mapcount, sizeof (elf32_arm_section_map),
|
|
elf32_arm_compare_mapping);
|
|
|
|
for (span = 0; span < sec_data->mapcount; span++)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int span_start = sec_data->map[span].vma;
|
|
unsigned int span_end = (span == sec_data->mapcount - 1)
|
|
? sec->size : sec_data->map[span + 1].vma;
|
|
char span_type = sec_data->map[span].type;
|
|
|
|
/* FIXME: Only ARM mode is supported at present. We may need to
|
|
support Thumb-2 mode also at some point. */
|
|
if (span_type != 'a')
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (i = span_start; i < span_end;)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int next_i = i + 4;
|
|
unsigned int insn = bfd_big_endian (abfd)
|
|
? (contents[i] << 24)
|
|
| (contents[i + 1] << 16)
|
|
| (contents[i + 2] << 8)
|
|
| contents[i + 3]
|
|
: (contents[i + 3] << 24)
|
|
| (contents[i + 2] << 16)
|
|
| (contents[i + 1] << 8)
|
|
| contents[i];
|
|
unsigned int writemask = 0;
|
|
enum bfd_arm_vfp11_pipe vpipe;
|
|
|
|
switch (state)
|
|
{
|
|
case 0:
|
|
vpipe = bfd_arm_vfp11_insn_decode (insn, &writemask, regs,
|
|
&numregs);
|
|
/* I'm assuming the VFP11 erratum can trigger with denorm
|
|
operands on either the FMAC or the DS pipeline. This might
|
|
lead to slightly overenthusiastic veneer insertion. */
|
|
if (vpipe == VFP11_FMAC || vpipe == VFP11_DS)
|
|
{
|
|
state = use_vector ? 1 : 2;
|
|
first_fmac = i;
|
|
veneer_of_insn = insn;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 1:
|
|
{
|
|
int other_regs[3], other_numregs;
|
|
vpipe = bfd_arm_vfp11_insn_decode (insn, &writemask,
|
|
other_regs,
|
|
&other_numregs);
|
|
if (vpipe != VFP11_BAD
|
|
&& bfd_arm_vfp11_antidependency (writemask, regs,
|
|
numregs))
|
|
state = 3;
|
|
else
|
|
state = 2;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 2:
|
|
{
|
|
int other_regs[3], other_numregs;
|
|
vpipe = bfd_arm_vfp11_insn_decode (insn, &writemask,
|
|
other_regs,
|
|
&other_numregs);
|
|
if (vpipe != VFP11_BAD
|
|
&& bfd_arm_vfp11_antidependency (writemask, regs,
|
|
numregs))
|
|
state = 3;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
state = 0;
|
|
next_i = first_fmac + 4;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 3:
|
|
abort (); /* Should be unreachable. */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (state == 3)
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *newerr =(elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *)
|
|
bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (elf32_vfp11_erratum_list));
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_section_data (sec)->erratumcount += 1;
|
|
|
|
newerr->u.b.vfp_insn = veneer_of_insn;
|
|
|
|
switch (span_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case 'a':
|
|
newerr->type = VFP11_ERRATUM_BRANCH_TO_ARM_VENEER;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
record_vfp11_erratum_veneer (link_info, newerr, abfd, sec,
|
|
first_fmac);
|
|
|
|
newerr->vma = -1;
|
|
|
|
newerr->next = sec_data->erratumlist;
|
|
sec_data->erratumlist = newerr;
|
|
|
|
state = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
i = next_i;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (contents != NULL
|
|
&& elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
|
|
free (contents);
|
|
contents = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
error_return:
|
|
if (contents != NULL
|
|
&& elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
|
|
free (contents);
|
|
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Find virtual-memory addresses for VFP11 erratum veneers and return locations
|
|
after sections have been laid out, using specially-named symbols. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_vfp11_fix_veneer_locations (bfd *abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
char *tmp_name;
|
|
|
|
if (link_info->relocatable)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip if this bfd does not correspond to an ELF image. */
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (abfd))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
tmp_name = (char *) bfd_malloc ((bfd_size_type) strlen
|
|
(VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_ENTRY_NAME) + 10);
|
|
|
|
for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf32_arm_section_data (sec);
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *errnode = sec_data->erratumlist;
|
|
|
|
for (; errnode != NULL; errnode = errnode->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *myh;
|
|
bfd_vma vma;
|
|
|
|
switch (errnode->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case VFP11_ERRATUM_BRANCH_TO_ARM_VENEER:
|
|
case VFP11_ERRATUM_BRANCH_TO_THUMB_VENEER:
|
|
/* Find veneer symbol. */
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_ENTRY_NAME,
|
|
errnode->u.b.veneer->u.v.id);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(globals)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
|
|
|
if (myh == NULL)
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: unable to find VFP11 veneer "
|
|
"`%s'"), abfd, tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
vma = myh->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ myh->root.u.def.section->output_offset
|
|
+ myh->root.u.def.value;
|
|
|
|
errnode->u.b.veneer->vma = vma;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case VFP11_ERRATUM_ARM_VENEER:
|
|
case VFP11_ERRATUM_THUMB_VENEER:
|
|
/* Find return location. */
|
|
sprintf (tmp_name, VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_ENTRY_NAME "_r",
|
|
errnode->u.v.id);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(&(globals)->root, tmp_name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
|
|
|
if (myh == NULL)
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: unable to find VFP11 veneer "
|
|
"`%s'"), abfd, tmp_name);
|
|
|
|
vma = myh->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ myh->root.u.def.section->output_offset
|
|
+ myh->root.u.def.value;
|
|
|
|
errnode->u.v.branch->vma = vma;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
free (tmp_name);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set target relocation values needed during linking. */
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_set_target_relocs (struct bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
|
int target1_is_rel,
|
|
char * target2_type,
|
|
int fix_v4bx,
|
|
int use_blx,
|
|
bfd_arm_vfp11_fix vfp11_fix,
|
|
int no_enum_warn, int no_wchar_warn,
|
|
int pic_veneer, int fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
globals->target1_is_rel = target1_is_rel;
|
|
if (strcmp (target2_type, "rel") == 0)
|
|
globals->target2_reloc = R_ARM_REL32;
|
|
else if (strcmp (target2_type, "abs") == 0)
|
|
globals->target2_reloc = R_ARM_ABS32;
|
|
else if (strcmp (target2_type, "got-rel") == 0)
|
|
globals->target2_reloc = R_ARM_GOT_PREL;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler (_("Invalid TARGET2 relocation type '%s'."),
|
|
target2_type);
|
|
}
|
|
globals->fix_v4bx = fix_v4bx;
|
|
globals->use_blx |= use_blx;
|
|
globals->vfp11_fix = vfp11_fix;
|
|
globals->pic_veneer = pic_veneer;
|
|
globals->fix_cortex_a8 = fix_cortex_a8;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (is_arm_elf (output_bfd));
|
|
elf_arm_tdata (output_bfd)->no_enum_size_warning = no_enum_warn;
|
|
elf_arm_tdata (output_bfd)->no_wchar_size_warning = no_wchar_warn;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Replace the target offset of a Thumb bl or b.w instruction. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
insert_thumb_branch (bfd *abfd, long int offset, bfd_byte *insn)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma upper;
|
|
bfd_vma lower;
|
|
int reloc_sign;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT ((offset & 1) == 0);
|
|
|
|
upper = bfd_get_16 (abfd, insn);
|
|
lower = bfd_get_16 (abfd, insn + 2);
|
|
reloc_sign = (offset < 0) ? 1 : 0;
|
|
upper = (upper & ~(bfd_vma) 0x7ff)
|
|
| ((offset >> 12) & 0x3ff)
|
|
| (reloc_sign << 10);
|
|
lower = (lower & ~(bfd_vma) 0x2fff)
|
|
| (((!((offset >> 23) & 1)) ^ reloc_sign) << 13)
|
|
| (((!((offset >> 22) & 1)) ^ reloc_sign) << 11)
|
|
| ((offset >> 1) & 0x7ff);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (abfd, upper, insn);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (abfd, lower, insn + 2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Thumb code calling an ARM function. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
elf32_thumb_to_arm_stub (struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
const char * name,
|
|
bfd * input_bfd,
|
|
bfd * output_bfd,
|
|
asection * input_section,
|
|
bfd_byte * hit_data,
|
|
asection * sym_sec,
|
|
bfd_vma offset,
|
|
bfd_signed_vma addend,
|
|
bfd_vma val,
|
|
char **error_message)
|
|
{
|
|
asection * s = 0;
|
|
bfd_vma my_offset;
|
|
long int ret_offset;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * myh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
|
|
myh = find_thumb_glue (info, name, error_message);
|
|
if (myh == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
my_offset = myh->root.u.def.value;
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->contents != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->output_section != NULL);
|
|
|
|
if ((my_offset & 0x01) == 0x01)
|
|
{
|
|
if (sym_sec != NULL
|
|
&& sym_sec->owner != NULL
|
|
&& !INTERWORK_FLAG (sym_sec->owner))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%s): warning: interworking not enabled.\n"
|
|
" first occurrence: %B: thumb call to arm"),
|
|
sym_sec->owner, input_bfd, name);
|
|
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
--my_offset;
|
|
myh->root.u.def.value = my_offset;
|
|
|
|
put_thumb_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) t2a1_bx_pc_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset);
|
|
|
|
put_thumb_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) t2a2_noop_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 2);
|
|
|
|
ret_offset =
|
|
/* Address of destination of the stub. */
|
|
((bfd_signed_vma) val)
|
|
- ((bfd_signed_vma)
|
|
/* Offset from the start of the current section
|
|
to the start of the stubs. */
|
|
(s->output_offset
|
|
/* Offset of the start of this stub from the start of the stubs. */
|
|
+ my_offset
|
|
/* Address of the start of the current section. */
|
|
+ s->output_section->vma)
|
|
/* The branch instruction is 4 bytes into the stub. */
|
|
+ 4
|
|
/* ARM branches work from the pc of the instruction + 8. */
|
|
+ 8);
|
|
|
|
put_arm_insn (globals, output_bfd,
|
|
(bfd_vma) t2a3_b_insn | ((ret_offset >> 2) & 0x00FFFFFF),
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 4);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (my_offset <= globals->thumb_glue_size);
|
|
|
|
/* Now go back and fix up the original BL insn to point to here. */
|
|
ret_offset =
|
|
/* Address of where the stub is located. */
|
|
(s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset + my_offset)
|
|
/* Address of where the BL is located. */
|
|
- (input_section->output_section->vma + input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ offset)
|
|
/* Addend in the relocation. */
|
|
- addend
|
|
/* Biassing for PC-relative addressing. */
|
|
- 8;
|
|
|
|
insert_thumb_branch (input_bfd, ret_offset, hit_data - input_section->vma);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Populate an Arm to Thumb stub. Returns the stub symbol. */
|
|
|
|
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
|
|
elf32_arm_create_thumb_stub (struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
const char * name,
|
|
bfd * input_bfd,
|
|
bfd * output_bfd,
|
|
asection * sym_sec,
|
|
bfd_vma val,
|
|
asection * s,
|
|
char ** error_message)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma my_offset;
|
|
long int ret_offset;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * myh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
|
|
myh = find_arm_glue (info, name, error_message);
|
|
if (myh == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
my_offset = myh->root.u.def.value;
|
|
|
|
if ((my_offset & 0x01) == 0x01)
|
|
{
|
|
if (sym_sec != NULL
|
|
&& sym_sec->owner != NULL
|
|
&& !INTERWORK_FLAG (sym_sec->owner))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%s): warning: interworking not enabled.\n"
|
|
" first occurrence: %B: arm call to thumb"),
|
|
sym_sec->owner, input_bfd, name);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
--my_offset;
|
|
myh->root.u.def.value = my_offset;
|
|
|
|
if (info->shared || globals->root.is_relocatable_executable
|
|
|| globals->pic_veneer)
|
|
{
|
|
/* For relocatable objects we can't use absolute addresses,
|
|
so construct the address from a relative offset. */
|
|
/* TODO: If the offset is small it's probably worth
|
|
constructing the address with adds. */
|
|
put_arm_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) a2t1p_ldr_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset);
|
|
put_arm_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) a2t2p_add_pc_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 4);
|
|
put_arm_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) a2t3p_bx_r12_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 8);
|
|
/* Adjust the offset by 4 for the position of the add,
|
|
and 8 for the pipeline offset. */
|
|
ret_offset = (val - (s->output_offset
|
|
+ s->output_section->vma
|
|
+ my_offset + 12))
|
|
| 1;
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ret_offset,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 12);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (globals->use_blx)
|
|
{
|
|
put_arm_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) a2t1v5_ldr_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset);
|
|
|
|
/* It's a thumb address. Add the low order bit. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val | a2t2v5_func_addr_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 4);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
put_arm_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) a2t1_ldr_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset);
|
|
|
|
put_arm_insn (globals, output_bfd, (bfd_vma) a2t2_bx_r12_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 4);
|
|
|
|
/* It's a thumb address. Add the low order bit. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val | a2t3_func_addr_insn,
|
|
s->contents + my_offset + 8);
|
|
|
|
my_offset += 12;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (my_offset <= globals->arm_glue_size);
|
|
|
|
return myh;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Arm code calling a Thumb function. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
elf32_arm_to_thumb_stub (struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
const char * name,
|
|
bfd * input_bfd,
|
|
bfd * output_bfd,
|
|
asection * input_section,
|
|
bfd_byte * hit_data,
|
|
asection * sym_sec,
|
|
bfd_vma offset,
|
|
bfd_signed_vma addend,
|
|
bfd_vma val,
|
|
char **error_message)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long int tmp;
|
|
bfd_vma my_offset;
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
long int ret_offset;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * myh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->contents != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->output_section != NULL);
|
|
|
|
myh = elf32_arm_create_thumb_stub (info, name, input_bfd, output_bfd,
|
|
sym_sec, val, s, error_message);
|
|
if (!myh)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
my_offset = myh->root.u.def.value;
|
|
tmp = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
tmp = tmp & 0xFF000000;
|
|
|
|
/* Somehow these are both 4 too far, so subtract 8. */
|
|
ret_offset = (s->output_offset
|
|
+ my_offset
|
|
+ s->output_section->vma
|
|
- (input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ offset + addend)
|
|
- 8);
|
|
|
|
tmp = tmp | ((ret_offset >> 2) & 0x00FFFFFF);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) tmp, hit_data - input_section->vma);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Populate Arm stub for an exported Thumb function. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_to_thumb_export_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void * inf)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bfd_link_info * info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * myh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
bfd_vma val;
|
|
char *error_message;
|
|
|
|
eh = elf32_arm_hash_entry (h);
|
|
/* Allocate stubs for exported Thumb functions on v4t. */
|
|
if (eh->export_glue == NULL)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->contents != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->output_section != NULL);
|
|
|
|
sec = eh->export_glue->root.u.def.section;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (sec->output_section != NULL);
|
|
|
|
val = eh->export_glue->root.u.def.value + sec->output_offset
|
|
+ sec->output_section->vma;
|
|
|
|
myh = elf32_arm_create_thumb_stub (info, h->root.root.string,
|
|
h->root.u.def.section->owner,
|
|
globals->obfd, sec, val, s,
|
|
&error_message);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (myh);
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Populate ARMv4 BX veneers. Returns the absolute adress of the veneer. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_vma
|
|
elf32_arm_bx_glue (struct bfd_link_info * info, int reg)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_byte *p;
|
|
bfd_vma glue_addr;
|
|
asection *s;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL);
|
|
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
ARM_BX_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->contents != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s->output_section != NULL);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->bx_glue_offset[reg] & 2);
|
|
|
|
glue_addr = globals->bx_glue_offset[reg] & ~(bfd_vma)3;
|
|
|
|
if ((globals->bx_glue_offset[reg] & 1) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
p = s->contents + glue_addr;
|
|
bfd_put_32 (globals->obfd, armbx1_tst_insn + (reg << 16), p);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (globals->obfd, armbx2_moveq_insn + reg, p + 4);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (globals->obfd, armbx3_bx_insn + reg, p + 8);
|
|
globals->bx_glue_offset[reg] |= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return glue_addr + s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Generate Arm stubs for exported Thumb symbols. */
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
|
|
if (link_info == NULL)
|
|
/* Ignore this if we are not called by the ELF backend linker. */
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
/* If blx is available then exported Thumb symbols are OK and there is
|
|
nothing to do. */
|
|
if (globals->use_blx)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
elf_link_hash_traverse (&globals->root, elf32_arm_to_thumb_export_stub,
|
|
link_info);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Reserve space for COUNT dynamic relocations in relocation selection
|
|
SRELOC. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *sreloc,
|
|
bfd_size_type count)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.dynamic_sections_created);
|
|
if (sreloc == NULL)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
sreloc->size += RELOC_SIZE (htab) * count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Reserve space for COUNT R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocations. If the link is
|
|
dynamic, the relocations should go in SRELOC, otherwise they should
|
|
go in the special .rel.iplt section. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *sreloc,
|
|
bfd_size_type count)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (!htab->root.dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
htab->root.irelplt->size += RELOC_SIZE (htab) * count;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
|
|
sreloc->size += RELOC_SIZE (htab) * count;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add relocation REL to the end of relocation section SRELOC. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
asection *sreloc, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_byte *loc;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (!htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
|
|
&& ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_ARM_IRELATIVE)
|
|
sreloc = htab->root.irelplt;
|
|
if (sreloc == NULL)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
loc = sreloc->contents;
|
|
loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
if (sreloc->reloc_count * RELOC_SIZE (htab) > sreloc->size)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (htab) (output_bfd, rel, loc);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate room for a PLT entry described by ROOT_PLT and ARM_PLT.
|
|
IS_IPLT_ENTRY says whether the entry belongs to .iplt rather than
|
|
to .plt. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_plt_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
bfd_boolean is_iplt_entry,
|
|
union gotplt_union *root_plt,
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
asection *splt;
|
|
asection *sgotplt;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
|
|
if (is_iplt_entry)
|
|
{
|
|
splt = htab->root.iplt;
|
|
sgotplt = htab->root.igotplt;
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate room for an R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocation in .rel.iplt. */
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs (info, htab->root.irelplt, 1);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
splt = htab->root.splt;
|
|
sgotplt = htab->root.sgotplt;
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate room for an R_JUMP_SLOT relocation in .rel.plt. */
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelplt, 1);
|
|
|
|
/* If this is the first .plt entry, make room for the special
|
|
first entry. */
|
|
if (splt->size == 0)
|
|
splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate the PLT entry itself, including any leading Thumb stub. */
|
|
if (elf32_arm_plt_needs_thumb_stub_p (info, arm_plt))
|
|
splt->size += PLT_THUMB_STUB_SIZE;
|
|
root_plt->offset = splt->size;
|
|
splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
|
|
|
|
if (!htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We also need to make an entry in the .got.plt section, which
|
|
will be placed in the .got section by the linker script. */
|
|
arm_plt->got_offset = sgotplt->size - 8 * htab->num_tls_desc;
|
|
sgotplt->size += 4;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in a PLT entry and its associated GOT slot. If DYNINDX == -1,
|
|
the entry lives in .iplt and resolves to (*SYM_VALUE)().
|
|
Otherwise, DYNINDX is the index of the symbol in the dynamic
|
|
symbol table and SYM_VALUE is undefined.
|
|
|
|
ROOT_PLT points to the offset of the PLT entry from the start of its
|
|
section (.iplt or .plt). ARM_PLT points to the symbol's ARM-specific
|
|
bookkeeping information. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_populate_plt_entry (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
union gotplt_union *root_plt,
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt,
|
|
int dynindx, bfd_vma sym_value)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
asection *sgot;
|
|
asection *splt;
|
|
asection *srel;
|
|
bfd_byte *loc;
|
|
bfd_vma plt_index;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
|
|
bfd_vma plt_header_size;
|
|
bfd_vma got_header_size;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
|
|
/* Pick the appropriate sections and sizes. */
|
|
if (dynindx == -1)
|
|
{
|
|
splt = htab->root.iplt;
|
|
sgot = htab->root.igotplt;
|
|
srel = htab->root.irelplt;
|
|
|
|
/* There are no reserved entries in .igot.plt, and no special
|
|
first entry in .iplt. */
|
|
got_header_size = 0;
|
|
plt_header_size = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
splt = htab->root.splt;
|
|
sgot = htab->root.sgotplt;
|
|
srel = htab->root.srelplt;
|
|
|
|
got_header_size = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->got_header_size;
|
|
plt_header_size = htab->plt_header_size;
|
|
}
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && srel != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in the entry in the procedure linkage table. */
|
|
if (htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (dynindx >= 0);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_symbian_plt_entry[0],
|
|
splt->contents + root_plt->offset);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_symbian_plt_entry[1],
|
|
splt->contents + root_plt->offset + 4);
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in the entry in the .rel.plt section. */
|
|
rel.r_offset = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ root_plt->offset + 4);
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (dynindx, R_ARM_GLOB_DAT);
|
|
|
|
/* Get the index in the procedure linkage table which
|
|
corresponds to this symbol. This is the index of this symbol
|
|
in all the symbols for which we are making plt entries. The
|
|
first entry in the procedure linkage table is reserved. */
|
|
plt_index = ((root_plt->offset - plt_header_size)
|
|
/ htab->plt_entry_size);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma got_offset, got_address, plt_address;
|
|
bfd_vma got_displacement, initial_got_entry;
|
|
bfd_byte * ptr;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Get the offset into the .(i)got.plt table of the entry that
|
|
corresponds to this function. */
|
|
got_offset = (arm_plt->got_offset & -2);
|
|
|
|
/* Get the index in the procedure linkage table which
|
|
corresponds to this symbol. This is the index of this symbol
|
|
in all the symbols for which we are making plt entries.
|
|
After the reserved .got.plt entries, all symbols appear in
|
|
the same order as in .plt. */
|
|
plt_index = (got_offset - got_header_size) / 4;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the address of the GOT entry. */
|
|
got_address = (sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ sgot->output_offset
|
|
+ got_offset);
|
|
|
|
/* ...and the address of the PLT entry. */
|
|
plt_address = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ root_plt->offset);
|
|
|
|
ptr = splt->contents + root_plt->offset;
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p && info->shared)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
|
bfd_vma val;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i != htab->plt_entry_size / 4; i++, ptr += 4)
|
|
{
|
|
val = elf32_arm_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[i];
|
|
if (i == 2)
|
|
val |= got_address - sgot->output_section->vma;
|
|
if (i == 5)
|
|
val |= plt_index * RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
if (i == 2 || i == 5)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, ptr);
|
|
else
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, val, ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (htab->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
|
bfd_vma val;
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i != htab->plt_entry_size / 4; i++, ptr += 4)
|
|
{
|
|
val = elf32_arm_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[i];
|
|
if (i == 2)
|
|
val |= got_address;
|
|
if (i == 4)
|
|
val |= 0xffffff & -((root_plt->offset + i * 4 + 8) >> 2);
|
|
if (i == 5)
|
|
val |= plt_index * RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
if (i == 2 || i == 5)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, ptr);
|
|
else
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, val, ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
|
|
+ (plt_index * 2 + 1) * RELOC_SIZE (htab));
|
|
|
|
/* Create the .rela.plt.unloaded R_ARM_ABS32 relocation
|
|
referencing the GOT for this PLT entry. */
|
|
rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_ARM_ABS32);
|
|
rel.r_addend = got_offset;
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (htab) (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
|
|
loc += RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
|
|
/* Create the R_ARM_ABS32 relocation referencing the
|
|
beginning of the PLT for this GOT entry. */
|
|
rel.r_offset = got_address;
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_ARM_ABS32);
|
|
rel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (htab) (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Calculate the displacement between the PLT slot and the
|
|
entry in the GOT. The eight-byte offset accounts for the
|
|
value produced by adding to pc in the first instruction
|
|
of the PLT stub. */
|
|
got_displacement = got_address - (plt_address + 8);
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT ((got_displacement & 0xf0000000) == 0);
|
|
|
|
if (elf32_arm_plt_needs_thumb_stub_p (info, arm_plt))
|
|
{
|
|
put_thumb_insn (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_plt_thumb_stub[0], ptr - 4);
|
|
put_thumb_insn (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_plt_thumb_stub[1], ptr - 2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_plt_entry[0]
|
|
| ((got_displacement & 0x0ff00000) >> 20),
|
|
ptr + 0);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_plt_entry[1]
|
|
| ((got_displacement & 0x000ff000) >> 12),
|
|
ptr+ 4);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
elf32_arm_plt_entry[2]
|
|
| (got_displacement & 0x00000fff),
|
|
ptr + 8);
|
|
#ifdef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, elf32_arm_plt_entry[3], ptr + 12);
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in the entry in the .rel(a).(i)plt section. */
|
|
rel.r_offset = got_address;
|
|
rel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
if (dynindx == -1)
|
|
{
|
|
/* .igot.plt entries use IRELATIVE relocations against SYM_VALUE.
|
|
The dynamic linker or static executable then calls SYM_VALUE
|
|
to determine the correct run-time value of the .igot.plt entry. */
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_ARM_IRELATIVE);
|
|
initial_got_entry = sym_value;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (dynindx, R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT);
|
|
initial_got_entry = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in the entry in the global offset table. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, initial_got_entry,
|
|
sgot->contents + got_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
loc = srel->contents + plt_index * RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (htab) (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Some relocations map to different relocations depending on the
|
|
target. Return the real relocation. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
arm_real_reloc_type (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals,
|
|
int r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_TARGET1:
|
|
if (globals->target1_is_rel)
|
|
return R_ARM_REL32;
|
|
else
|
|
return R_ARM_ABS32;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TARGET2:
|
|
return globals->target2_reloc;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
return r_type;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return the base VMA address which should be subtracted from real addresses
|
|
when resolving @dtpoff relocation.
|
|
This is PT_TLS segment p_vaddr. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_vma
|
|
dtpoff_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
|
|
if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return the relocation value for @tpoff relocation
|
|
if STT_TLS virtual address is ADDRESS. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_vma
|
|
tpoff (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_vma address)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
|
|
bfd_vma base;
|
|
|
|
/* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
|
|
if (htab->tls_sec == NULL)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
base = align_power ((bfd_vma) TCB_SIZE, htab->tls_sec->alignment_power);
|
|
return address - htab->tls_sec->vma + base;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Perform an R_ARM_ABS12 relocation on the field pointed to by DATA.
|
|
VALUE is the relocation value. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_reloc_status_type
|
|
elf32_arm_abs12_reloc (bfd *abfd, void *data, bfd_vma value)
|
|
{
|
|
if (value > 0xfff)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
value |= bfd_get_32 (abfd, data) & 0xfffff000;
|
|
bfd_put_32 (abfd, value, data);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Handle TLS relaxations. Relaxing is possible for symbols that use
|
|
R_ARM_GOTDESC, R_ARM_{,THM_}TLS_CALL or
|
|
R_ARM_{,THM_}TLS_DESCSEQ relocations, during a static link.
|
|
|
|
Return bfd_reloc_ok if we're done, bfd_reloc_continue if the caller
|
|
is to then call final_link_relocate. Return other values in the
|
|
case of error.
|
|
|
|
FIXME:When --emit-relocs is in effect, we'll emit relocs describing
|
|
the pre-relaxed code. It would be nice if the relocs were updated
|
|
to match the optimization. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_reloc_status_type
|
|
elf32_arm_tls_relax (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals,
|
|
bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_sec, bfd_byte *contents,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, unsigned long is_local)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long insn;
|
|
|
|
switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
|
|
{
|
|
default:
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC:
|
|
if (is_local)
|
|
insn = 0;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
if (insn & 1)
|
|
insn -= 5; /* THUMB */
|
|
else
|
|
insn -= 8; /* ARM */
|
|
}
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_continue;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
/* Thumb insn. */
|
|
insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
if ((insn & 0xff78) == 0x4478) /* add rx, pc */
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_local)
|
|
/* nop */
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0x46c0, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((insn & 0xffc0) == 0x6840) /* ldr rx,[ry,#4] */
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_local)
|
|
/* nop */
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0x46c0, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
else
|
|
/* ldr rx,[ry] */
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn & 0xf83f, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((insn & 0xff87) == 0x4780) /* blx rx */
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_local)
|
|
/* nop */
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0x46c0, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
else
|
|
/* mov r0, rx */
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0x4600 | (insn & 0x78),
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ((insn & 0xf000) == 0xf000 || (insn & 0xf800) == 0xe800)
|
|
/* It's a 32 bit instruction, fetch the rest of it for
|
|
error generation. */
|
|
insn = (insn << 16)
|
|
| bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 2);
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx):unexpected Thumb instruction '0x%x' in TLS trampoline"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_sec, (unsigned long)rel->r_offset, insn);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
/* arm insn. */
|
|
insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
if ((insn & 0xffff0ff0) == 0xe08f0000) /* add rx,pc,ry */
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_local)
|
|
/* mov rx, ry */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 0xe1a00000 | (insn & 0xffff),
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((insn & 0xfff00fff) == 0xe5900004) /* ldr rx,[ry,#4]*/
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_local)
|
|
/* nop */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 0xe1a00000, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
else
|
|
/* ldr rx,[ry] */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn & 0xfffff000,
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((insn & 0xfffffff0) == 0xe12fff30) /* blx rx */
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_local)
|
|
/* nop */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 0xe1a00000, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
else
|
|
/* mov r0, rx */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 0xe1a00000 | (insn & 0xf),
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx):unexpected ARM instruction '0x%x' in TLS trampoline"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_sec, (unsigned long)rel->r_offset, insn);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
/* GD->IE relaxation, turn the instruction into 'nop' or
|
|
'ldr r0, [pc,r0]' */
|
|
insn = is_local ? 0xe1a00000 : 0xe79f0000;
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
/* GD->IE relaxation */
|
|
if (!is_local)
|
|
/* add r0,pc; ldr r0, [r0] */
|
|
insn = 0x44786800;
|
|
else if (arch_has_thumb2_nop (globals))
|
|
/* nop.w */
|
|
insn = 0xf3af8000;
|
|
else
|
|
/* nop; nop */
|
|
insn = 0xbf00bf00;
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn >> 16, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn & 0xffff, contents + rel->r_offset + 2);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* For a given value of n, calculate the value of G_n as required to
|
|
deal with group relocations. We return it in the form of an
|
|
encoded constant-and-rotation, together with the final residual. If n is
|
|
specified as less than zero, then final_residual is filled with the
|
|
input value and no further action is performed. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_vma
|
|
calculate_group_reloc_mask (bfd_vma value, int n, bfd_vma *final_residual)
|
|
{
|
|
int current_n;
|
|
bfd_vma g_n;
|
|
bfd_vma encoded_g_n = 0;
|
|
bfd_vma residual = value; /* Also known as Y_n. */
|
|
|
|
for (current_n = 0; current_n <= n; current_n++)
|
|
{
|
|
int shift;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate which part of the value to mask. */
|
|
if (residual == 0)
|
|
shift = 0;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
int msb;
|
|
|
|
/* Determine the most significant bit in the residual and
|
|
align the resulting value to a 2-bit boundary. */
|
|
for (msb = 30; msb >= 0; msb -= 2)
|
|
if (residual & (3 << msb))
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* The desired shift is now (msb - 6), or zero, whichever
|
|
is the greater. */
|
|
shift = msb - 6;
|
|
if (shift < 0)
|
|
shift = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate g_n in 32-bit as well as encoded constant+rotation form. */
|
|
g_n = residual & (0xff << shift);
|
|
encoded_g_n = (g_n >> shift)
|
|
| ((g_n <= 0xff ? 0 : (32 - shift) / 2) << 8);
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the residual for the next time around. */
|
|
residual &= ~g_n;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
*final_residual = residual;
|
|
|
|
return encoded_g_n;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Given an ARM instruction, determine whether it is an ADD or a SUB.
|
|
Returns 1 if it is an ADD, -1 if it is a SUB, and 0 otherwise. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
identify_add_or_sub (bfd_vma insn)
|
|
{
|
|
int opcode = insn & 0x1e00000;
|
|
|
|
if (opcode == 1 << 23) /* ADD */
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
if (opcode == 1 << 22) /* SUB */
|
|
return -1;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Perform a relocation as part of a final link. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_reloc_status_type
|
|
elf32_arm_final_link_relocate (reloc_howto_type * howto,
|
|
bfd * input_bfd,
|
|
bfd * output_bfd,
|
|
asection * input_section,
|
|
bfd_byte * contents,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,
|
|
bfd_vma value,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
asection * sym_sec,
|
|
const char * sym_name,
|
|
unsigned char st_type,
|
|
enum arm_st_branch_type branch_type,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,
|
|
bfd_boolean * unresolved_reloc_p,
|
|
char ** error_message)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long r_type = howto->type;
|
|
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
|
bfd_byte * hit_data = contents + rel->r_offset;
|
|
bfd_vma * local_got_offsets;
|
|
bfd_vma * local_tlsdesc_gotents;
|
|
asection * sgot;
|
|
asection * splt;
|
|
asection * sreloc = NULL;
|
|
asection * srelgot;
|
|
bfd_vma addend;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_addend;
|
|
unsigned char dynreloc_st_type;
|
|
bfd_vma dynreloc_value;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
union gotplt_union *root_plt;
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt;
|
|
bfd_vma plt_offset;
|
|
bfd_vma gotplt_offset;
|
|
bfd_boolean has_iplt_entry;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (is_arm_elf (input_bfd));
|
|
|
|
/* Some relocation types map to different relocations depending on the
|
|
target. We pick the right one here. */
|
|
r_type = arm_real_reloc_type (globals, r_type);
|
|
|
|
/* It is possible to have linker relaxations on some TLS access
|
|
models. Update our information here. */
|
|
r_type = elf32_arm_tls_transition (info, r_type, h);
|
|
|
|
if (r_type != howto->type)
|
|
howto = elf32_arm_howto_from_type (r_type);
|
|
|
|
/* If the start address has been set, then set the EF_ARM_HASENTRY
|
|
flag. Setting this more than once is redundant, but the cost is
|
|
not too high, and it keeps the code simple.
|
|
|
|
The test is done here, rather than somewhere else, because the
|
|
start address is only set just before the final link commences.
|
|
|
|
Note - if the user deliberately sets a start address of 0, the
|
|
flag will not be set. */
|
|
if (bfd_get_start_address (output_bfd) != 0)
|
|
elf_elfheader (output_bfd)->e_flags |= EF_ARM_HASENTRY;
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
sgot = globals->root.sgot;
|
|
local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
|
|
local_tlsdesc_gotents = elf32_arm_local_tlsdesc_gotent (input_bfd);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->root.dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
srelgot = globals->root.srelgot;
|
|
else
|
|
srelgot = NULL;
|
|
|
|
r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
addend = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data) & howto->src_mask;
|
|
|
|
if (addend & ((howto->src_mask + 1) >> 1))
|
|
{
|
|
signed_addend = -1;
|
|
signed_addend &= ~ howto->src_mask;
|
|
signed_addend |= addend;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
signed_addend = addend;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
addend = signed_addend = rel->r_addend;
|
|
|
|
/* Record the symbol information that should be used in dynamic
|
|
relocations. */
|
|
dynreloc_st_type = st_type;
|
|
dynreloc_value = value;
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
dynreloc_value |= 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Find out whether the symbol has a PLT. Set ST_VALUE, BRANCH_TYPE and
|
|
VALUE appropriately for relocations that we resolve at link time. */
|
|
has_iplt_entry = FALSE;
|
|
if (elf32_arm_get_plt_info (input_bfd, eh, r_symndx, &root_plt, &arm_plt)
|
|
&& root_plt->offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
plt_offset = root_plt->offset;
|
|
gotplt_offset = arm_plt->got_offset;
|
|
|
|
if (h == NULL || eh->is_iplt)
|
|
{
|
|
has_iplt_entry = TRUE;
|
|
splt = globals->root.iplt;
|
|
|
|
/* Populate .iplt entries here, because not all of them will
|
|
be seen by finish_dynamic_symbol. The lower bit is set if
|
|
we have already populated the entry. */
|
|
if (plt_offset & 1)
|
|
plt_offset--;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_populate_plt_entry (output_bfd, info, root_plt, arm_plt,
|
|
-1, dynreloc_value);
|
|
root_plt->offset |= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Static relocations always resolve to the .iplt entry. */
|
|
st_type = STT_FUNC;
|
|
value = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ plt_offset);
|
|
branch_type = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
|
|
/* If there are non-call relocations that resolve to the .iplt
|
|
entry, then all dynamic ones must too. */
|
|
if (arm_plt->noncall_refcount != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
dynreloc_st_type = st_type;
|
|
dynreloc_value = value;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
/* We populate the .plt entry in finish_dynamic_symbol. */
|
|
splt = globals->root.splt;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
splt = NULL;
|
|
plt_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
gotplt_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_NONE:
|
|
/* We don't need to find a value for this symbol. It's just a
|
|
marker. */
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS12:
|
|
if (!globals->vxworks_p)
|
|
return elf32_arm_abs12_reloc (input_bfd, hit_data, value + addend);
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_PC24:
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32:
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32:
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
|
|
case R_ARM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_JUMP24:
|
|
case R_ARM_XPC25:
|
|
case R_ARM_PREL31:
|
|
case R_ARM_PLT32:
|
|
/* Handle relocations which should use the PLT entry. ABS32/REL32
|
|
will use the symbol's value, which may point to a PLT entry, but we
|
|
don't need to handle that here. If we created a PLT entry, all
|
|
branches in this object should go to it, except if the PLT is too
|
|
far away, in which case a long branch stub should be inserted. */
|
|
if ((r_type != R_ARM_ABS32 && r_type != R_ARM_REL32
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_ABS32_NOI && r_type != R_ARM_REL32_NOI
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_CALL
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_JUMP24
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_PLT32)
|
|
&& plt_offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we've created a .plt section, and assigned a PLT entry
|
|
to this function, it must either be a STT_GNU_IFUNC reference
|
|
or not be known to bind locally. In other cases, we should
|
|
have cleared the PLT entry by now. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (has_iplt_entry || !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h));
|
|
|
|
value = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ plt_offset);
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* When generating a shared object or relocatable executable, these
|
|
relocations are copied into the output file to be resolved at
|
|
run time. */
|
|
if ((info->shared || globals->root.is_relocatable_executable)
|
|
&& (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
|
|
&& !(globals->vxworks_p
|
|
&& strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
|
|
".tls_vars") == 0)
|
|
&& ((r_type != R_ARM_REL32 && r_type != R_ARM_REL32_NOI)
|
|
|| !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
&& (!strstr (input_section->name, STUB_SUFFIX))
|
|
&& (h == NULL
|
|
|| ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
|
|
|| h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_PC24
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_CALL
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_JUMP24
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_PREL31
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_PLT32)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
|
|
bfd_boolean skip, relocate;
|
|
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (sreloc == NULL && globals->root.dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
{
|
|
sreloc = _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_section (input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
! globals->use_rel);
|
|
|
|
if (sreloc == NULL)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
skip = FALSE;
|
|
relocate = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
outrel.r_addend = addend;
|
|
outrel.r_offset =
|
|
_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
|
|
rel->r_offset);
|
|
if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
skip = TRUE;
|
|
else if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
|
|
skip = TRUE, relocate = TRUE;
|
|
outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset);
|
|
|
|
if (skip)
|
|
memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
|
|
else if (h != NULL
|
|
&& h->dynindx != -1
|
|
&& (!info->shared
|
|
|| !info->symbolic
|
|
|| !h->def_regular))
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, r_type);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
int symbol;
|
|
|
|
/* This symbol is local, or marked to become local. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_ARM_ABS32 || r_type == R_ARM_ABS32_NOI);
|
|
if (globals->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *osec;
|
|
|
|
/* On Symbian OS, the data segment and text segement
|
|
can be relocated independently. Therefore, we
|
|
must indicate the segment to which this
|
|
relocation is relative. The BPABI allows us to
|
|
use any symbol in the right segment; we just use
|
|
the section symbol as it is convenient. (We
|
|
cannot use the symbol given by "h" directly as it
|
|
will not appear in the dynamic symbol table.)
|
|
|
|
Note that the dynamic linker ignores the section
|
|
symbol value, so we don't subtract osec->vma
|
|
from the emitted reloc addend. */
|
|
if (sym_sec)
|
|
osec = sym_sec->output_section;
|
|
else
|
|
osec = input_section->output_section;
|
|
symbol = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
|
|
if (symbol == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
|
|
|
|
if ((osec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
|
|
&& htab->data_index_section != NULL)
|
|
osec = htab->data_index_section;
|
|
else
|
|
osec = htab->text_index_section;
|
|
symbol = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
|
|
}
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (symbol != 0);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
/* On SVR4-ish systems, the dynamic loader cannot
|
|
relocate the text and data segments independently,
|
|
so the symbol does not matter. */
|
|
symbol = 0;
|
|
if (dynreloc_st_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
/* We have an STT_GNU_IFUNC symbol that doesn't resolve
|
|
to the .iplt entry. Instead, every non-call reference
|
|
must use an R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocation to obtain the
|
|
correct run-time address. */
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (symbol, R_ARM_IRELATIVE);
|
|
else
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (symbol, R_ARM_RELATIVE);
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
relocate = TRUE;
|
|
else
|
|
outrel.r_addend += dynreloc_value;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info, sreloc, &outrel);
|
|
|
|
/* If this reloc is against an external symbol, we do not want to
|
|
fiddle with the addend. Otherwise, we need to include the symbol
|
|
value so that it becomes an addend for the dynamic reloc. */
|
|
if (! relocate)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset,
|
|
dynreloc_value, (bfd_vma) 0);
|
|
}
|
|
else switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS12:
|
|
return elf32_arm_abs12_reloc (input_bfd, hit_data, value + addend);
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_XPC25: /* Arm BLX instruction. */
|
|
case R_ARM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_JUMP24:
|
|
case R_ARM_PC24: /* Arm B/BL instruction. */
|
|
case R_ARM_PLT32:
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_XPC25)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check for Arm calling Arm function. */
|
|
/* FIXME: Should we translate the instruction into a BL
|
|
instruction instead ? */
|
|
if (branch_type != ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("\%B: Warning: Arm BLX instruction targets Arm function '%s'."),
|
|
input_bfd,
|
|
h ? h->root.root.string : "(local)");
|
|
}
|
|
else if (r_type == R_ARM_PC24)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check for Arm calling Thumb function. */
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
{
|
|
if (elf32_arm_to_thumb_stub (info, sym_name, input_bfd,
|
|
output_bfd, input_section,
|
|
hit_data, sym_sec, rel->r_offset,
|
|
signed_addend, value,
|
|
error_message))
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
else
|
|
return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Check if a stub has to be inserted because the
|
|
destination is too far or we are changing mode. */
|
|
if ( r_type == R_ARM_CALL
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_JUMP24
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_PLT32)
|
|
{
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type = arm_stub_none;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *hash;
|
|
|
|
hash = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
stub_type = arm_type_of_stub (info, input_section, rel,
|
|
st_type, &branch_type,
|
|
hash, value, sym_sec,
|
|
input_bfd, sym_name);
|
|
|
|
if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The target is out of reach, so redirect the
|
|
branch to the local stub for this function. */
|
|
|
|
stub_entry = elf32_arm_get_stub_entry (input_section,
|
|
sym_sec, h,
|
|
rel, globals,
|
|
stub_type);
|
|
if (stub_entry != NULL)
|
|
value = (stub_entry->stub_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* If the call goes through a PLT entry, make sure to
|
|
check distance to the right destination address. */
|
|
if (plt_offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
value = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ plt_offset);
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
/* The PLT entry is in ARM mode, regardless of the
|
|
target function. */
|
|
branch_type = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The ARM ELF ABI says that this reloc is computed as: S - P + A
|
|
where:
|
|
S is the address of the symbol in the relocation.
|
|
P is address of the instruction being relocated.
|
|
A is the addend (extracted from the instruction) in bytes.
|
|
|
|
S is held in 'value'.
|
|
P is the base address of the section containing the
|
|
instruction plus the offset of the reloc into that
|
|
section, ie:
|
|
(input_section->output_section->vma +
|
|
input_section->output_offset +
|
|
rel->r_offset).
|
|
A is the addend, converted into bytes, ie:
|
|
(signed_addend * 4)
|
|
|
|
Note: None of these operations have knowledge of the pipeline
|
|
size of the processor, thus it is up to the assembler to
|
|
encode this information into the addend. */
|
|
value -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset);
|
|
value -= rel->r_offset;
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
value += (signed_addend << howto->size);
|
|
else
|
|
/* RELA addends do not have to be adjusted by howto->size. */
|
|
value += signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
signed_addend = value;
|
|
signed_addend >>= howto->rightshift;
|
|
|
|
/* A branch to an undefined weak symbol is turned into a jump to
|
|
the next instruction unless a PLT entry will be created.
|
|
Do the same for local undefined symbols (but not for STN_UNDEF).
|
|
The jump to the next instruction is optimized as a NOP depending
|
|
on the architecture. */
|
|
if (h ? (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
|
|
&& plt_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
: r_symndx != STN_UNDEF && bfd_is_und_section (sym_sec))
|
|
{
|
|
value = (bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data) & 0xf0000000);
|
|
|
|
if (arch_has_arm_nop (globals))
|
|
value |= 0x0320f000;
|
|
else
|
|
value |= 0x01a00000; /* Using pre-UAL nop: mov r0, r0. */
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Perform a signed range check. */
|
|
if ( signed_addend > ((bfd_signed_vma) (howto->dst_mask >> 1))
|
|
|| signed_addend < - ((bfd_signed_vma) ((howto->dst_mask + 1) >> 1)))
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
addend = (value & 2);
|
|
|
|
value = (signed_addend & howto->dst_mask)
|
|
| (bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data) & (~ howto->dst_mask));
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Set the H bit in the BLX instruction. */
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
{
|
|
if (addend)
|
|
value |= (1 << 24);
|
|
else
|
|
value &= ~(bfd_vma)(1 << 24);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Select the correct instruction (BL or BLX). */
|
|
/* Only if we are not handling a BL to a stub. In this
|
|
case, mode switching is performed by the stub. */
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB && !stub_entry)
|
|
value |= (1 << 28);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
value &= ~(bfd_vma)(1 << 28);
|
|
value |= (1 << 24);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32:
|
|
value += addend;
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
value |= 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
|
|
value += addend;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32:
|
|
value += addend;
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
value |= 1;
|
|
value -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
|
|
value += addend;
|
|
value -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_PREL31:
|
|
value -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset);
|
|
value += signed_addend;
|
|
if (! h || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check for overflow. */
|
|
if ((value ^ (value >> 1)) & (1 << 30))
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
}
|
|
value &= 0x7fffffff;
|
|
value |= (bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data) & 0x80000000);
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
value |= 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value, hit_data);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS8:
|
|
value += addend;
|
|
|
|
/* There is no way to tell whether the user intended to use a signed or
|
|
unsigned addend. When checking for overflow we accept either,
|
|
as specified by the AAELF. */
|
|
if ((long) value > 0xff || (long) value < -0x80)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_8 (input_bfd, value, hit_data);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS16:
|
|
value += addend;
|
|
|
|
/* See comment for R_ARM_ABS8. */
|
|
if ((long) value > 0xffff || (long) value < -0x8000)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, value, hit_data);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_ABS5:
|
|
/* Support ldr and str instructions for the thumb. */
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Need to refetch addend. */
|
|
addend = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data) & howto->src_mask;
|
|
/* ??? Need to determine shift amount from operand size. */
|
|
addend >>= howto->rightshift;
|
|
}
|
|
value += addend;
|
|
|
|
/* ??? Isn't value unsigned? */
|
|
if ((long) value > 0x1f || (long) value < -0x10)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
/* ??? Value needs to be properly shifted into place first. */
|
|
value |= bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data) & 0xf83f;
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, value, hit_data);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0:
|
|
/* Corresponds to: addw.w reg, pc, #offset (and similarly for subw). */
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma relocation;
|
|
|
|
insn = (bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data) << 16)
|
|
| bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data + 2);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
signed_addend = (insn & 0xff) | ((insn & 0x7000) >> 4)
|
|
| ((insn & (1 << 26)) >> 15);
|
|
if (insn & 0xf00000)
|
|
signed_addend = -signed_addend;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
relocation = value + signed_addend;
|
|
relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
value = abs (relocation);
|
|
|
|
if (value >= 0x1000)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
insn = (insn & 0xfb0f8f00) | (value & 0xff)
|
|
| ((value & 0x700) << 4)
|
|
| ((value & 0x800) << 15);
|
|
if (relocation < 0)
|
|
insn |= 0xa00000;
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn >> 16, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn & 0xffff, hit_data + 2);
|
|
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_PC8:
|
|
/* PR 10073: This reloc is not generated by the GNU toolchain,
|
|
but it is supported for compatibility with third party libraries
|
|
generated by other compilers, specifically the ARM/IAR. */
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma relocation;
|
|
|
|
insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
addend = (insn & 0x00ff) << 2;
|
|
|
|
relocation = value + addend;
|
|
relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
value = abs (relocation);
|
|
|
|
/* We do not check for overflow of this reloc. Although strictly
|
|
speaking this is incorrect, it appears to be necessary in order
|
|
to work with IAR generated relocs. Since GCC and GAS do not
|
|
generate R_ARM_THM_PC8 relocs, the lack of a check should not be
|
|
a problem for them. */
|
|
value &= 0x3fc;
|
|
|
|
insn = (insn & 0xff00) | (value >> 2);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn, hit_data);
|
|
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_PC12:
|
|
/* Corresponds to: ldr.w reg, [pc, #offset]. */
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma relocation;
|
|
|
|
insn = (bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data) << 16)
|
|
| bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data + 2);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
signed_addend = insn & 0xfff;
|
|
if (!(insn & (1 << 23)))
|
|
signed_addend = -signed_addend;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
relocation = value + signed_addend;
|
|
relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
value = abs (relocation);
|
|
|
|
if (value >= 0x1000)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
insn = (insn & 0xff7ff000) | value;
|
|
if (relocation >= 0)
|
|
insn |= (1 << 23);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn >> 16, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn & 0xffff, hit_data + 2);
|
|
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_XPC22:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
|
|
/* Thumb BL (branch long instruction). */
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma relocation;
|
|
bfd_vma reloc_sign;
|
|
bfd_boolean overflow = FALSE;
|
|
bfd_vma upper_insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_vma lower_insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data + 2);
|
|
bfd_signed_vma reloc_signed_max;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma reloc_signed_min;
|
|
bfd_vma check;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_check;
|
|
int bitsize;
|
|
const int thumb2 = using_thumb2 (globals);
|
|
|
|
/* A branch to an undefined weak symbol is turned into a jump to
|
|
the next instruction unless a PLT entry will be created.
|
|
The jump to the next instruction is optimized as a NOP.W for
|
|
Thumb-2 enabled architectures. */
|
|
if (h && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
|
|
&& plt_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
if (arch_has_thumb2_nop (globals))
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0xf3af, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0x8000, hit_data + 2);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0xe000, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, 0xbf00, hit_data + 2);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fetch the addend. We use the Thumb-2 encoding (backwards compatible
|
|
with Thumb-1) involving the J1 and J2 bits. */
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma s = (upper_insn & (1 << 10)) >> 10;
|
|
bfd_vma upper = upper_insn & 0x3ff;
|
|
bfd_vma lower = lower_insn & 0x7ff;
|
|
bfd_vma j1 = (lower_insn & (1 << 13)) >> 13;
|
|
bfd_vma j2 = (lower_insn & (1 << 11)) >> 11;
|
|
bfd_vma i1 = j1 ^ s ? 0 : 1;
|
|
bfd_vma i2 = j2 ^ s ? 0 : 1;
|
|
|
|
addend = (i1 << 23) | (i2 << 22) | (upper << 12) | (lower << 1);
|
|
/* Sign extend. */
|
|
addend = (addend | ((s ? 0 : 1) << 24)) - (1 << 24);
|
|
|
|
signed_addend = addend;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_XPC22)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check for Thumb to Thumb call. */
|
|
/* FIXME: Should we translate the instruction into a BL
|
|
instruction instead ? */
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B: Warning: Thumb BLX instruction targets thumb function '%s'."),
|
|
input_bfd,
|
|
h ? h->root.root.string : "(local)");
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* If it is not a call to Thumb, assume call to Arm.
|
|
If it is a call relative to a section name, then it is not a
|
|
function call at all, but rather a long jump. Calls through
|
|
the PLT do not require stubs. */
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM && plt_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
if (globals->use_blx && r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Convert BL to BLX. */
|
|
lower_insn = (lower_insn & ~0x1000) | 0x0800;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (( r_type != R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
&& (r_type != R_ARM_THM_JUMP24))
|
|
{
|
|
if (elf32_thumb_to_arm_stub
|
|
(info, sym_name, input_bfd, output_bfd, input_section,
|
|
hit_data, sym_sec, rel->r_offset, signed_addend, value,
|
|
error_message))
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
else
|
|
return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB
|
|
&& globals->use_blx
|
|
&& r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Make sure this is a BL. */
|
|
lower_insn |= 0x1800;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type = arm_stub_none;
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL || r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP24)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Check if a stub has to be inserted because the destination
|
|
is too far. */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *hash;
|
|
|
|
hash = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
|
|
stub_type = arm_type_of_stub (info, input_section, rel,
|
|
st_type, &branch_type,
|
|
hash, value, sym_sec,
|
|
input_bfd, sym_name);
|
|
|
|
if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The target is out of reach or we are changing modes, so
|
|
redirect the branch to the local stub for this
|
|
function. */
|
|
stub_entry = elf32_arm_get_stub_entry (input_section,
|
|
sym_sec, h,
|
|
rel, globals,
|
|
stub_type);
|
|
if (stub_entry != NULL)
|
|
value = (stub_entry->stub_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
|
|
|
|
/* If this call becomes a call to Arm, force BLX. */
|
|
if (globals->use_blx && (r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL))
|
|
{
|
|
if ((stub_entry
|
|
&& !arm_stub_is_thumb (stub_entry->stub_type))
|
|
|| branch_type != ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
lower_insn = (lower_insn & ~0x1000) | 0x0800;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Handle calls via the PLT. */
|
|
if (stub_type == arm_stub_none && plt_offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
value = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ plt_offset);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_blx && r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If the Thumb BLX instruction is available, convert
|
|
the BL to a BLX instruction to call the ARM-mode
|
|
PLT entry. */
|
|
lower_insn = (lower_insn & ~0x1000) | 0x0800;
|
|
branch_type = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Target the Thumb stub before the ARM PLT entry. */
|
|
value -= PLT_THUMB_STUB_SIZE;
|
|
branch_type = ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB;
|
|
}
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
relocation = value + signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
check = relocation >> howto->rightshift;
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a signed value, the rightshift just dropped
|
|
leading 1 bits (assuming twos complement). */
|
|
if ((bfd_signed_vma) relocation >= 0)
|
|
signed_check = check;
|
|
else
|
|
signed_check = check | ~((bfd_vma) -1 >> howto->rightshift);
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the permissable maximum and minimum values for
|
|
this relocation according to whether we're relocating for
|
|
Thumb-2 or not. */
|
|
bitsize = howto->bitsize;
|
|
if (!thumb2)
|
|
bitsize -= 2;
|
|
reloc_signed_max = (1 << (bitsize - 1)) - 1;
|
|
reloc_signed_min = ~reloc_signed_max;
|
|
|
|
/* Assumes two's complement. */
|
|
if (signed_check > reloc_signed_max || signed_check < reloc_signed_min)
|
|
overflow = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if ((lower_insn & 0x5000) == 0x4000)
|
|
/* For a BLX instruction, make sure that the relocation is rounded up
|
|
to a word boundary. This follows the semantics of the instruction
|
|
which specifies that bit 1 of the target address will come from bit
|
|
1 of the base address. */
|
|
relocation = (relocation + 2) & ~ 3;
|
|
|
|
/* Put RELOCATION back into the insn. Assumes two's complement.
|
|
We use the Thumb-2 encoding, which is safe even if dealing with
|
|
a Thumb-1 instruction by virtue of our overflow check above. */
|
|
reloc_sign = (signed_check < 0) ? 1 : 0;
|
|
upper_insn = (upper_insn & ~(bfd_vma) 0x7ff)
|
|
| ((relocation >> 12) & 0x3ff)
|
|
| (reloc_sign << 10);
|
|
lower_insn = (lower_insn & ~(bfd_vma) 0x2fff)
|
|
| (((!((relocation >> 23) & 1)) ^ reloc_sign) << 13)
|
|
| (((!((relocation >> 22) & 1)) ^ reloc_sign) << 11)
|
|
| ((relocation >> 1) & 0x7ff);
|
|
|
|
/* Put the relocated value back in the object file: */
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, upper_insn, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, lower_insn, hit_data + 2);
|
|
|
|
return (overflow ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
|
|
/* Thumb32 conditional branch instruction. */
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma relocation;
|
|
bfd_boolean overflow = FALSE;
|
|
bfd_vma upper_insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_vma lower_insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data + 2);
|
|
bfd_signed_vma reloc_signed_max = 0xffffe;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma reloc_signed_min = -0x100000;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_check;
|
|
|
|
/* Need to refetch the addend, reconstruct the top three bits,
|
|
and squish the two 11 bit pieces together. */
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma S = (upper_insn & 0x0400) >> 10;
|
|
bfd_vma upper = (upper_insn & 0x003f);
|
|
bfd_vma J1 = (lower_insn & 0x2000) >> 13;
|
|
bfd_vma J2 = (lower_insn & 0x0800) >> 11;
|
|
bfd_vma lower = (lower_insn & 0x07ff);
|
|
|
|
upper |= J1 << 6;
|
|
upper |= J2 << 7;
|
|
upper |= (!S) << 8;
|
|
upper -= 0x0100; /* Sign extend. */
|
|
|
|
addend = (upper << 12) | (lower << 1);
|
|
signed_addend = addend;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Handle calls via the PLT. */
|
|
if (plt_offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
value = (splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ splt->output_offset
|
|
+ plt_offset);
|
|
/* Target the Thumb stub before the ARM PLT entry. */
|
|
value -= PLT_THUMB_STUB_SIZE;
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* ??? Should handle interworking? GCC might someday try to
|
|
use this for tail calls. */
|
|
|
|
relocation = value + signed_addend;
|
|
relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
signed_check = (bfd_signed_vma) relocation;
|
|
|
|
if (signed_check > reloc_signed_max || signed_check < reloc_signed_min)
|
|
overflow = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Put RELOCATION back into the insn. */
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma S = (relocation & 0x00100000) >> 20;
|
|
bfd_vma J2 = (relocation & 0x00080000) >> 19;
|
|
bfd_vma J1 = (relocation & 0x00040000) >> 18;
|
|
bfd_vma hi = (relocation & 0x0003f000) >> 12;
|
|
bfd_vma lo = (relocation & 0x00000ffe) >> 1;
|
|
|
|
upper_insn = (upper_insn & 0xfbc0) | (S << 10) | hi;
|
|
lower_insn = (lower_insn & 0xd000) | (J1 << 13) | (J2 << 11) | lo;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Put the relocated value back in the object file: */
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, upper_insn, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, lower_insn, hit_data + 2);
|
|
|
|
return (overflow ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP11:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP8:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP6:
|
|
/* Thumb B (branch) instruction). */
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma relocation;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma reloc_signed_max = (1 << (howto->bitsize - 1)) - 1;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma reloc_signed_min = ~ reloc_signed_max;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_check;
|
|
|
|
/* CZB cannot jump backward. */
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP6)
|
|
reloc_signed_min = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Need to refetch addend. */
|
|
addend = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data) & howto->src_mask;
|
|
if (addend & ((howto->src_mask + 1) >> 1))
|
|
{
|
|
signed_addend = -1;
|
|
signed_addend &= ~ howto->src_mask;
|
|
signed_addend |= addend;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
signed_addend = addend;
|
|
/* The value in the insn has been right shifted. We need to
|
|
undo this, so that we can perform the address calculation
|
|
in terms of bytes. */
|
|
signed_addend <<= howto->rightshift;
|
|
}
|
|
relocation = value + signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
relocation >>= howto->rightshift;
|
|
signed_check = relocation;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP6)
|
|
relocation = ((relocation & 0x0020) << 4) | ((relocation & 0x001f) << 3);
|
|
else
|
|
relocation &= howto->dst_mask;
|
|
relocation |= (bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data) & (~ howto->dst_mask));
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, relocation, hit_data);
|
|
|
|
/* Assumes two's complement. */
|
|
if (signed_check > reloc_signed_max || signed_check < reloc_signed_min)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PCREL7_0:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PCREL15_8:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PCREL23_15:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn;
|
|
bfd_vma relocation;
|
|
|
|
insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Extract the addend. */
|
|
addend = (insn & 0xff) << ((insn & 0xf00) >> 7);
|
|
signed_addend = addend;
|
|
}
|
|
relocation = value + signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset);
|
|
insn = (insn & ~0xfff)
|
|
| ((howto->bitpos << 7) & 0xf00)
|
|
| ((relocation >> howto->bitpos) & 0xff);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value, hit_data);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT:
|
|
case R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY:
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_GOTOFF32:
|
|
/* Relocation is relative to the start of the
|
|
global offset table. */
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
|
|
if (sgot == NULL)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
|
|
/* If we are addressing a Thumb function, we need to adjust the
|
|
address by one, so that attempts to call the function pointer will
|
|
correctly interpret it as Thumb code. */
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
value += 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Note that sgot->output_offset is not involved in this
|
|
calculation. We always want the start of .got. If we
|
|
define _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE in a different way, as is
|
|
permitted by the ABI, we might have to change this
|
|
calculation. */
|
|
value -= sgot->output_section->vma;
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_GOTPC:
|
|
/* Use global offset table as symbol value. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (sgot == NULL)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
value = sgot->output_section->vma;
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_GOT32:
|
|
case R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
|
|
/* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
|
|
global offset table. */
|
|
if (sgot == NULL)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
|
|
if (dynreloc_st_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
|
&& plt_offset != (bfd_vma) -1
|
|
&& (h == NULL || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
|
|
{
|
|
/* We have a relocation against a locally-binding STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
|
symbol, and the relocation resolves directly to the runtime
|
|
target rather than to the .iplt entry. This means that any
|
|
.got entry would be the same value as the .igot.plt entry,
|
|
so there's no point creating both. */
|
|
sgot = globals->root.igotplt;
|
|
value = sgot->output_offset + gotplt_offset;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (h != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma off;
|
|
|
|
off = h->got.offset;
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (off != (bfd_vma) -1);
|
|
if ((off & 1) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* We have already processsed one GOT relocation against
|
|
this symbol. */
|
|
off &= ~1;
|
|
if (globals->root.dynamic_sections_created
|
|
&& !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
|
|
|
|
if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
{
|
|
/* If the symbol doesn't resolve locally in a static
|
|
object, we have an undefined reference. If the
|
|
symbol doesn't resolve locally in a dynamic object,
|
|
it should be resolved by the dynamic linker. */
|
|
if (globals->root.dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
{
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_ARM_GLOB_DAT);
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
outrel.r_info = 0;
|
|
outrel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (dynreloc_st_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_ARM_IRELATIVE);
|
|
else if (info->shared)
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_ARM_RELATIVE);
|
|
else
|
|
outrel.r_info = 0;
|
|
outrel.r_addend = dynreloc_value;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The GOT entry is initialized to zero by default.
|
|
See if we should install a different value. */
|
|
if (outrel.r_addend != 0
|
|
&& (outrel.r_info == 0 || globals->use_rel))
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend,
|
|
sgot->contents + off);
|
|
outrel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (outrel.r_info != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ sgot->output_offset
|
|
+ off);
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info, srelgot, &outrel);
|
|
}
|
|
h->got.offset |= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
value = sgot->output_offset + off;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma off;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (local_got_offsets != NULL &&
|
|
local_got_offsets[r_symndx] != (bfd_vma) -1);
|
|
|
|
off = local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
|
|
|
|
/* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
|
|
least significant bit to record whether we have already
|
|
generated the necessary reloc. */
|
|
if ((off & 1) != 0)
|
|
off &= ~1;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, dynreloc_value, sgot->contents + off);
|
|
|
|
if (info->shared || dynreloc_st_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
|
|
|
|
outrel.r_addend = addend + dynreloc_value;
|
|
outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ sgot->output_offset
|
|
+ off);
|
|
if (dynreloc_st_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_ARM_IRELATIVE);
|
|
else
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_ARM_RELATIVE);
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info, srelgot, &outrel);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
local_got_offsets[r_symndx] |= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
value = sgot->output_offset + off;
|
|
}
|
|
if (r_type != R_ARM_GOT32)
|
|
value += sgot->output_section->vma;
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:
|
|
value = value - dtpoff_base (info);
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma off;
|
|
|
|
if (sgot == NULL)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
off = globals->tls_ldm_got.offset;
|
|
|
|
if ((off & 1) != 0)
|
|
off &= ~1;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we don't know the module number, create a relocation
|
|
for it. */
|
|
if (info->shared)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
|
|
|
|
if (srelgot == NULL)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
outrel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ sgot->output_offset + off);
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend,
|
|
sgot->contents + off);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info, srelgot, &outrel);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 1, sgot->contents + off);
|
|
|
|
globals->tls_ldm_got.offset |= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
value = sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + off
|
|
- (input_section->output_section->vma + input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GD32:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_IE32:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma off, offplt;
|
|
int indx = 0;
|
|
char tls_type;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_boolean dyn;
|
|
dyn = globals->root.dynamic_sections_created;
|
|
if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
|
|
&& (!info->shared
|
|
|| !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
|
|
{
|
|
*unresolved_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
indx = h->dynindx;
|
|
}
|
|
off = h->got.offset;
|
|
offplt = elf32_arm_hash_entry (h)->tlsdesc_got;
|
|
tls_type = ((struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_type;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (local_got_offsets != NULL);
|
|
off = local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
|
|
offplt = local_tlsdesc_gotents[r_symndx];
|
|
tls_type = elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Linker relaxations happens from one of the
|
|
R_ARM_{GOTDESC,CALL,DESCSEQ} relocations to IE or LE. */
|
|
if (ELF32_R_TYPE(rel->r_info) != r_type)
|
|
tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (tls_type != GOT_UNKNOWN);
|
|
|
|
if ((off & 1) != 0)
|
|
off &= ~1;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
|
|
int cur_off = off;
|
|
|
|
/* The GOT entries have not been initialized yet. Do it
|
|
now, and emit any relocations. If both an IE GOT and a
|
|
GD GOT are necessary, we emit the GD first. */
|
|
|
|
if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
|
|
&& (h == NULL
|
|
|| ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
|
|
|| h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
|
|
{
|
|
need_relocs = TRUE;
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (srelgot != NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_byte *loc;
|
|
|
|
/* We should have relaxed, unless this is an undefined
|
|
weak symbol. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT ((h && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
|
|
|| info->shared);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (globals->sgotplt_jump_table_size + offplt + 8
|
|
<= globals->root.sgotplt->size);
|
|
|
|
outrel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
outrel.r_offset = (globals->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ globals->root.sgotplt->output_offset
|
|
+ offplt
|
|
+ globals->sgotplt_jump_table_size);
|
|
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_ARM_TLS_DESC);
|
|
sreloc = globals->root.srelplt;
|
|
loc = sreloc->contents;
|
|
loc += globals->next_tls_desc_index++ * RELOC_SIZE (globals);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (loc + RELOC_SIZE (globals)
|
|
<= sreloc->contents + sreloc->size);
|
|
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (globals) (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
|
|
|
|
/* For globals, the first word in the relocation gets
|
|
the relocation index and the top bit set, or zero,
|
|
if we're binding now. For locals, it gets the
|
|
symbol's offset in the tls section. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
|
|
!h ? value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma
|
|
: info->flags & DF_BIND_NOW ? 0
|
|
: 0x80000000 | ELF32_R_SYM (outrel.r_info),
|
|
globals->root.sgotplt->contents + offplt +
|
|
globals->sgotplt_jump_table_size);
|
|
|
|
/* Second word in the relocation is always zero. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0,
|
|
globals->root.sgotplt->contents + offplt +
|
|
globals->sgotplt_jump_table_size + 4);
|
|
}
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
|
|
{
|
|
if (need_relocs)
|
|
{
|
|
outrel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ sgot->output_offset
|
|
+ cur_off);
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend,
|
|
sgot->contents + cur_off);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info, srelgot, &outrel);
|
|
|
|
if (indx == 0)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, value - dtpoff_base (info),
|
|
sgot->contents + cur_off + 4);
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
outrel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx,
|
|
R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32);
|
|
outrel.r_offset += 4;
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend,
|
|
sgot->contents + cur_off + 4);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info,
|
|
srelgot, &outrel);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we are not emitting relocations for a
|
|
general dynamic reference, then we must be in a
|
|
static link or an executable link with the
|
|
symbol binding locally. Mark it as belonging
|
|
to module 1, the executable. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 1,
|
|
sgot->contents + cur_off);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, value - dtpoff_base (info),
|
|
sgot->contents + cur_off + 4);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cur_off += 8;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
|
|
{
|
|
if (need_relocs)
|
|
{
|
|
if (indx == 0)
|
|
outrel.r_addend = value - dtpoff_base (info);
|
|
else
|
|
outrel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ sgot->output_offset
|
|
+ cur_off);
|
|
outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend,
|
|
sgot->contents + cur_off);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info, srelgot, &outrel);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, tpoff (info, value),
|
|
sgot->contents + cur_off);
|
|
cur_off += 4;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
h->got.offset |= 1;
|
|
else
|
|
local_got_offsets[r_symndx] |= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) && r_type != R_ARM_TLS_GD32)
|
|
off += 8;
|
|
else if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC)
|
|
off = offplt;
|
|
|
|
if (ELF32_R_TYPE(rel->r_info) == R_ARM_TLS_CALL
|
|
|| ELF32_R_TYPE(rel->r_info) == R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma offset;
|
|
enum elf32_arm_stub_type stub_type
|
|
= arm_type_of_stub (info, input_section, rel,
|
|
st_type, &branch_type,
|
|
(struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *)h,
|
|
globals->tls_trampoline, globals->root.splt,
|
|
input_bfd, sym_name);
|
|
|
|
if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry
|
|
= elf32_arm_get_stub_entry
|
|
(input_section, globals->root.splt, 0, rel,
|
|
globals, stub_type);
|
|
offset = (stub_entry->stub_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
offset = (globals->root.splt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ globals->root.splt->output_offset
|
|
+ globals->tls_trampoline);
|
|
|
|
if (ELF32_R_TYPE(rel->r_info) == R_ARM_TLS_CALL)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long inst;
|
|
|
|
offset -= (input_section->output_section->vma +
|
|
input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset + 8);
|
|
|
|
inst = offset >> 2;
|
|
inst &= 0x00ffffff;
|
|
value = inst | (globals->use_blx ? 0xfa000000 : 0xeb000000);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Thumb blx encodes the offset in a complicated
|
|
fashion. */
|
|
unsigned upper_insn, lower_insn;
|
|
unsigned neg;
|
|
|
|
offset -= (input_section->output_section->vma +
|
|
input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset + 4);
|
|
|
|
/* Round up the offset to a word boundary */
|
|
offset = (offset + 2) & ~2;
|
|
neg = offset < 0;
|
|
upper_insn = (0xf000
|
|
| ((offset >> 12) & 0x3ff)
|
|
| (neg << 10));
|
|
lower_insn = (0xc000
|
|
| (((!((offset >> 23) & 1)) ^ neg) << 13)
|
|
| (((!((offset >> 22) & 1)) ^ neg) << 11)
|
|
| ((offset >> 1) & 0x7ff));
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, upper_insn, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, lower_insn, hit_data + 2);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/* These relocations needs special care, as besides the fact
|
|
they point somewhere in .gotplt, the addend must be
|
|
adjusted accordingly depending on the type of instruction
|
|
we refer to */
|
|
else if ((r_type == R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC))
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long data, insn;
|
|
unsigned thumb;
|
|
|
|
data = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
thumb = data & 1;
|
|
data &= ~1u;
|
|
|
|
if (thumb)
|
|
{
|
|
insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset - data);
|
|
if ((insn & 0xf000) == 0xf000 || (insn & 0xf800) == 0xe800)
|
|
insn = (insn << 16)
|
|
| bfd_get_16 (input_bfd,
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset - data + 2);
|
|
if ((insn & 0xf800c000) == 0xf000c000)
|
|
/* bl/blx */
|
|
value = -6;
|
|
else if ((insn & 0xffffff00) == 0x4400)
|
|
/* add */
|
|
value = -5;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx):unexpected Thumb instruction '0x%x' referenced by TLS_GOTDESC"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(unsigned long)rel->r_offset, insn);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset - data);
|
|
|
|
switch (insn >> 24)
|
|
{
|
|
case 0xeb: /* bl */
|
|
case 0xfa: /* blx */
|
|
value = -4;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 0xe0: /* add */
|
|
value = -8;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx):unexpected ARM instruction '0x%x' referenced by TLS_GOTDESC"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(unsigned long)rel->r_offset, insn);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
value += ((globals->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ globals->root.sgotplt->output_offset + off)
|
|
- (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset)
|
|
+ globals->sgotplt_jump_table_size);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
value = ((globals->root.sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ globals->root.sgot->output_offset + off)
|
|
- (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset));
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_LE32:
|
|
if (info->shared)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): R_ARM_TLS_LE32 relocation not permitted in shared object"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset, howto->name);
|
|
return (bfd_reloc_status_type) FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
value = tpoff (info, value);
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel->r_offset, value,
|
|
rel->r_addend);
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_V4BX:
|
|
if (globals->fix_v4bx)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
|
|
/* Ensure that we have a BX instruction. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT ((insn & 0x0ffffff0) == 0x012fff10);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->fix_v4bx == 2 && (insn & 0xf) != 0xf)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Branch to veneer. */
|
|
bfd_vma glue_addr;
|
|
glue_addr = elf32_arm_bx_glue (info, insn & 0xf);
|
|
glue_addr -= input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset
|
|
+ rel->r_offset + 8;
|
|
insn = (insn & 0xf0000000) | 0x0a000000
|
|
| ((glue_addr >> 2) & 0x00ffffff);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Preserve Rm (lowest four bits) and the condition code
|
|
(highest four bits). Other bits encode MOV PC,Rm. */
|
|
insn = (insn & 0xf000000f) | 0x01a0f000;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, hit_data);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
|
|
/* Until we properly support segment-base-relative addressing then
|
|
we assume the segment base to be zero, as for the group relocations.
|
|
Thus R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC has the same semantics as R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC
|
|
and R_ARM_MOVT_BREL has the same semantics as R_ARM_MOVT_ABS. */
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_BREL:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_BREL:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
addend = ((insn >> 4) & 0xf000) | (insn & 0xfff);
|
|
signed_addend = (addend ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
value += signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC || r_type == R_ARM_MOVT_PREL)
|
|
value -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_MOVW_BREL && value >= 0x10000)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
value |= 1;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_MOVT_ABS || r_type == R_ARM_MOVT_PREL
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_MOVT_BREL)
|
|
value >>= 16;
|
|
|
|
insn &= 0xfff0f000;
|
|
insn |= value & 0xfff;
|
|
insn |= (value & 0xf000) << 4;
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, hit_data);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
|
|
/* Until we properly support segment-base-relative addressing then
|
|
we assume the segment base to be zero, as for the above relocations.
|
|
Thus R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC has the same semantics as
|
|
R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC and R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL has the same semantics
|
|
as R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS. */
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn;
|
|
|
|
insn = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data) << 16;
|
|
insn |= bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, hit_data + 2);
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
addend = ((insn >> 4) & 0xf000)
|
|
| ((insn >> 15) & 0x0800)
|
|
| ((insn >> 4) & 0x0700)
|
|
| (insn & 0x00ff);
|
|
signed_addend = (addend ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
value += signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC || r_type == R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL)
|
|
value -= (input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL && value >= 0x10000)
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
value |= 1;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS || r_type == R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL)
|
|
value >>= 16;
|
|
|
|
insn &= 0xfbf08f00;
|
|
insn |= (value & 0xf000) << 4;
|
|
insn |= (value & 0x0800) << 15;
|
|
insn |= (value & 0x0700) << 4;
|
|
insn |= (value & 0x00ff);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn >> 16, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, insn & 0xffff, hit_data + 2);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_vma pc = input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset;
|
|
/* sb should be the origin of the *segment* containing the symbol.
|
|
It is not clear how to obtain this OS-dependent value, so we
|
|
make an arbitrary choice of zero. */
|
|
bfd_vma sb = 0;
|
|
bfd_vma residual;
|
|
bfd_vma g_n;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_value;
|
|
int group = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Determine which group of bits to select. */
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:
|
|
group = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:
|
|
group = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:
|
|
group = 2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If REL, extract the addend from the insn. If RELA, it will
|
|
have already been fetched for us. */
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
int negative;
|
|
bfd_vma constant = insn & 0xff;
|
|
bfd_vma rotation = (insn & 0xf00) >> 8;
|
|
|
|
if (rotation == 0)
|
|
signed_addend = constant;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* Compensate for the fact that in the instruction, the
|
|
rotation is stored in multiples of 2 bits. */
|
|
rotation *= 2;
|
|
|
|
/* Rotate "constant" right by "rotation" bits. */
|
|
signed_addend = (constant >> rotation) |
|
|
(constant << (8 * sizeof (bfd_vma) - rotation));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine if the instruction is an ADD or a SUB.
|
|
(For REL, this determines the sign of the addend.) */
|
|
negative = identify_add_or_sub (insn);
|
|
if (negative == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): Only ADD or SUB instructions are allowed for ALU group relocations"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset, howto->name);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
signed_addend *= negative;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the value (X) to go in the place. */
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2)
|
|
/* PC relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - pc + signed_addend;
|
|
else
|
|
/* Section base relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - sb + signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
/* If the target symbol is a Thumb function, then set the
|
|
Thumb bit in the address. */
|
|
if (branch_type == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
signed_value |= 1;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the value of the relevant G_n, in encoded
|
|
constant-with-rotation format. */
|
|
g_n = calculate_group_reloc_mask (abs (signed_value), group,
|
|
&residual);
|
|
|
|
/* Check for overflow if required. */
|
|
if ((r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2) && residual != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): Overflow whilst splitting 0x%lx for group relocation %s"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset, abs (signed_value), howto->name);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mask out the value and the ADD/SUB part of the opcode; take care
|
|
not to destroy the S bit. */
|
|
insn &= 0xff1ff000;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the opcode according to whether the value to go in the
|
|
place is negative. */
|
|
if (signed_value < 0)
|
|
insn |= 1 << 22;
|
|
else
|
|
insn |= 1 << 23;
|
|
|
|
/* Encode the offset. */
|
|
insn |= g_n;
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, hit_data);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_vma pc = input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset;
|
|
bfd_vma sb = 0; /* See note above. */
|
|
bfd_vma residual;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_value;
|
|
int group = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Determine which groups of bits to calculate. */
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0:
|
|
group = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1:
|
|
group = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2:
|
|
group = 2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If REL, extract the addend from the insn. If RELA, it will
|
|
have already been fetched for us. */
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
int negative = (insn & (1 << 23)) ? 1 : -1;
|
|
signed_addend = negative * (insn & 0xfff);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the value (X) to go in the place. */
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2)
|
|
/* PC relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - pc + signed_addend;
|
|
else
|
|
/* Section base relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - sb + signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the value of the relevant G_{n-1} to obtain
|
|
the residual at that stage. */
|
|
calculate_group_reloc_mask (abs (signed_value), group - 1, &residual);
|
|
|
|
/* Check for overflow. */
|
|
if (residual >= 0x1000)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): Overflow whilst splitting 0x%lx for group relocation %s"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset, abs (signed_value), howto->name);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mask out the value and U bit. */
|
|
insn &= 0xff7ff000;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the U bit if the value to go in the place is non-negative. */
|
|
if (signed_value >= 0)
|
|
insn |= 1 << 23;
|
|
|
|
/* Encode the offset. */
|
|
insn |= residual;
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, hit_data);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_vma pc = input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset;
|
|
bfd_vma sb = 0; /* See note above. */
|
|
bfd_vma residual;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_value;
|
|
int group = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Determine which groups of bits to calculate. */
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0:
|
|
group = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1:
|
|
group = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2:
|
|
group = 2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If REL, extract the addend from the insn. If RELA, it will
|
|
have already been fetched for us. */
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
int negative = (insn & (1 << 23)) ? 1 : -1;
|
|
signed_addend = negative * (((insn & 0xf00) >> 4) + (insn & 0xf));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the value (X) to go in the place. */
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2)
|
|
/* PC relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - pc + signed_addend;
|
|
else
|
|
/* Section base relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - sb + signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the value of the relevant G_{n-1} to obtain
|
|
the residual at that stage. */
|
|
calculate_group_reloc_mask (abs (signed_value), group - 1, &residual);
|
|
|
|
/* Check for overflow. */
|
|
if (residual >= 0x100)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): Overflow whilst splitting 0x%lx for group relocation %s"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset, abs (signed_value), howto->name);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mask out the value and U bit. */
|
|
insn &= 0xff7ff0f0;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the U bit if the value to go in the place is non-negative. */
|
|
if (signed_value >= 0)
|
|
insn |= 1 << 23;
|
|
|
|
/* Encode the offset. */
|
|
insn |= ((residual & 0xf0) << 4) | (residual & 0xf);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, hit_data);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, hit_data);
|
|
bfd_vma pc = input_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ input_section->output_offset + rel->r_offset;
|
|
bfd_vma sb = 0; /* See note above. */
|
|
bfd_vma residual;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma signed_value;
|
|
int group = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* Determine which groups of bits to calculate. */
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0:
|
|
group = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1:
|
|
group = 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2:
|
|
case R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2:
|
|
group = 2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If REL, extract the addend from the insn. If RELA, it will
|
|
have already been fetched for us. */
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
int negative = (insn & (1 << 23)) ? 1 : -1;
|
|
signed_addend = negative * ((insn & 0xff) << 2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the value (X) to go in the place. */
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2)
|
|
/* PC relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - pc + signed_addend;
|
|
else
|
|
/* Section base relative. */
|
|
signed_value = value - sb + signed_addend;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the value of the relevant G_{n-1} to obtain
|
|
the residual at that stage. */
|
|
calculate_group_reloc_mask (abs (signed_value), group - 1, &residual);
|
|
|
|
/* Check for overflow. (The absolute value to go in the place must be
|
|
divisible by four and, after having been divided by four, must
|
|
fit in eight bits.) */
|
|
if ((residual & 0x3) != 0 || residual >= 0x400)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): Overflow whilst splitting 0x%lx for group relocation %s"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset, abs (signed_value), howto->name);
|
|
return bfd_reloc_overflow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mask out the value and U bit. */
|
|
insn &= 0xff7fff00;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the U bit if the value to go in the place is non-negative. */
|
|
if (signed_value >= 0)
|
|
insn |= 1 << 23;
|
|
|
|
/* Encode the offset. */
|
|
insn |= residual >> 2;
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, hit_data);
|
|
}
|
|
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add INCREMENT to the reloc (of type HOWTO) at ADDRESS. */
|
|
static void
|
|
arm_add_to_rel (bfd * abfd,
|
|
bfd_byte * address,
|
|
reloc_howto_type * howto,
|
|
bfd_signed_vma increment)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma addend;
|
|
|
|
if (howto->type == R_ARM_THM_CALL
|
|
|| howto->type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP24)
|
|
{
|
|
int upper_insn, lower_insn;
|
|
int upper, lower;
|
|
|
|
upper_insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, address);
|
|
lower_insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, address + 2);
|
|
upper = upper_insn & 0x7ff;
|
|
lower = lower_insn & 0x7ff;
|
|
|
|
addend = (upper << 12) | (lower << 1);
|
|
addend += increment;
|
|
addend >>= 1;
|
|
|
|
upper_insn = (upper_insn & 0xf800) | ((addend >> 11) & 0x7ff);
|
|
lower_insn = (lower_insn & 0xf800) | (addend & 0x7ff);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (abfd, (bfd_vma) upper_insn, address);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (abfd, (bfd_vma) lower_insn, address + 2);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma contents;
|
|
|
|
contents = bfd_get_32 (abfd, address);
|
|
|
|
/* Get the (signed) value from the instruction. */
|
|
addend = contents & howto->src_mask;
|
|
if (addend & ((howto->src_mask + 1) >> 1))
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma mask;
|
|
|
|
mask = -1;
|
|
mask &= ~ howto->src_mask;
|
|
addend |= mask;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add in the increment, (which is a byte value). */
|
|
switch (howto->type)
|
|
{
|
|
default:
|
|
addend += increment;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_PC24:
|
|
case R_ARM_PLT32:
|
|
case R_ARM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_JUMP24:
|
|
addend <<= howto->size;
|
|
addend += increment;
|
|
|
|
/* Should we check for overflow here ? */
|
|
|
|
/* Drop any undesired bits. */
|
|
addend >>= howto->rightshift;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
contents = (contents & ~ howto->dst_mask) | (addend & howto->dst_mask);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (abfd, contents, address);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#define IS_ARM_TLS_RELOC(R_TYPE) \
|
|
((R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_GD32 \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_LDO32 \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_LDM32 \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32 \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32 \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_LE32 \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_IE32 \
|
|
|| IS_ARM_TLS_GNU_RELOC (R_TYPE))
|
|
|
|
/* Specific set of relocations for the gnu tls dialect. */
|
|
#define IS_ARM_TLS_GNU_RELOC(R_TYPE) \
|
|
((R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_CALL \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ \
|
|
|| (R_TYPE) == R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ)
|
|
|
|
/* Relocate an ARM ELF section. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_relocate_section (bfd * output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
bfd * input_bfd,
|
|
asection * input_section,
|
|
bfd_byte * contents,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,
|
|
asection ** local_sections)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
|
|
const char *name;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
symtab_hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
|
|
sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
|
|
|
|
rel = relocs;
|
|
relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
|
|
for (; rel < relend; rel++)
|
|
{
|
|
int r_type;
|
|
reloc_howto_type * howto;
|
|
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym * sym;
|
|
asection * sec;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * h;
|
|
bfd_vma relocation;
|
|
bfd_reloc_status_type r;
|
|
arelent bfd_reloc;
|
|
char sym_type;
|
|
bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
|
|
char *error_message = NULL;
|
|
|
|
r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
|
|
r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
|
|
r_type = arm_real_reloc_type (globals, r_type);
|
|
|
|
if ( r_type == R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
bfd_reloc.howto = elf32_arm_howto_from_type (r_type);
|
|
howto = bfd_reloc.howto;
|
|
|
|
h = NULL;
|
|
sym = NULL;
|
|
sec = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
|
|
{
|
|
sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
|
|
sym_type = ELF32_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
|
|
sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
|
|
|
|
/* An object file might have a reference to a local
|
|
undefined symbol. This is a daft object file, but we
|
|
should at least do something about it. V4BX & NONE
|
|
relocations do not use the symbol and are explicitly
|
|
allowed to use the undefined symbol, so allow those.
|
|
Likewise for relocations against STN_UNDEF. */
|
|
if (r_type != R_ARM_V4BX
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_NONE
|
|
&& r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
|
|
&& bfd_is_und_section (sec)
|
|
&& ELF_ST_BIND (sym->st_info) != STB_WEAK)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!info->callbacks->undefined_symbol
|
|
(info, bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section
|
|
(input_bfd, symtab_hdr->sh_link, sym->st_name),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
rel->r_offset, TRUE))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
|
|
+ sec->output_offset
|
|
+ sym->st_value);
|
|
if (!info->relocatable
|
|
&& (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
|
|
&& ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *msec;
|
|
bfd_vma addend, value;
|
|
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
value = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
addend = ((value & 0xf0000) >> 4) | (value & 0xfff);
|
|
addend = (addend ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
value = bfd_get_16 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset)
|
|
<< 16;
|
|
value |= bfd_get_16 (input_bfd,
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset + 2);
|
|
addend = ((value & 0xf7000) >> 4) | (value & 0xff)
|
|
| ((value & 0x04000000) >> 15);
|
|
addend = (addend ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
if (howto->rightshift
|
|
|| (howto->src_mask & (howto->src_mask + 1)))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): %s relocation against SEC_MERGE section"),
|
|
input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset, howto->name);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
value = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
|
|
/* Get the (signed) value from the instruction. */
|
|
addend = value & howto->src_mask;
|
|
if (addend & ((howto->src_mask + 1) >> 1))
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma mask;
|
|
|
|
mask = -1;
|
|
mask &= ~ howto->src_mask;
|
|
addend |= mask;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
msec = sec;
|
|
addend =
|
|
_bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &msec, addend)
|
|
- relocation;
|
|
addend += msec->output_section->vma + msec->output_offset;
|
|
|
|
/* Cases here must match those in the preceeding
|
|
switch statement. */
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
value = (value & 0xfff0f000) | ((addend & 0xf000) << 4)
|
|
| (addend & 0xfff);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
value = (value & 0xfbf08f00) | ((addend & 0xf700) << 4)
|
|
| (addend & 0xff) | ((addend & 0x0800) << 15);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, value >> 16,
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (input_bfd, value,
|
|
contents + rel->r_offset + 2);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
value = (value & ~ howto->dst_mask)
|
|
| (addend & howto->dst_mask);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value, contents + rel->r_offset);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_boolean warned;
|
|
|
|
RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
|
|
r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
|
|
h, sec, relocation,
|
|
unresolved_reloc, warned);
|
|
|
|
sym_type = h->type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
|
|
RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION (info, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
rel, relend, howto, contents);
|
|
|
|
if (info->relocatable)
|
|
{
|
|
/* This is a relocatable link. We don't have to change
|
|
anything, unless the reloc is against a section symbol,
|
|
in which case we have to adjust according to where the
|
|
section symbol winds up in the output section. */
|
|
if (sym != NULL && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
|
|
{
|
|
if (globals->use_rel)
|
|
arm_add_to_rel (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset,
|
|
howto, (bfd_signed_vma) sec->output_offset);
|
|
else
|
|
rel->r_addend += sec->output_offset;
|
|
}
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
name = h->root.root.string;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
name = (bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section
|
|
(input_bfd, symtab_hdr->sh_link, sym->st_name));
|
|
if (name == NULL || *name == '\0')
|
|
name = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
|
|
&& r_type != R_ARM_NONE
|
|
&& (h == NULL
|
|
|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
|
|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
|
|
&& IS_ARM_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
((sym_type == STT_TLS
|
|
? _("%B(%A+0x%lx): %s used with TLS symbol %s")
|
|
: _("%B(%A+0x%lx): %s used with non-TLS symbol %s")),
|
|
input_bfd,
|
|
input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset,
|
|
howto->name,
|
|
name);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We call elf32_arm_final_link_relocate unless we're completely
|
|
done, i.e., the relaxation produced the final output we want,
|
|
and we won't let anybody mess with it. Also, we have to do
|
|
addend adjustments in case of a R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC relocation
|
|
both in relaxed and non-relaxed cases */
|
|
if ((elf32_arm_tls_transition (info, r_type, h) != (unsigned)r_type)
|
|
|| (IS_ARM_TLS_GNU_RELOC (r_type)
|
|
&& !((h ? elf32_arm_hash_entry (h)->tls_type :
|
|
elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type (input_bfd)[r_symndx])
|
|
& GOT_TLS_GDESC)))
|
|
{
|
|
r = elf32_arm_tls_relax (globals, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
contents, rel, h == NULL);
|
|
/* This may have been marked unresolved because it came from
|
|
a shared library. But we've just dealt with that. */
|
|
unresolved_reloc = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
r = bfd_reloc_continue;
|
|
|
|
if (r == bfd_reloc_continue)
|
|
r = elf32_arm_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, output_bfd,
|
|
input_section, contents, rel,
|
|
relocation, info, sec, name, sym_type,
|
|
(h ? h->target_internal
|
|
: ARM_SYM_BRANCH_TYPE (sym)), h,
|
|
&unresolved_reloc, &error_message);
|
|
|
|
/* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
|
|
because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
|
|
not process them. */
|
|
if (unresolved_reloc
|
|
&& !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
|
|
&& h->def_dynamic))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B(%A+0x%lx): unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'"),
|
|
input_bfd,
|
|
input_section,
|
|
(long) rel->r_offset,
|
|
howto->name,
|
|
h->root.root.string);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (r)
|
|
{
|
|
case bfd_reloc_overflow:
|
|
/* If the overflowing reloc was to an undefined symbol,
|
|
we have already printed one error message and there
|
|
is no point complaining again. */
|
|
if ((! h ||
|
|
h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefined)
|
|
&& (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
|
|
(info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), name, howto->name,
|
|
(bfd_vma) 0, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
rel->r_offset))))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bfd_reloc_undefined:
|
|
if (!((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
|
|
(info, name, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
rel->r_offset, TRUE)))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
|
|
error_message = _("out of range");
|
|
goto common_error;
|
|
|
|
case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
|
|
error_message = _("unsupported relocation");
|
|
goto common_error;
|
|
|
|
case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
|
|
/* error_message should already be set. */
|
|
goto common_error;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
error_message = _("unknown error");
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
|
|
common_error:
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
|
|
if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
|
|
(info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
|
|
rel->r_offset)))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add a new unwind edit to the list described by HEAD, TAIL. If TINDEX is zero,
|
|
adds the edit to the start of the list. (The list must be built in order of
|
|
ascending TINDEX: the function's callers are primarily responsible for
|
|
maintaining that condition). */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
add_unwind_table_edit (arm_unwind_table_edit **head,
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit **tail,
|
|
arm_unwind_edit_type type,
|
|
asection *linked_section,
|
|
unsigned int tindex)
|
|
{
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit *new_edit = (arm_unwind_table_edit *)
|
|
xmalloc (sizeof (arm_unwind_table_edit));
|
|
|
|
new_edit->type = type;
|
|
new_edit->linked_section = linked_section;
|
|
new_edit->index = tindex;
|
|
|
|
if (tindex > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
new_edit->next = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (*tail)
|
|
(*tail)->next = new_edit;
|
|
|
|
(*tail) = new_edit;
|
|
|
|
if (!*head)
|
|
(*head) = new_edit;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
new_edit->next = *head;
|
|
|
|
if (!*tail)
|
|
*tail = new_edit;
|
|
|
|
*head = new_edit;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static _arm_elf_section_data *get_arm_elf_section_data (asection *);
|
|
|
|
/* Increase the size of EXIDX_SEC by ADJUST bytes. ADJUST mau be negative. */
|
|
static void
|
|
adjust_exidx_size(asection *exidx_sec, int adjust)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *out_sec;
|
|
|
|
if (!exidx_sec->rawsize)
|
|
exidx_sec->rawsize = exidx_sec->size;
|
|
|
|
bfd_set_section_size (exidx_sec->owner, exidx_sec, exidx_sec->size + adjust);
|
|
out_sec = exidx_sec->output_section;
|
|
/* Adjust size of output section. */
|
|
bfd_set_section_size (out_sec->owner, out_sec, out_sec->size +adjust);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Insert an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND marker at the end of a section. */
|
|
static void
|
|
insert_cantunwind_after(asection *text_sec, asection *exidx_sec)
|
|
{
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *exidx_arm_data;
|
|
|
|
exidx_arm_data = get_arm_elf_section_data (exidx_sec);
|
|
add_unwind_table_edit (
|
|
&exidx_arm_data->u.exidx.unwind_edit_list,
|
|
&exidx_arm_data->u.exidx.unwind_edit_tail,
|
|
INSERT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND_AT_END, text_sec, UINT_MAX);
|
|
|
|
adjust_exidx_size(exidx_sec, 8);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Scan .ARM.exidx tables, and create a list describing edits which should be
|
|
made to those tables, such that:
|
|
|
|
1. Regions without unwind data are marked with EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entries.
|
|
2. Duplicate entries are merged together (EXIDX_CANTUNWIND, or unwind
|
|
codes which have been inlined into the index).
|
|
|
|
If MERGE_EXIDX_ENTRIES is false, duplicate entries are not merged.
|
|
|
|
The edits are applied when the tables are written
|
|
(in elf32_arm_write_section).
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_fix_exidx_coverage (asection **text_section_order,
|
|
unsigned int num_text_sections,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
bfd_boolean merge_exidx_entries)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd *inp;
|
|
unsigned int last_second_word = 0, i;
|
|
asection *last_exidx_sec = NULL;
|
|
asection *last_text_sec = NULL;
|
|
int last_unwind_type = -1;
|
|
|
|
/* Walk over all EXIDX sections, and create backlinks from the corrsponding
|
|
text sections. */
|
|
for (inp = info->input_bfds; inp != NULL; inp = inp->link_next)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
|
|
for (sec = inp->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (sec);
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_sec->this_hdr;
|
|
|
|
if (!hdr || hdr->sh_type != SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (elf_sec->linked_to)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *linked_hdr
|
|
= &elf_section_data (elf_sec->linked_to)->this_hdr;
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *linked_sec_arm_data
|
|
= get_arm_elf_section_data (linked_hdr->bfd_section);
|
|
|
|
if (linked_sec_arm_data == NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Link this .ARM.exidx section back from the text section it
|
|
describes. */
|
|
linked_sec_arm_data->u.text.arm_exidx_sec = sec;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Walk all text sections in order of increasing VMA. Eilminate duplicate
|
|
index table entries (EXIDX_CANTUNWIND and inlined unwind opcodes),
|
|
and add EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entries for sections with no unwind table data. */
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < num_text_sections; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *sec = text_section_order[i];
|
|
asection *exidx_sec;
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *arm_data = get_arm_elf_section_data (sec);
|
|
struct _arm_elf_section_data *exidx_arm_data;
|
|
bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
|
|
int deleted_exidx_bytes = 0;
|
|
bfd_vma j;
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit *unwind_edit_head = NULL;
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit *unwind_edit_tail = NULL;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
|
|
bfd *ibfd;
|
|
|
|
if (arm_data == NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
exidx_sec = arm_data->u.text.arm_exidx_sec;
|
|
if (exidx_sec == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Section has no unwind data. */
|
|
if (last_unwind_type == 0 || !last_exidx_sec)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore zero sized sections. */
|
|
if (sec->size == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
insert_cantunwind_after(last_text_sec, last_exidx_sec);
|
|
last_unwind_type = 0;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Skip /DISCARD/ sections. */
|
|
if (bfd_is_abs_section (exidx_sec->output_section))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
hdr = &elf_section_data (exidx_sec)->this_hdr;
|
|
if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
exidx_arm_data = get_arm_elf_section_data (exidx_sec);
|
|
if (exidx_arm_data == NULL)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
ibfd = exidx_sec->owner;
|
|
|
|
if (hdr->contents != NULL)
|
|
contents = hdr->contents;
|
|
else if (! bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, exidx_sec, &contents))
|
|
/* An error? */
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (j = 0; j < hdr->sh_size; j += 8)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int second_word = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, contents + j + 4);
|
|
int unwind_type;
|
|
int elide = 0;
|
|
|
|
/* An EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry. */
|
|
if (second_word == 1)
|
|
{
|
|
if (last_unwind_type == 0)
|
|
elide = 1;
|
|
unwind_type = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Inlined unwinding data. Merge if equal to previous. */
|
|
else if ((second_word & 0x80000000) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (merge_exidx_entries
|
|
&& last_second_word == second_word && last_unwind_type == 1)
|
|
elide = 1;
|
|
unwind_type = 1;
|
|
last_second_word = second_word;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Normal table entry. In theory we could merge these too,
|
|
but duplicate entries are likely to be much less common. */
|
|
else
|
|
unwind_type = 2;
|
|
|
|
if (elide)
|
|
{
|
|
add_unwind_table_edit (&unwind_edit_head, &unwind_edit_tail,
|
|
DELETE_EXIDX_ENTRY, NULL, j / 8);
|
|
|
|
deleted_exidx_bytes += 8;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
last_unwind_type = unwind_type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Free contents if we allocated it ourselves. */
|
|
if (contents != hdr->contents)
|
|
free (contents);
|
|
|
|
/* Record edits to be applied later (in elf32_arm_write_section). */
|
|
exidx_arm_data->u.exidx.unwind_edit_list = unwind_edit_head;
|
|
exidx_arm_data->u.exidx.unwind_edit_tail = unwind_edit_tail;
|
|
|
|
if (deleted_exidx_bytes > 0)
|
|
adjust_exidx_size(exidx_sec, -deleted_exidx_bytes);
|
|
|
|
last_exidx_sec = exidx_sec;
|
|
last_text_sec = sec;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add terminating CANTUNWIND entry. */
|
|
if (last_exidx_sec && last_unwind_type != 0)
|
|
insert_cantunwind_after(last_text_sec, last_exidx_sec);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_output_glue_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *obfd,
|
|
bfd *ibfd, const char *name)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *sec, *osec;
|
|
|
|
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, name);
|
|
if (sec == NULL || (sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
osec = sec->output_section;
|
|
if (elf32_arm_write_section (obfd, info, sec, sec->contents))
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (! bfd_set_section_contents (obfd, osec, sec->contents,
|
|
sec->output_offset, sec->size))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
asection *sec, *osec;
|
|
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
|
|
if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* Process stub sections (eg BE8 encoding, ...). */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
int i;
|
|
for (i=0; i<htab->top_id; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
sec = htab->stub_group[i].stub_sec;
|
|
/* Only process it once, in its link_sec slot. */
|
|
if (sec && i == htab->stub_group[i].link_sec->id)
|
|
{
|
|
osec = sec->output_section;
|
|
elf32_arm_write_section (abfd, info, sec, sec->contents);
|
|
if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, osec, sec->contents,
|
|
sec->output_offset, sec->size))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Write out any glue sections now that we have created all the
|
|
stubs. */
|
|
if (globals->bfd_of_glue_owner != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (! elf32_arm_output_glue_section (info, abfd,
|
|
globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (! elf32_arm_output_glue_section (info, abfd,
|
|
globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SECTION_NAME))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (! elf32_arm_output_glue_section (info, abfd,
|
|
globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
VFP11_ERRATUM_VENEER_SECTION_NAME))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (! elf32_arm_output_glue_section (info, abfd,
|
|
globals->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
ARM_BX_GLUE_SECTION_NAME))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set the right machine number. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_object_p (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int mach;
|
|
|
|
mach = bfd_arm_get_mach_from_notes (abfd, ARM_NOTE_SECTION);
|
|
|
|
if (mach != bfd_mach_arm_unknown)
|
|
bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_arm, mach);
|
|
|
|
else if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_ARM_MAVERICK_FLOAT)
|
|
bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_arm, bfd_mach_arm_ep9312);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_arm, mach);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Function to keep ARM specific flags in the ELF header. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
|
|
{
|
|
if (elf_flags_init (abfd)
|
|
&& elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags != flags)
|
|
{
|
|
if (EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (flags) == EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN)
|
|
{
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK)
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("Warning: Not setting interworking flag of %B since it has already been specified as non-interworking"),
|
|
abfd);
|
|
else
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("Warning: Clearing the interworking flag of %B due to outside request"),
|
|
abfd);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
|
|
elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Copy backend specific data from one object module to another. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
|
|
{
|
|
flagword in_flags;
|
|
flagword out_flags;
|
|
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (ibfd) || ! is_arm_elf (obfd))
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
in_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
|
|
out_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
|
|
|
|
if (elf_flags_init (obfd)
|
|
&& EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (out_flags) == EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN
|
|
&& in_flags != out_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Cannot mix APCS26 and APCS32 code. */
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_26) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_26))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* Cannot mix float APCS and non-float APCS code. */
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* If the src and dest have different interworking flags
|
|
then turn off the interworking bit. */
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK))
|
|
{
|
|
if (out_flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK)
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("Warning: Clearing the interworking flag of %B because non-interworking code in %B has been linked with it"),
|
|
obfd, ibfd);
|
|
|
|
in_flags &= ~EF_ARM_INTERWORK;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Likewise for PIC, though don't warn for this case. */
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_PIC) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_PIC))
|
|
in_flags &= ~EF_ARM_PIC;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = in_flags;
|
|
elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
|
|
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
|
|
elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
|
|
|
|
/* Copy object attributes. */
|
|
_bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Values for Tag_ABI_PCS_R9_use. */
|
|
enum
|
|
{
|
|
AEABI_R9_V6,
|
|
AEABI_R9_SB,
|
|
AEABI_R9_TLS,
|
|
AEABI_R9_unused
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Values for Tag_ABI_PCS_RW_data. */
|
|
enum
|
|
{
|
|
AEABI_PCS_RW_data_absolute,
|
|
AEABI_PCS_RW_data_PCrel,
|
|
AEABI_PCS_RW_data_SBrel,
|
|
AEABI_PCS_RW_data_unused
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Values for Tag_ABI_enum_size. */
|
|
enum
|
|
{
|
|
AEABI_enum_unused,
|
|
AEABI_enum_short,
|
|
AEABI_enum_wide,
|
|
AEABI_enum_forced_wide
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Determine whether an object attribute tag takes an integer, a
|
|
string or both. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
elf32_arm_obj_attrs_arg_type (int tag)
|
|
{
|
|
if (tag == Tag_compatibility)
|
|
return ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_STR_VAL;
|
|
else if (tag == Tag_nodefaults)
|
|
return ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_NO_DEFAULT;
|
|
else if (tag == Tag_CPU_raw_name || tag == Tag_CPU_name)
|
|
return ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_STR_VAL;
|
|
else if (tag < 32)
|
|
return ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
|
|
else
|
|
return (tag & 1) != 0 ? ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_STR_VAL : ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The ABI defines that Tag_conformance should be emitted first, and that
|
|
Tag_nodefaults should be second (if either is defined). This sets those
|
|
two positions, and bumps up the position of all the remaining tags to
|
|
compensate. */
|
|
static int
|
|
elf32_arm_obj_attrs_order (int num)
|
|
{
|
|
if (num == LEAST_KNOWN_OBJ_ATTRIBUTE)
|
|
return Tag_conformance;
|
|
if (num == LEAST_KNOWN_OBJ_ATTRIBUTE + 1)
|
|
return Tag_nodefaults;
|
|
if ((num - 2) < Tag_nodefaults)
|
|
return num - 2;
|
|
if ((num - 1) < Tag_conformance)
|
|
return num - 1;
|
|
return num;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Attribute numbers >=64 (mod 128) can be safely ignored. */
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_obj_attrs_handle_unknown (bfd *abfd, int tag)
|
|
{
|
|
if ((tag & 127) < 64)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("%B: Unknown mandatory EABI object attribute %d"),
|
|
abfd, tag);
|
|
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("Warning: %B: Unknown EABI object attribute %d"),
|
|
abfd, tag);
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Read the architecture from the Tag_also_compatible_with attribute, if any.
|
|
Returns -1 if no architecture could be read. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
get_secondary_compatible_arch (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
obj_attribute *attr =
|
|
&elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (abfd)[Tag_also_compatible_with];
|
|
|
|
/* Note: the tag and its argument below are uleb128 values, though
|
|
currently-defined values fit in one byte for each. */
|
|
if (attr->s
|
|
&& attr->s[0] == Tag_CPU_arch
|
|
&& (attr->s[1] & 128) != 128
|
|
&& attr->s[2] == 0)
|
|
return attr->s[1];
|
|
|
|
/* This tag is "safely ignorable", so don't complain if it looks funny. */
|
|
return -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set, or unset, the architecture of the Tag_also_compatible_with attribute.
|
|
The tag is removed if ARCH is -1. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
set_secondary_compatible_arch (bfd *abfd, int arch)
|
|
{
|
|
obj_attribute *attr =
|
|
&elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (abfd)[Tag_also_compatible_with];
|
|
|
|
if (arch == -1)
|
|
{
|
|
attr->s = NULL;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Note: the tag and its argument below are uleb128 values, though
|
|
currently-defined values fit in one byte for each. */
|
|
if (!attr->s)
|
|
attr->s = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, 3);
|
|
attr->s[0] = Tag_CPU_arch;
|
|
attr->s[1] = arch;
|
|
attr->s[2] = '\0';
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Combine two values for Tag_CPU_arch, taking secondary compatibility tags
|
|
into account. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
tag_cpu_arch_combine (bfd *ibfd, int oldtag, int *secondary_compat_out,
|
|
int newtag, int secondary_compat)
|
|
{
|
|
#define T(X) TAG_CPU_ARCH_##X
|
|
int tagl, tagh, result;
|
|
const int v6t2[] =
|
|
{
|
|
T(V6T2), /* PRE_V4. */
|
|
T(V6T2), /* V4. */
|
|
T(V6T2), /* V4T. */
|
|
T(V6T2), /* V5T. */
|
|
T(V6T2), /* V5TE. */
|
|
T(V6T2), /* V5TEJ. */
|
|
T(V6T2), /* V6. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6KZ. */
|
|
T(V6T2) /* V6T2. */
|
|
};
|
|
const int v6k[] =
|
|
{
|
|
T(V6K), /* PRE_V4. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V4. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V4T. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5T. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5TE. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5TEJ. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V6. */
|
|
T(V6KZ), /* V6KZ. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6T2. */
|
|
T(V6K) /* V6K. */
|
|
};
|
|
const int v7[] =
|
|
{
|
|
T(V7), /* PRE_V4. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V4. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V4T. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V5T. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V5TE. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V5TEJ. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6KZ. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6T2. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6K. */
|
|
T(V7) /* V7. */
|
|
};
|
|
const int v6_m[] =
|
|
{
|
|
-1, /* PRE_V4. */
|
|
-1, /* V4. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V4T. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5T. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5TE. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5TEJ. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V6. */
|
|
T(V6KZ), /* V6KZ. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6T2. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V6K. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V7. */
|
|
T(V6_M) /* V6_M. */
|
|
};
|
|
const int v6s_m[] =
|
|
{
|
|
-1, /* PRE_V4. */
|
|
-1, /* V4. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V4T. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5T. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5TE. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V5TEJ. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V6. */
|
|
T(V6KZ), /* V6KZ. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V6T2. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V6K. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V7. */
|
|
T(V6S_M), /* V6_M. */
|
|
T(V6S_M) /* V6S_M. */
|
|
};
|
|
const int v7e_m[] =
|
|
{
|
|
-1, /* PRE_V4. */
|
|
-1, /* V4. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V4T. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V5T. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V5TE. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V5TEJ. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V6. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V6KZ. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V6T2. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V6K. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V7. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V6_M. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V6S_M. */
|
|
T(V7E_M) /* V7E_M. */
|
|
};
|
|
const int v4t_plus_v6_m[] =
|
|
{
|
|
-1, /* PRE_V4. */
|
|
-1, /* V4. */
|
|
T(V4T), /* V4T. */
|
|
T(V5T), /* V5T. */
|
|
T(V5TE), /* V5TE. */
|
|
T(V5TEJ), /* V5TEJ. */
|
|
T(V6), /* V6. */
|
|
T(V6KZ), /* V6KZ. */
|
|
T(V6T2), /* V6T2. */
|
|
T(V6K), /* V6K. */
|
|
T(V7), /* V7. */
|
|
T(V6_M), /* V6_M. */
|
|
T(V6S_M), /* V6S_M. */
|
|
T(V7E_M), /* V7E_M. */
|
|
T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M) /* V4T plus V6_M. */
|
|
};
|
|
const int *comb[] =
|
|
{
|
|
v6t2,
|
|
v6k,
|
|
v7,
|
|
v6_m,
|
|
v6s_m,
|
|
v7e_m,
|
|
/* Pseudo-architecture. */
|
|
v4t_plus_v6_m
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Check we've not got a higher architecture than we know about. */
|
|
|
|
if (oldtag > MAX_TAG_CPU_ARCH || newtag > MAX_TAG_CPU_ARCH)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler (_("error: %B: Unknown CPU architecture"), ibfd);
|
|
return -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Override old tag if we have a Tag_also_compatible_with on the output. */
|
|
|
|
if ((oldtag == T(V6_M) && *secondary_compat_out == T(V4T))
|
|
|| (oldtag == T(V4T) && *secondary_compat_out == T(V6_M)))
|
|
oldtag = T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M);
|
|
|
|
/* And override the new tag if we have a Tag_also_compatible_with on the
|
|
input. */
|
|
|
|
if ((newtag == T(V6_M) && secondary_compat == T(V4T))
|
|
|| (newtag == T(V4T) && secondary_compat == T(V6_M)))
|
|
newtag = T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M);
|
|
|
|
tagl = (oldtag < newtag) ? oldtag : newtag;
|
|
result = tagh = (oldtag > newtag) ? oldtag : newtag;
|
|
|
|
/* Architectures before V6KZ add features monotonically. */
|
|
if (tagh <= TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6KZ)
|
|
return result;
|
|
|
|
result = comb[tagh - T(V6T2)][tagl];
|
|
|
|
/* Use Tag_CPU_arch == V4T and Tag_also_compatible_with (Tag_CPU_arch V6_M)
|
|
as the canonical version. */
|
|
if (result == T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M))
|
|
{
|
|
result = T(V4T);
|
|
*secondary_compat_out = T(V6_M);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
*secondary_compat_out = -1;
|
|
|
|
if (result == -1)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler (_("error: %B: Conflicting CPU architectures %d/%d"),
|
|
ibfd, oldtag, newtag);
|
|
return -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
#undef T
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Merge EABI object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if there
|
|
are conflicting attributes. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_merge_eabi_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
|
|
{
|
|
obj_attribute *in_attr;
|
|
obj_attribute *out_attr;
|
|
/* Some tags have 0 = don't care, 1 = strong requirement,
|
|
2 = weak requirement. */
|
|
static const int order_021[3] = {0, 2, 1};
|
|
int i;
|
|
bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Skip the linker stubs file. This preserves previous behavior
|
|
of accepting unknown attributes in the first input file - but
|
|
is that a bug? */
|
|
if (ibfd->flags & BFD_LINKER_CREATED)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
|
|
{
|
|
/* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
|
|
_bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
|
|
|
|
out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd);
|
|
|
|
/* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
|
|
initialized. */
|
|
out_attr[0].i = 1;
|
|
|
|
/* We do not output objects with Tag_MPextension_use_legacy - we move
|
|
the attribute's value to Tag_MPextension_use. */
|
|
if (out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].i != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use].i != 0
|
|
&& out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].i
|
|
!= out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use].i)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("Error: %B has both the current and legacy "
|
|
"Tag_MPextension_use attributes"), ibfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use] =
|
|
out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use_legacy];
|
|
out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].type = 0;
|
|
out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].i = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (ibfd);
|
|
out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd);
|
|
/* This needs to happen before Tag_ABI_FP_number_model is merged. */
|
|
if (in_attr[Tag_ABI_VFP_args].i != out_attr[Tag_ABI_VFP_args].i)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Ignore mismatches if the object doesn't use floating point. */
|
|
if (out_attr[Tag_ABI_FP_number_model].i == 0)
|
|
out_attr[Tag_ABI_VFP_args].i = in_attr[Tag_ABI_VFP_args].i;
|
|
else if (in_attr[Tag_ABI_FP_number_model].i != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B uses VFP register arguments, %B does not"),
|
|
in_attr[Tag_ABI_VFP_args].i ? ibfd : obfd,
|
|
in_attr[Tag_ABI_VFP_args].i ? obfd : ibfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for (i = LEAST_KNOWN_OBJ_ATTRIBUTE; i < NUM_KNOWN_OBJ_ATTRIBUTES; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Merge this attribute with existing attributes. */
|
|
switch (i)
|
|
{
|
|
case Tag_CPU_raw_name:
|
|
case Tag_CPU_name:
|
|
/* These are merged after Tag_CPU_arch. */
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_ABI_optimization_goals:
|
|
case Tag_ABI_FP_optimization_goals:
|
|
/* Use the first value seen. */
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_CPU_arch:
|
|
{
|
|
int secondary_compat = -1, secondary_compat_out = -1;
|
|
unsigned int saved_out_attr = out_attr[i].i;
|
|
static const char *name_table[] = {
|
|
/* These aren't real CPU names, but we can't guess
|
|
that from the architecture version alone. */
|
|
"Pre v4",
|
|
"ARM v4",
|
|
"ARM v4T",
|
|
"ARM v5T",
|
|
"ARM v5TE",
|
|
"ARM v5TEJ",
|
|
"ARM v6",
|
|
"ARM v6KZ",
|
|
"ARM v6T2",
|
|
"ARM v6K",
|
|
"ARM v7",
|
|
"ARM v6-M",
|
|
"ARM v6S-M"
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/* Merge Tag_CPU_arch and Tag_also_compatible_with. */
|
|
secondary_compat = get_secondary_compatible_arch (ibfd);
|
|
secondary_compat_out = get_secondary_compatible_arch (obfd);
|
|
out_attr[i].i = tag_cpu_arch_combine (ibfd, out_attr[i].i,
|
|
&secondary_compat_out,
|
|
in_attr[i].i,
|
|
secondary_compat);
|
|
set_secondary_compatible_arch (obfd, secondary_compat_out);
|
|
|
|
/* Merge Tag_CPU_name and Tag_CPU_raw_name. */
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i == saved_out_attr)
|
|
; /* Leave the names alone. */
|
|
else if (out_attr[i].i == in_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The output architecture has been changed to match the
|
|
input architecture. Use the input names. */
|
|
out_attr[Tag_CPU_name].s = in_attr[Tag_CPU_name].s
|
|
? _bfd_elf_attr_strdup (obfd, in_attr[Tag_CPU_name].s)
|
|
: NULL;
|
|
out_attr[Tag_CPU_raw_name].s = in_attr[Tag_CPU_raw_name].s
|
|
? _bfd_elf_attr_strdup (obfd, in_attr[Tag_CPU_raw_name].s)
|
|
: NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
out_attr[Tag_CPU_name].s = NULL;
|
|
out_attr[Tag_CPU_raw_name].s = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If we still don't have a value for Tag_CPU_name,
|
|
make one up now. Tag_CPU_raw_name remains blank. */
|
|
if (out_attr[Tag_CPU_name].s == NULL
|
|
&& out_attr[i].i < ARRAY_SIZE (name_table))
|
|
out_attr[Tag_CPU_name].s =
|
|
_bfd_elf_attr_strdup (obfd, name_table[out_attr[i].i]);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_ARM_ISA_use:
|
|
case Tag_THUMB_ISA_use:
|
|
case Tag_WMMX_arch:
|
|
case Tag_Advanced_SIMD_arch:
|
|
/* ??? Do Advanced_SIMD (NEON) and WMMX conflict? */
|
|
case Tag_ABI_FP_rounding:
|
|
case Tag_ABI_FP_exceptions:
|
|
case Tag_ABI_FP_user_exceptions:
|
|
case Tag_ABI_FP_number_model:
|
|
case Tag_FP_HP_extension:
|
|
case Tag_CPU_unaligned_access:
|
|
case Tag_T2EE_use:
|
|
case Tag_MPextension_use:
|
|
/* Use the largest value specified. */
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i > out_attr[i].i)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_ABI_align_preserved:
|
|
case Tag_ABI_PCS_RO_data:
|
|
/* Use the smallest value specified. */
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i < out_attr[i].i)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_ABI_align_needed:
|
|
if ((in_attr[i].i > 0 || out_attr[i].i > 0)
|
|
&& (in_attr[Tag_ABI_align_preserved].i == 0
|
|
|| out_attr[Tag_ABI_align_preserved].i == 0))
|
|
{
|
|
/* This error message should be enabled once all non-conformant
|
|
binaries in the toolchain have had the attributes set
|
|
properly.
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B: 8-byte data alignment conflicts with %B"),
|
|
obfd, ibfd);
|
|
result = FALSE; */
|
|
}
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
case Tag_ABI_FP_denormal:
|
|
case Tag_ABI_PCS_GOT_use:
|
|
/* Use the "greatest" from the sequence 0, 2, 1, or the largest
|
|
value if greater than 2 (for future-proofing). */
|
|
if ((in_attr[i].i > 2 && in_attr[i].i > out_attr[i].i)
|
|
|| (in_attr[i].i <= 2 && out_attr[i].i <= 2
|
|
&& order_021[in_attr[i].i] > order_021[out_attr[i].i]))
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_Virtualization_use:
|
|
/* The virtualization tag effectively stores two bits of
|
|
information: the intended use of TrustZone (in bit 0), and the
|
|
intended use of Virtualization (in bit 1). */
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i == 0)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
else if (in_attr[i].i != 0
|
|
&& in_attr[i].i != out_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i <= 3 && out_attr[i].i <= 3)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = 3;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B: unable to merge virtualization attributes "
|
|
"with %B"),
|
|
obfd, ibfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_CPU_arch_profile:
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i != in_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
/* 0 will merge with anything.
|
|
'A' and 'S' merge to 'A'.
|
|
'R' and 'S' merge to 'R'.
|
|
'M' and 'A|R|S' is an error. */
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i == 0
|
|
|| (out_attr[i].i == 'S'
|
|
&& (in_attr[i].i == 'A' || in_attr[i].i == 'R')))
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
else if (in_attr[i].i == 0
|
|
|| (in_attr[i].i == 'S'
|
|
&& (out_attr[i].i == 'A' || out_attr[i].i == 'R')))
|
|
; /* Do nothing. */
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B: Conflicting architecture profiles %c/%c"),
|
|
ibfd,
|
|
in_attr[i].i ? in_attr[i].i : '0',
|
|
out_attr[i].i ? out_attr[i].i : '0');
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_FP_arch:
|
|
{
|
|
/* Tag_ABI_HardFP_use is handled along with Tag_FP_arch since
|
|
the meaning of Tag_ABI_HardFP_use depends on Tag_FP_arch
|
|
when it's 0. It might mean absence of FP hardware if
|
|
Tag_FP_arch is zero, otherwise it is effectively SP + DP. */
|
|
|
|
static const struct
|
|
{
|
|
int ver;
|
|
int regs;
|
|
} vfp_versions[7] =
|
|
{
|
|
{0, 0},
|
|
{1, 16},
|
|
{2, 16},
|
|
{3, 32},
|
|
{3, 16},
|
|
{4, 32},
|
|
{4, 16}
|
|
};
|
|
int ver;
|
|
int regs;
|
|
int newval;
|
|
|
|
/* If the output has no requirement about FP hardware,
|
|
follow the requirement of the input. */
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (out_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i == 0);
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
out_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i
|
|
= in_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
/* If the input has no requirement about FP hardware, do
|
|
nothing. */
|
|
else if (in_attr[i].i == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (in_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i == 0);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Both the input and the output have nonzero Tag_FP_arch.
|
|
So Tag_ABI_HardFP_use is (SP & DP) when it's zero. */
|
|
|
|
/* If both the input and the output have zero Tag_ABI_HardFP_use,
|
|
do nothing. */
|
|
if (in_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i == 0
|
|
&& out_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i == 0)
|
|
;
|
|
/* If the input and the output have different Tag_ABI_HardFP_use,
|
|
the combination of them is 3 (SP & DP). */
|
|
else if (in_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i
|
|
!= out_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i)
|
|
out_attr[Tag_ABI_HardFP_use].i = 3;
|
|
|
|
/* Now we can handle Tag_FP_arch. */
|
|
|
|
/* Values greater than 6 aren't defined, so just pick the
|
|
biggest */
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i > 6 && in_attr[i].i > out_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
out_attr[i] = in_attr[i];
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
/* The output uses the superset of input features
|
|
(ISA version) and registers. */
|
|
ver = vfp_versions[in_attr[i].i].ver;
|
|
if (ver < vfp_versions[out_attr[i].i].ver)
|
|
ver = vfp_versions[out_attr[i].i].ver;
|
|
regs = vfp_versions[in_attr[i].i].regs;
|
|
if (regs < vfp_versions[out_attr[i].i].regs)
|
|
regs = vfp_versions[out_attr[i].i].regs;
|
|
/* This assumes all possible supersets are also a valid
|
|
options. */
|
|
for (newval = 6; newval > 0; newval--)
|
|
{
|
|
if (regs == vfp_versions[newval].regs
|
|
&& ver == vfp_versions[newval].ver)
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
out_attr[i].i = newval;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_PCS_config:
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i == 0)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
else if (in_attr[i].i != 0 && out_attr[i].i != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* It's sometimes ok to mix different configs, so this is only
|
|
a warning. */
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("Warning: %B: Conflicting platform configuration"), ibfd);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_PCS_R9_use:
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != out_attr[i].i
|
|
&& out_attr[i].i != AEABI_R9_unused
|
|
&& in_attr[i].i != AEABI_R9_unused)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B: Conflicting use of R9"), ibfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i == AEABI_R9_unused)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_PCS_RW_data:
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i == AEABI_PCS_RW_data_SBrel
|
|
&& out_attr[Tag_ABI_PCS_R9_use].i != AEABI_R9_SB
|
|
&& out_attr[Tag_ABI_PCS_R9_use].i != AEABI_R9_unused)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B: SB relative addressing conflicts with use of R9"),
|
|
ibfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Use the smallest value specified. */
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i < out_attr[i].i)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_PCS_wchar_t:
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i && in_attr[i].i && out_attr[i].i != in_attr[i].i
|
|
&& !elf_arm_tdata (obfd)->no_wchar_size_warning)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("warning: %B uses %u-byte wchar_t yet the output is to use %u-byte wchar_t; use of wchar_t values across objects may fail"),
|
|
ibfd, in_attr[i].i, out_attr[i].i);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (in_attr[i].i && !out_attr[i].i)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_enum_size:
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != AEABI_enum_unused)
|
|
{
|
|
if (out_attr[i].i == AEABI_enum_unused
|
|
|| out_attr[i].i == AEABI_enum_forced_wide)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The existing object is compatible with anything.
|
|
Use whatever requirements the new object has. */
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (in_attr[i].i != AEABI_enum_forced_wide
|
|
&& out_attr[i].i != in_attr[i].i
|
|
&& !elf_arm_tdata (obfd)->no_enum_size_warning)
|
|
{
|
|
static const char *aeabi_enum_names[] =
|
|
{ "", "variable-size", "32-bit", "" };
|
|
const char *in_name =
|
|
in_attr[i].i < ARRAY_SIZE(aeabi_enum_names)
|
|
? aeabi_enum_names[in_attr[i].i]
|
|
: "<unknown>";
|
|
const char *out_name =
|
|
out_attr[i].i < ARRAY_SIZE(aeabi_enum_names)
|
|
? aeabi_enum_names[out_attr[i].i]
|
|
: "<unknown>";
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("warning: %B uses %s enums yet the output is to use %s enums; use of enum values across objects may fail"),
|
|
ibfd, in_name, out_name);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_VFP_args:
|
|
/* Aready done. */
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_WMMX_args:
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != out_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B uses iWMMXt register arguments, %B does not"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_compatibility:
|
|
/* Merged in target-independent code. */
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_HardFP_use:
|
|
/* This is handled along with Tag_FP_arch. */
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_ABI_FP_16bit_format:
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != 0 && out_attr[i].i != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != out_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: fp16 format mismatch between %B and %B"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != 0)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_DIV_use:
|
|
/* This tag is set to zero if we can use UDIV and SDIV in Thumb
|
|
mode on a v7-M or v7-R CPU; to one if we can not use UDIV or
|
|
SDIV at all; and to two if we can use UDIV or SDIV on a v7-A
|
|
CPU. We will merge as follows: If the input attribute's value
|
|
is one then the output attribute's value remains unchanged. If
|
|
the input attribute's value is zero or two then if the output
|
|
attribute's value is one the output value is set to the input
|
|
value, otherwise the output value must be the same as the
|
|
inputs. */
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != 1 && out_attr[i].i != 1)
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != out_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("DIV usage mismatch between %B and %B"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != 1)
|
|
out_attr[i].i = in_attr[i].i;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_MPextension_use_legacy:
|
|
/* We don't output objects with Tag_MPextension_use_legacy - we
|
|
move the value to Tag_MPextension_use. */
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i != 0 && in_attr[Tag_MPextension_use].i != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_attr[Tag_MPextension_use].i != in_attr[i].i)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("%B has has both the current and legacy "
|
|
"Tag_MPextension_use attributes"),
|
|
ibfd);
|
|
result = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (in_attr[i].i > out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use].i)
|
|
out_attr[Tag_MPextension_use] = in_attr[i];
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Tag_nodefaults:
|
|
/* This tag is set if it exists, but the value is unused (and is
|
|
typically zero). We don't actually need to do anything here -
|
|
the merge happens automatically when the type flags are merged
|
|
below. */
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_also_compatible_with:
|
|
/* Already done in Tag_CPU_arch. */
|
|
break;
|
|
case Tag_conformance:
|
|
/* Keep the attribute if it matches. Throw it away otherwise.
|
|
No attribute means no claim to conform. */
|
|
if (!in_attr[i].s || !out_attr[i].s
|
|
|| strcmp (in_attr[i].s, out_attr[i].s) != 0)
|
|
out_attr[i].s = NULL;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
result
|
|
= result && _bfd_elf_merge_unknown_attribute_low (ibfd, obfd, i);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If out_attr was copied from in_attr then it won't have a type yet. */
|
|
if (in_attr[i].type && !out_attr[i].type)
|
|
out_attr[i].type = in_attr[i].type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
|
|
if (!_bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* Check for any attributes not known on ARM. */
|
|
result &= _bfd_elf_merge_unknown_attribute_list (ibfd, obfd);
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return TRUE if the two EABI versions are incompatible. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_versions_compatible (unsigned iver, unsigned over)
|
|
{
|
|
/* v4 and v5 are the same spec before and after it was released,
|
|
so allow mixing them. */
|
|
if ((iver == EF_ARM_EABI_VER4 && over == EF_ARM_EABI_VER5)
|
|
|| (iver == EF_ARM_EABI_VER5 && over == EF_ARM_EABI_VER4))
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
return (iver == over);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
|
|
object file when linking. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd * ibfd, bfd * obfd);
|
|
|
|
/* Display the flags field. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void * ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
FILE * file = (FILE *) ptr;
|
|
unsigned long flags;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* Print normal ELF private data. */
|
|
_bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
|
|
|
|
flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
|
|
/* Ignore init flag - it may not be set, despite the flags field
|
|
containing valid data. */
|
|
|
|
/* xgettext:c-format */
|
|
fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
|
|
|
|
switch (EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (flags))
|
|
{
|
|
case EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN:
|
|
/* The following flag bits are GNU extensions and not part of the
|
|
official ARM ELF extended ABI. Hence they are only decoded if
|
|
the EABI version is not set. */
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [interworking enabled]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_APCS_26)
|
|
fprintf (file, " [APCS-26]");
|
|
else
|
|
fprintf (file, " [APCS-32]");
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_VFP_FLOAT)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [VFP float format]"));
|
|
else if (flags & EF_ARM_MAVERICK_FLOAT)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [Maverick float format]"));
|
|
else
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [FPA float format]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [floats passed in float registers]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_PIC)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [position independent]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_NEW_ABI)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [new ABI]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_OLD_ABI)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [old ABI]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_SOFT_FLOAT)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [software FP]"));
|
|
|
|
flags &= ~(EF_ARM_INTERWORK | EF_ARM_APCS_26 | EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT
|
|
| EF_ARM_PIC | EF_ARM_NEW_ABI | EF_ARM_OLD_ABI
|
|
| EF_ARM_SOFT_FLOAT | EF_ARM_VFP_FLOAT
|
|
| EF_ARM_MAVERICK_FLOAT);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case EF_ARM_EABI_VER1:
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [Version1 EABI]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_SYMSARESORTED)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [sorted symbol table]"));
|
|
else
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [unsorted symbol table]"));
|
|
|
|
flags &= ~ EF_ARM_SYMSARESORTED;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case EF_ARM_EABI_VER2:
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [Version2 EABI]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_SYMSARESORTED)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [sorted symbol table]"));
|
|
else
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [unsorted symbol table]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_DYNSYMSUSESEGIDX)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [dynamic symbols use segment index]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_MAPSYMSFIRST)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [mapping symbols precede others]"));
|
|
|
|
flags &= ~(EF_ARM_SYMSARESORTED | EF_ARM_DYNSYMSUSESEGIDX
|
|
| EF_ARM_MAPSYMSFIRST);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case EF_ARM_EABI_VER3:
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [Version3 EABI]"));
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case EF_ARM_EABI_VER4:
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [Version4 EABI]"));
|
|
goto eabi;
|
|
|
|
case EF_ARM_EABI_VER5:
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [Version5 EABI]"));
|
|
eabi:
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_BE8)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [BE8]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_LE8)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [LE8]"));
|
|
|
|
flags &= ~(EF_ARM_LE8 | EF_ARM_BE8);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" <EABI version unrecognised>"));
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
flags &= ~ EF_ARM_EABIMASK;
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_RELEXEC)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [relocatable executable]"));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & EF_ARM_HASENTRY)
|
|
fprintf (file, _(" [has entry point]"));
|
|
|
|
flags &= ~ (EF_ARM_RELEXEC | EF_ARM_HASENTRY);
|
|
|
|
if (flags)
|
|
fprintf (file, _("<Unrecognised flag bits set>"));
|
|
|
|
fputc ('\n', file);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
elf32_arm_get_symbol_type (Elf_Internal_Sym * elf_sym, int type)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (ELF_ST_TYPE (elf_sym->st_info))
|
|
{
|
|
case STT_ARM_TFUNC:
|
|
return ELF_ST_TYPE (elf_sym->st_info);
|
|
|
|
case STT_ARM_16BIT:
|
|
/* If the symbol is not an object, return the STT_ARM_16BIT flag.
|
|
This allows us to distinguish between data used by Thumb instructions
|
|
and non-data (which is probably code) inside Thumb regions of an
|
|
executable. */
|
|
if (type != STT_OBJECT && type != STT_TLS)
|
|
return ELF_ST_TYPE (elf_sym->st_info);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static asection *
|
|
elf32_arm_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
|
|
{
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT:
|
|
case R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY:
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_gc_sweep_hook (bfd * abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
asection * sec,
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table * globals;
|
|
|
|
if (info->relocatable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
elf_section_data (sec)->local_dynrel = NULL;
|
|
|
|
symtab_hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
|
|
sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
|
|
local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
|
|
|
|
check_use_blx (globals);
|
|
|
|
relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
|
|
for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
int r_type;
|
|
bfd_boolean call_reloc_p;
|
|
bfd_boolean may_become_dynamic_p;
|
|
bfd_boolean may_need_local_target_p;
|
|
union gotplt_union *root_plt;
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt;
|
|
|
|
r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
|
|
if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
|
|
{
|
|
h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
|
|
while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
|
|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
|
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
|
|
}
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
|
|
call_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
may_become_dynamic_p = FALSE;
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
|
|
r_type = arm_real_reloc_type (globals, r_type);
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_GOT32:
|
|
case R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GD32:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_IE32:
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (h->got.refcount > 0)
|
|
h->got.refcount -= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (local_got_refcounts != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] > 0)
|
|
local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] -= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:
|
|
globals->tls_ldm_got.refcount -= 1;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_PC24:
|
|
case R_ARM_PLT32:
|
|
case R_ARM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_JUMP24:
|
|
case R_ARM_PREL31:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
|
|
call_reloc_p = TRUE;
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS12:
|
|
if (!globals->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32:
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32:
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
|
|
/* Should the interworking branches be here also? */
|
|
if ((info->shared || globals->root.is_relocatable_executable)
|
|
&& (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (h == NULL
|
|
&& (r_type == R_ARM_REL32 || r_type == R_ARM_REL32_NOI))
|
|
{
|
|
call_reloc_p = TRUE;
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
may_become_dynamic_p = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (may_need_local_target_p
|
|
&& elf32_arm_get_plt_info (abfd, eh, r_symndx, &root_plt, &arm_plt))
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (root_plt->refcount > 0);
|
|
root_plt->refcount -= 1;
|
|
|
|
if (!call_reloc_p)
|
|
arm_plt->noncall_refcount--;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
arm_plt->maybe_thumb_refcount--;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP24
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP19)
|
|
arm_plt->thumb_refcount--;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (may_become_dynamic_p)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
pp = &((struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
|
|
|
|
isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&globals->sym_cache,
|
|
abfd, r_symndx);
|
|
if (isym == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
pp = elf32_arm_get_local_dynreloc_list (abfd, r_symndx, isym);
|
|
if (pp == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; pp = &p->next)
|
|
if (p->sec == sec)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Everything must go for SEC. */
|
|
*pp = p->next;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
|
|
bfd *dynobj;
|
|
asection *sreloc;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
bfd_boolean call_reloc_p;
|
|
bfd_boolean may_become_dynamic_p;
|
|
bfd_boolean may_need_local_target_p;
|
|
unsigned long nsyms;
|
|
|
|
if (info->relocatable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (is_arm_elf (abfd));
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
sreloc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Create dynamic sections for relocatable executables so that we can
|
|
copy relocations. */
|
|
if (htab->root.is_relocatable_executable
|
|
&& ! htab->root.dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
{
|
|
if (! _bfd_elf_link_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->root.dynobj == NULL)
|
|
htab->root.dynobj = abfd;
|
|
if (!create_ifunc_sections (info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
dynobj = htab->root.dynobj;
|
|
|
|
symtab_hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
|
|
sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
|
|
nsyms = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
|
|
|
|
rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
|
|
for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
|
int r_type;
|
|
|
|
r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
|
|
r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
|
|
r_type = arm_real_reloc_type (htab, r_type);
|
|
|
|
if (r_symndx >= nsyms
|
|
/* PR 9934: It is possible to have relocations that do not
|
|
refer to symbols, thus it is also possible to have an
|
|
object file containing relocations but no symbol table. */
|
|
&& (r_symndx > STN_UNDEF || nsyms > 0))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: bad symbol index: %d"), abfd,
|
|
r_symndx);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
h = NULL;
|
|
isym = NULL;
|
|
if (nsyms > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
|
|
{
|
|
/* A local symbol. */
|
|
isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
|
|
abfd, r_symndx);
|
|
if (isym == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
|
|
while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
|
|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
|
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
|
|
call_reloc_p = FALSE;
|
|
may_become_dynamic_p = FALSE;
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* Could be done earlier, if h were already available. */
|
|
r_type = elf32_arm_tls_transition (info, r_type, h);
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_GOT32:
|
|
case R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GD32:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_IE32:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
/* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
|
|
{
|
|
int tls_type, old_tls_type;
|
|
|
|
switch (r_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GD32: tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD; break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_IE32: tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE; break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_CALL: case R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ: case R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
|
|
tls_type = GOT_TLS_GDESC; break;
|
|
|
|
default: tls_type = GOT_NORMAL; break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
h->got.refcount++;
|
|
old_tls_type = elf32_arm_hash_entry (h)->tls_type;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_allocate_local_sym_info (abfd))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd)[r_symndx] += 1;
|
|
old_tls_type = elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If a variable is accessed with both tls methods, two
|
|
slots may be created. */
|
|
if (GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (old_tls_type)
|
|
&& GOT_TLS_GD_ANY_P (tls_type))
|
|
tls_type |= old_tls_type;
|
|
|
|
/* We will already have issued an error message if there
|
|
is a TLS/non-TLS mismatch, based on the symbol
|
|
type. So just combine any TLS types needed. */
|
|
if (old_tls_type != GOT_UNKNOWN && old_tls_type != GOT_NORMAL
|
|
&& tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
|
|
tls_type |= old_tls_type;
|
|
|
|
/* If the symbol is accessed in both IE and GDESC
|
|
method, we're able to relax. Turn off the GDESC flag,
|
|
without messing up with any other kind of tls types
|
|
that may be involved */
|
|
if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC))
|
|
tls_type &= ~GOT_TLS_GDESC;
|
|
|
|
if (old_tls_type != tls_type)
|
|
{
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
elf32_arm_hash_entry (h)->tls_type = tls_type;
|
|
else
|
|
elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx] = tls_type;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_TLS_LDM32)
|
|
htab->tls_ldm_got.refcount++;
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_GOTOFF32:
|
|
case R_ARM_GOTPC:
|
|
if (htab->root.sgot == NULL
|
|
&& !create_got_section (htab->root.dynobj, info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_PC24:
|
|
case R_ARM_PLT32:
|
|
case R_ARM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_JUMP24:
|
|
case R_ARM_PREL31:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_CALL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
|
|
call_reloc_p = TRUE;
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS12:
|
|
/* VxWorks uses dynamic R_ARM_ABS12 relocations for
|
|
ldr __GOTT_INDEX__ offsets. */
|
|
if (!htab->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
|
|
if (info->shared)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
|
(_("%B: relocation %s against `%s' can not be used when making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC"),
|
|
abfd, elf32_arm_howto_table_1[r_type].name,
|
|
(h) ? h->root.root.string : "a local symbol");
|
|
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32:
|
|
case R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32:
|
|
case R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
|
|
case R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
|
|
|
|
/* Should the interworking branches be listed here? */
|
|
if ((info->shared || htab->root.is_relocatable_executable)
|
|
&& (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (h == NULL
|
|
&& (r_type == R_ARM_REL32 || r_type == R_ARM_REL32_NOI))
|
|
{
|
|
/* In shared libraries and relocatable executables,
|
|
we treat local relative references as calls;
|
|
see the related SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL code in
|
|
allocate_dynrelocs. */
|
|
call_reloc_p = TRUE;
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
/* We are creating a shared library or relocatable
|
|
executable, and this is a reloc against a global symbol,
|
|
or a non-PC-relative reloc against a local symbol.
|
|
We may need to copy the reloc into the output. */
|
|
may_become_dynamic_p = TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
may_need_local_target_p = TRUE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
|
|
Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
|
|
case R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT:
|
|
if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
|
|
used. Record for later use during GC. */
|
|
case R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY:
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
|
|
if (h != NULL
|
|
&& !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (call_reloc_p)
|
|
/* We may need a .plt entry if the function this reloc
|
|
refers to is in a different object, regardless of the
|
|
symbol's type. We can't tell for sure yet, because
|
|
something later might force the symbol local. */
|
|
h->needs_plt = 1;
|
|
else if (may_need_local_target_p)
|
|
/* If this reloc is in a read-only section, we might
|
|
need a copy reloc. We can't check reliably at this
|
|
stage whether the section is read-only, as input
|
|
sections have not yet been mapped to output sections.
|
|
Tentatively set the flag for now, and correct in
|
|
adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
|
|
h->non_got_ref = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (may_need_local_target_p
|
|
&& (h != NULL || ELF32_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
|
|
{
|
|
union gotplt_union *root_plt;
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt;
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info *local_iplt;
|
|
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
root_plt = &h->plt;
|
|
arm_plt = &eh->plt;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
local_iplt = elf32_arm_create_local_iplt (abfd, r_symndx);
|
|
if (local_iplt == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
root_plt = &local_iplt->root;
|
|
arm_plt = &local_iplt->arm;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If the symbol is a function that doesn't bind locally,
|
|
this relocation will need a PLT entry. */
|
|
root_plt->refcount += 1;
|
|
|
|
if (!call_reloc_p)
|
|
arm_plt->noncall_refcount++;
|
|
|
|
/* It's too early to use htab->use_blx here, so we have to
|
|
record possible blx references separately from
|
|
relocs that definitely need a thumb stub. */
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_CALL)
|
|
arm_plt->maybe_thumb_refcount += 1;
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP24
|
|
|| r_type == R_ARM_THM_JUMP19)
|
|
arm_plt->thumb_refcount += 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (may_become_dynamic_p)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *p, **head;
|
|
|
|
/* Create a reloc section in dynobj. */
|
|
if (sreloc == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
|
|
(sec, dynobj, 2, abfd, ! htab->use_rel);
|
|
|
|
if (sreloc == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* BPABI objects never have dynamic relocations mapped. */
|
|
if (htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
flagword flags;
|
|
|
|
flags = bfd_get_section_flags (dynobj, sreloc);
|
|
flags &= ~(SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC);
|
|
bfd_set_section_flags (dynobj, sreloc, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a global symbol, count the number of
|
|
relocations we need for this symbol. */
|
|
if (h != NULL)
|
|
head = &((struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
head = elf32_arm_get_local_dynreloc_list (abfd, r_symndx, isym);
|
|
if (head == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
p = *head;
|
|
if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof *p;
|
|
|
|
p = (struct elf_dyn_relocs *) bfd_alloc (htab->root.dynobj, amt);
|
|
if (p == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
p->next = *head;
|
|
*head = p;
|
|
p->sec = sec;
|
|
p->count = 0;
|
|
p->pc_count = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (r_type == R_ARM_REL32 || r_type == R_ARM_REL32_NOI)
|
|
p->pc_count += 1;
|
|
p->count += 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Unwinding tables are not referenced directly. This pass marks them as
|
|
required if the corresponding code section is marked. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_gc_mark_extra_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
elf_gc_mark_hook_fn gc_mark_hook)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd *sub;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr **elf_shdrp;
|
|
bfd_boolean again;
|
|
|
|
/* Marking EH data may cause additional code sections to be marked,
|
|
requiring multiple passes. */
|
|
again = TRUE;
|
|
while (again)
|
|
{
|
|
again = FALSE;
|
|
for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub != NULL; sub = sub->link_next)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *o;
|
|
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (sub))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
elf_shdrp = elf_elfsections (sub);
|
|
for (o = sub->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
|
|
|
|
hdr = &elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr;
|
|
if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ARM_EXIDX
|
|
&& hdr->sh_link
|
|
&& hdr->sh_link < elf_numsections (sub)
|
|
&& !o->gc_mark
|
|
&& elf_shdrp[hdr->sh_link]->bfd_section->gc_mark)
|
|
{
|
|
again = TRUE;
|
|
if (!_bfd_elf_gc_mark (info, o, gc_mark_hook))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Treat mapping symbols as special target symbols. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_is_target_special_symbol (bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asymbol * sym)
|
|
{
|
|
return bfd_is_arm_special_symbol_name (sym->name,
|
|
BFD_ARM_SPECIAL_SYM_TYPE_ANY);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* This is a copy of elf_find_function() from elf.c except that
|
|
ARM mapping symbols are ignored when looking for function names
|
|
and STT_ARM_TFUNC is considered to a function type. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arm_elf_find_function (bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
|
asection * section,
|
|
asymbol ** symbols,
|
|
bfd_vma offset,
|
|
const char ** filename_ptr,
|
|
const char ** functionname_ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
const char * filename = NULL;
|
|
asymbol * func = NULL;
|
|
bfd_vma low_func = 0;
|
|
asymbol ** p;
|
|
|
|
for (p = symbols; *p != NULL; p++)
|
|
{
|
|
elf_symbol_type *q;
|
|
|
|
q = (elf_symbol_type *) *p;
|
|
|
|
switch (ELF_ST_TYPE (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info))
|
|
{
|
|
default:
|
|
break;
|
|
case STT_FILE:
|
|
filename = bfd_asymbol_name (&q->symbol);
|
|
break;
|
|
case STT_FUNC:
|
|
case STT_ARM_TFUNC:
|
|
case STT_NOTYPE:
|
|
/* Skip mapping symbols. */
|
|
if ((q->symbol.flags & BSF_LOCAL)
|
|
&& bfd_is_arm_special_symbol_name (q->symbol.name,
|
|
BFD_ARM_SPECIAL_SYM_TYPE_ANY))
|
|
continue;
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
if (bfd_get_section (&q->symbol) == section
|
|
&& q->symbol.value >= low_func
|
|
&& q->symbol.value <= offset)
|
|
{
|
|
func = (asymbol *) q;
|
|
low_func = q->symbol.value;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (func == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (filename_ptr)
|
|
*filename_ptr = filename;
|
|
if (functionname_ptr)
|
|
*functionname_ptr = bfd_asymbol_name (func);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset, for error
|
|
reporting. This code is a duplicate of the code in elf.c, except
|
|
that it uses arm_elf_find_function. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_find_nearest_line (bfd * abfd,
|
|
asection * section,
|
|
asymbol ** symbols,
|
|
bfd_vma offset,
|
|
const char ** filename_ptr,
|
|
const char ** functionname_ptr,
|
|
unsigned int * line_ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_boolean found = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* We skip _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line since no known ARM toolchain uses it. */
|
|
|
|
if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
|
|
filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
|
|
line_ptr, 0,
|
|
& elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!*functionname_ptr)
|
|
arm_elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
|
|
*filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
|
|
functionname_ptr);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
|
|
& found, filename_ptr,
|
|
functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
|
|
& elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (symbols == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (! arm_elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
|
|
filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
*line_ptr = 0;
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_find_inliner_info (bfd * abfd,
|
|
const char ** filename_ptr,
|
|
const char ** functionname_ptr,
|
|
unsigned int * line_ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_boolean found;
|
|
found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
|
|
functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
|
|
& elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
|
|
return found;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
|
|
regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
|
|
dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
|
|
change the definition to something the rest of the link can
|
|
understand. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd * dynobj;
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry * eh;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
|
|
&& (h->needs_plt
|
|
|| h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
|
|| h->u.weakdef != NULL
|
|
|| (h->def_dynamic
|
|
&& h->ref_regular
|
|
&& !h->def_regular)));
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a function, put it in the procedure linkage table. We
|
|
will fill in the contents of the procedure linkage table later,
|
|
when we know the address of the .got section. */
|
|
if (h->type == STT_FUNC || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC || h->needs_plt)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Calls to STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols always use a PLT, even if the
|
|
symbol binds locally. */
|
|
if (h->plt.refcount <= 0
|
|
|| (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
|
&& (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
|
|
|| (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
|
|
&& h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))))
|
|
{
|
|
/* This case can occur if we saw a PLT32 reloc in an input
|
|
file, but the symbol was never referred to by a dynamic
|
|
object, or if all references were garbage collected. In
|
|
such a case, we don't actually need to build a procedure
|
|
linkage table, and we can just do a PC24 reloc instead. */
|
|
h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
eh->plt.thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
eh->plt.maybe_thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
eh->plt.noncall_refcount = 0;
|
|
h->needs_plt = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* It's possible that we incorrectly decided a .plt reloc was
|
|
needed for an R_ARM_PC24 or similar reloc to a non-function sym
|
|
in check_relocs. We can't decide accurately between function
|
|
and non-function syms in check-relocs; Objects loaded later in
|
|
the link may change h->type. So fix it now. */
|
|
h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
eh->plt.thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
eh->plt.maybe_thumb_refcount = 0;
|
|
eh->plt.noncall_refcount = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
|
|
processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
|
|
real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
|
|
if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
|
|| h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
|
|
h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
|
|
h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If there are no non-GOT references, we do not need a copy
|
|
relocation. */
|
|
if (!h->non_got_ref)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
|
|
is not a function. */
|
|
|
|
/* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
|
|
only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
|
|
For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
|
|
be handled correctly by relocate_section. Relocatable executables
|
|
can reference data in shared objects directly, so we don't need to
|
|
do anything here. */
|
|
if (info->shared || globals->root.is_relocatable_executable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (h->size == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("dynamic variable `%s' is zero size"),
|
|
h->root.root.string);
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
|
|
become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
|
|
an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
|
|
object will contain position independent code, so all references
|
|
from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
|
|
offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
|
|
determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
|
|
both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
|
|
same memory location for the variable. */
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynbss");
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
|
|
/* We must generate a R_ARM_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic linker to
|
|
copy the initial value out of the dynamic object and into the
|
|
runtime process image. We need to remember the offset into the
|
|
.rel(a).bss section we are going to use. */
|
|
if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *srel;
|
|
|
|
srel = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, RELOC_SECTION (globals, ".bss"));
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, srel, 1);
|
|
h->needs_copy = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, s);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
|
|
dynamic relocs. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
allocate_dynrelocs_for_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void * inf)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
|
|
|
|
if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
|
/* When warning symbols are created, they **replace** the "real"
|
|
entry in the hash table, thus we never get to see the real
|
|
symbol in a hash traversal. So look at it now. */
|
|
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
|
|
info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if ((htab->root.dynamic_sections_created || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
&& h->plt.refcount > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.
|
|
Undefined weak syms won't yet be marked as dynamic. */
|
|
if (h->dynindx == -1
|
|
&& !h->forced_local)
|
|
{
|
|
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If the call in the PLT entry binds locally, the associated
|
|
GOT entry should use an R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocation instead of
|
|
the usual R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT. Put it in the .iplt section rather
|
|
than the .plt section. */
|
|
if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
{
|
|
eh->is_iplt = 1;
|
|
if (eh->plt.noncall_refcount == 0
|
|
&& SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
/* All non-call references can be resolved directly.
|
|
This means that they can (and in some cases, must)
|
|
resolve directly to the run-time target, rather than
|
|
to the PLT. That in turns means that any .got entry
|
|
would be equal to the .igot.plt entry, so there's
|
|
no point having both. */
|
|
h->got.refcount = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (info->shared
|
|
|| eh->is_iplt
|
|
|| WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (1, 0, h))
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_plt_entry (info, eh->is_iplt, &h->plt, &eh->plt);
|
|
|
|
/* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, and we are
|
|
not generating a shared library, then set the symbol to this
|
|
location in the .plt. This is required to make function
|
|
pointers compare as equal between the normal executable and
|
|
the shared library. */
|
|
if (! info->shared
|
|
&& !h->def_regular)
|
|
{
|
|
h->root.u.def.section = htab->root.splt;
|
|
h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure the function is not marked as Thumb, in case
|
|
it is the target of an ABS32 relocation, which will
|
|
point to the PLT entry. */
|
|
h->target_internal = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
htab->next_tls_desc_index++;
|
|
|
|
/* VxWorks executables have a second set of relocations for
|
|
each PLT entry. They go in a separate relocation section,
|
|
which is processed by the kernel loader. */
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p && !info->shared)
|
|
{
|
|
/* There is a relocation for the initial PLT entry:
|
|
an R_ARM_32 relocation for _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
|
|
if (h->plt.offset == htab->plt_header_size)
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->srelplt2, 1);
|
|
|
|
/* There are two extra relocations for each subsequent
|
|
PLT entry: an R_ARM_32 relocation for the GOT entry,
|
|
and an R_ARM_32 relocation for the PLT entry. */
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->srelplt2, 2);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
h->needs_plt = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
h->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
h->needs_plt = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
eh->tlsdesc_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
|
|
if (h->got.refcount > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *s;
|
|
bfd_boolean dyn;
|
|
int tls_type = elf32_arm_hash_entry (h)->tls_type;
|
|
int indx;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.
|
|
Undefined weak syms won't yet be marked as dynamic. */
|
|
if (h->dynindx == -1
|
|
&& !h->forced_local)
|
|
{
|
|
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
s = htab->root.sgot;
|
|
h->got.offset = s->size;
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type == GOT_UNKNOWN)
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
|
|
/* Non-TLS symbols need one GOT slot. */
|
|
s->size += 4;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC)
|
|
{
|
|
/* R_ARM_TLS_DESC needs 2 GOT slots. */
|
|
eh->tlsdesc_got
|
|
= (htab->root.sgotplt->size
|
|
- elf32_arm_compute_jump_table_size (htab));
|
|
htab->root.sgotplt->size += 8;
|
|
h->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -2;
|
|
/* plt.got_offset needs to know there's a TLS_DESC
|
|
reloc in the middle of .got.plt. */
|
|
htab->num_tls_desc++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
|
|
{
|
|
/* R_ARM_TLS_GD32 needs 2 consecutive GOT slots. If
|
|
the symbol is both GD and GDESC, got.offset may
|
|
have been overwritten. */
|
|
h->got.offset = s->size;
|
|
s->size += 8;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
|
|
/* R_ARM_TLS_IE32 needs one GOT slot. */
|
|
s->size += 4;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
dyn = htab->root.dynamic_sections_created;
|
|
|
|
indx = 0;
|
|
if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
|
|
&& (!info->shared
|
|
|| !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
|
|
indx = h->dynindx;
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type != GOT_NORMAL
|
|
&& (info->shared || indx != 0)
|
|
&& (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
|
|
|| h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
|
|
{
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelgot, 1);
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelgot, 1);
|
|
|
|
if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC)
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelplt, 1);
|
|
/* GDESC needs a trampoline to jump to. */
|
|
htab->tls_trampoline = -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Only GD needs it. GDESC just emits one relocation per
|
|
2 entries. */
|
|
if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) && indx != 0)
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelgot, 1);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
{
|
|
if (htab->root.dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
/* Reserve room for the GOT entry's R_ARM_GLOB_DAT relocation. */
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelgot, 1);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
|
&& eh->plt.noncall_refcount == 0)
|
|
/* No non-call references resolve the STT_GNU_IFUNC's PLT entry;
|
|
they all resolve dynamically instead. Reserve room for the
|
|
GOT entry's R_ARM_IRELATIVE relocation. */
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs (info, htab->root.srelgot, 1);
|
|
else if (info->shared)
|
|
/* Reserve room for the GOT entry's R_ARM_RELATIVE relocation. */
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelgot, 1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
h->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate stubs for exported Thumb functions on v4t. */
|
|
if (!htab->use_blx && h->dynindx != -1
|
|
&& h->def_regular
|
|
&& h->target_internal == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB
|
|
&& ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * th;
|
|
struct bfd_link_hash_entry * bh;
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * myh;
|
|
char name[1024];
|
|
asection *s;
|
|
bh = NULL;
|
|
/* Create a new symbol to regist the real location of the function. */
|
|
s = h->root.u.def.section;
|
|
sprintf (name, "__real_%s", h->root.root.string);
|
|
_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner,
|
|
name, BSF_GLOBAL, s,
|
|
h->root.u.def.value,
|
|
NULL, TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
|
|
|
|
myh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
|
myh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
|
|
myh->forced_local = 1;
|
|
myh->target_internal = ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB;
|
|
eh->export_glue = myh;
|
|
th = record_arm_to_thumb_glue (info, h);
|
|
/* Point the symbol at the stub. */
|
|
h->type = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (h->type), STT_FUNC);
|
|
h->target_internal = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
h->root.u.def.section = th->root.u.def.section;
|
|
h->root.u.def.value = th->root.u.def.value & ~1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
|
|
dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
|
|
defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
|
|
space for pc-relative relocs that have become local due to symbol
|
|
visibility changes. */
|
|
|
|
if (info->shared || htab->root.is_relocatable_executable)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The only relocs that use pc_count are R_ARM_REL32 and
|
|
R_ARM_REL32_NOI, which will appear on something like
|
|
".long foo - .". We want calls to protected symbols to resolve
|
|
directly to the function rather than going via the plt. If people
|
|
want function pointer comparisons to work as expected then they
|
|
should avoid writing assembly like ".long foo - .". */
|
|
if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
|
|
|
|
for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
|
|
{
|
|
p->count -= p->pc_count;
|
|
p->pc_count = 0;
|
|
if (p->count == 0)
|
|
*pp = p->next;
|
|
else
|
|
pp = &p->next;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
|
|
|
|
for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
|
|
{
|
|
if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
|
|
*pp = p->next;
|
|
else
|
|
pp = &p->next;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
|
|
visibility. */
|
|
if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL
|
|
&& h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
|
|
eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure undefined weak symbols are output as a dynamic
|
|
symbol in PIEs. */
|
|
else if (h->dynindx == -1
|
|
&& !h->forced_local)
|
|
{
|
|
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else if (htab->root.is_relocatable_executable && h->dynindx == -1
|
|
&& h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Output absolute symbols so that we can create relocations
|
|
against them. For normal symbols we output a relocation
|
|
against the section that contains them. */
|
|
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* For the non-shared case, discard space for relocs against
|
|
symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
|
|
dynamic. */
|
|
|
|
if (!h->non_got_ref
|
|
&& ((h->def_dynamic
|
|
&& !h->def_regular)
|
|
|| (htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
|
|
&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
|
|
|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined))))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.
|
|
Undefined weak syms won't yet be marked as dynamic. */
|
|
if (h->dynindx == -1
|
|
&& !h->forced_local)
|
|
{
|
|
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If that succeeded, we know we'll be keeping all the
|
|
relocs. */
|
|
if (h->dynindx != -1)
|
|
goto keep;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
|
|
|
|
keep: ;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Finally, allocate space. */
|
|
for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
|
|
if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
|
&& eh->plt.noncall_refcount == 0
|
|
&& SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs (info, sreloc, p->count);
|
|
else
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, sreloc, p->count);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Find any dynamic relocs that apply to read-only sections. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry * h, void * inf)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry * eh;
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs * p;
|
|
|
|
if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
|
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *s = p->sec;
|
|
|
|
if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
|
|
|
|
info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
|
|
|
|
/* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_set_byteswap_code (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
int byteswap_code)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
globals->byteswap_code = byteswap_code;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_size_dynamic_sections (bfd * output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info * info)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd * dynobj;
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
bfd_boolean plt;
|
|
bfd_boolean relocs;
|
|
bfd *ibfd;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
|
|
check_use_blx (htab);
|
|
|
|
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
|
|
if (info->executable)
|
|
{
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
|
|
s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
|
|
relocs. */
|
|
for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link_next)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info **local_iplt_ptr, *local_iplt;
|
|
char *local_tls_type;
|
|
bfd_vma *local_tlsdesc_gotent;
|
|
bfd_size_type locsymcount;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
|
asection *srel;
|
|
bfd_boolean is_vxworks = htab->vxworks_p;
|
|
unsigned int symndx;
|
|
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (ibfd))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
|
|
|
|
for (p = (struct elf_dyn_relocs *)
|
|
elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
|
|
&& bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
|
|
{
|
|
/* Input section has been discarded, either because
|
|
it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
|
|
linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
|
|
the relocs too. */
|
|
}
|
|
else if (is_vxworks
|
|
&& strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
|
|
".tls_vars") == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
|
|
handled specially by the loader. */
|
|
}
|
|
else if (p->count != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
srel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, srel, p->count);
|
|
if ((p->sec->output_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
|
|
info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
|
|
if (!local_got)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
symtab_hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
|
|
locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
|
|
end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
|
|
local_iplt_ptr = elf32_arm_local_iplt (ibfd);
|
|
local_tls_type = elf32_arm_local_got_tls_type (ibfd);
|
|
local_tlsdesc_gotent = elf32_arm_local_tlsdesc_gotent (ibfd);
|
|
symndx = 0;
|
|
s = htab->root.sgot;
|
|
srel = htab->root.srelgot;
|
|
for (; local_got < end_local_got;
|
|
++local_got, ++local_iplt_ptr, ++local_tls_type,
|
|
++local_tlsdesc_gotent, ++symndx)
|
|
{
|
|
*local_tlsdesc_gotent = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
local_iplt = *local_iplt_ptr;
|
|
if (local_iplt != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
|
|
|
|
if (local_iplt->root.refcount > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_plt_entry (info, TRUE,
|
|
&local_iplt->root,
|
|
&local_iplt->arm);
|
|
if (local_iplt->arm.noncall_refcount == 0)
|
|
/* All references to the PLT are calls, so all
|
|
non-call references can resolve directly to the
|
|
run-time target. This means that the .got entry
|
|
would be the same as the .igot.plt entry, so there's
|
|
no point creating both. */
|
|
*local_got = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (local_iplt->arm.noncall_refcount == 0);
|
|
local_iplt->root.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for (p = local_iplt->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *psrel;
|
|
|
|
psrel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
|
|
if (local_iplt->arm.noncall_refcount == 0)
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs (info, psrel, p->count);
|
|
else
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, psrel, p->count);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (*local_got > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
|
|
|
|
*local_got = s->size;
|
|
if (*local_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
|
|
/* TLS_GD relocs need an 8-byte structure in the GOT. */
|
|
s->size += 8;
|
|
if (*local_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC)
|
|
{
|
|
*local_tlsdesc_gotent = htab->root.sgotplt->size
|
|
- elf32_arm_compute_jump_table_size (htab);
|
|
htab->root.sgotplt->size += 8;
|
|
*local_got = (bfd_vma) -2;
|
|
/* plt.got_offset needs to know there's a TLS_DESC
|
|
reloc in the middle of .got.plt. */
|
|
htab->num_tls_desc++;
|
|
}
|
|
if (*local_tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
|
|
s->size += 4;
|
|
|
|
if (*local_tls_type & GOT_NORMAL)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If the symbol is both GD and GDESC, *local_got
|
|
may have been overwritten. */
|
|
*local_got = s->size;
|
|
s->size += 4;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, ibfd, symndx);
|
|
if (isym == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* If all references to an STT_GNU_IFUNC PLT are calls,
|
|
then all non-call references, including this GOT entry,
|
|
resolve directly to the run-time target. */
|
|
if (ELF32_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
|
|
&& (local_iplt == NULL
|
|
|| local_iplt->arm.noncall_refcount == 0))
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_irelocs (info, srel, 1);
|
|
else if ((info->shared && !(*local_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC))
|
|
|| *local_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, srel, 1);
|
|
|
|
if (info->shared && *local_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GDESC)
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelplt, 1);
|
|
htab->tls_trampoline = -1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
*local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->tls_ldm_got.refcount > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Allocate two GOT entries and one dynamic relocation (if necessary)
|
|
for R_ARM_TLS_LDM32 relocations. */
|
|
htab->tls_ldm_got.offset = htab->root.sgot->size;
|
|
htab->root.sgot->size += 8;
|
|
if (info->shared)
|
|
elf32_arm_allocate_dynrelocs (info, htab->root.srelgot, 1);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
htab->tls_ldm_got.offset = -1;
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate global sym .plt and .got entries, and space for global
|
|
sym dynamic relocs. */
|
|
elf_link_hash_traverse (& htab->root, allocate_dynrelocs_for_symbol, info);
|
|
|
|
/* Here we rummage through the found bfds to collect glue information. */
|
|
for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link_next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (ibfd))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Initialise mapping tables for code/data. */
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_init_maps (ibfd);
|
|
|
|
if (!bfd_elf32_arm_process_before_allocation (ibfd, info)
|
|
|| !bfd_elf32_arm_vfp11_erratum_scan (ibfd, info))
|
|
/* xgettext:c-format */
|
|
_bfd_error_handler (_("Errors encountered processing file %s"),
|
|
ibfd->filename);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate space for the glue sections now that we've sized them. */
|
|
bfd_elf32_arm_allocate_interworking_sections (info);
|
|
|
|
/* For every jump slot reserved in the sgotplt, reloc_count is
|
|
incremented. However, when we reserve space for TLS descriptors,
|
|
it's not incremented, so in order to compute the space reserved
|
|
for them, it suffices to multiply the reloc count by the jump
|
|
slot size. */
|
|
if (htab->root.srelplt)
|
|
htab->sgotplt_jump_table_size = elf32_arm_compute_jump_table_size(htab);
|
|
|
|
if (htab->tls_trampoline)
|
|
{
|
|
if (htab->root.splt->size == 0)
|
|
htab->root.splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
|
|
|
|
htab->tls_trampoline = htab->root.splt->size;
|
|
htab->root.splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
|
|
|
|
/* If we're not using lazy TLS relocations, don't generate the
|
|
PLT and GOT entries they require. */
|
|
if (!(info->flags & DF_BIND_NOW))
|
|
{
|
|
htab->dt_tlsdesc_got = htab->root.sgot->size;
|
|
htab->root.sgot->size += 4;
|
|
|
|
htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt = htab->root.splt->size;
|
|
htab->root.splt->size += 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (dl_tlsdesc_lazy_trampoline);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
|
|
determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
|
|
memory for them. */
|
|
plt = FALSE;
|
|
relocs = FALSE;
|
|
for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
|
|
{
|
|
const char * name;
|
|
|
|
if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
|
|
of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
|
|
name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
|
|
|
|
if (s == htab->root.splt)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Remember whether there is a PLT. */
|
|
plt = s->size != 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
|
|
{
|
|
if (s->size != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Remember whether there are any reloc sections other
|
|
than .rel(a).plt and .rela.plt.unloaded. */
|
|
if (s != htab->root.srelplt && s != htab->srelplt2)
|
|
relocs = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
|
|
to copy relocs into the output file. */
|
|
s->reloc_count = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (s != htab->root.sgot
|
|
&& s != htab->root.sgotplt
|
|
&& s != htab->root.iplt
|
|
&& s != htab->root.igotplt
|
|
&& s != htab->sdynbss)
|
|
{
|
|
/* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (s->size == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
|
|
output file. This is mostly to handle .rel(a).bss and
|
|
.rel(a).plt. We must create both sections in
|
|
create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
|
|
before the linker maps input sections to output
|
|
sections. The linker does that before
|
|
adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
|
|
function which decides whether anything needs to go
|
|
into these sections. */
|
|
s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
|
|
s->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
|
|
if (s->contents == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
|
|
values later, in elf32_arm_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
|
|
must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
|
|
the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
|
|
dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
|
|
#define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
|
|
_bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
|
|
|
|
if (info->executable)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (plt)
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL,
|
|
htab->use_rel ? DT_REL : DT_RELA)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt &&
|
|
(!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TLSDESC_PLT,0)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_TLSDESC_GOT,0)))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (relocs)
|
|
{
|
|
if (htab->use_rel)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_REL, 0)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELSZ, 0)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELENT, RELOC_SIZE (htab)))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
|
|
|| !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, RELOC_SIZE (htab)))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section,
|
|
then we need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
|
|
if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
|
|
elf_link_hash_traverse (& htab->root, elf32_arm_readonly_dynrelocs,
|
|
info);
|
|
|
|
if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p
|
|
&& !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
#undef add_dynamic_entry
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Size sections even though they're not dynamic. We use it to setup
|
|
_TLS_MODULE_BASE_, if needed. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *tls_sec;
|
|
|
|
if (info->relocatable)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
tls_sec = elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec;
|
|
|
|
if (tls_sec)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
|
|
|
|
tlsbase = elf_link_hash_lookup
|
|
(elf_hash_table (info), "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_", TRUE, TRUE, FALSE);
|
|
|
|
if (tlsbase)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
|
|
const struct elf_backend_data *bed
|
|
= get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
|
|
|
|
if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
|
|
(info, output_bfd, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_", BSF_LOCAL,
|
|
tls_sec, 0, NULL, FALSE,
|
|
bed->collect, &bh)))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
tlsbase->type = STT_TLS;
|
|
tlsbase = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *)bh;
|
|
tlsbase->def_regular = 1;
|
|
tlsbase->other = STV_HIDDEN;
|
|
(*bed->elf_backend_hide_symbol) (info, tlsbase, TRUE);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
|
|
dynamic sections here. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd * output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info * info,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
|
|
if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!eh->is_iplt)
|
|
{
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
|
|
elf32_arm_populate_plt_entry (output_bfd, info, &h->plt, &eh->plt,
|
|
h->dynindx, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!h->def_regular)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as defined in
|
|
the .plt section. Leave the value alone. */
|
|
sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
|
|
/* If the symbol is weak, we do need to clear the value.
|
|
Otherwise, the PLT entry would provide a definition for
|
|
the symbol even if the symbol wasn't defined anywhere,
|
|
and so the symbol would never be NULL. */
|
|
if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
|
|
sym->st_value = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (eh->is_iplt && eh->plt.noncall_refcount != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* At least one non-call relocation references this .iplt entry,
|
|
so the .iplt entry is the function's canonical address. */
|
|
sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (sym->st_info), STT_FUNC);
|
|
sym->st_target_internal = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
sym->st_shndx = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(output_bfd, htab->root.iplt->output_section));
|
|
sym->st_value = (h->plt.offset
|
|
+ htab->root.iplt->output_section->vma
|
|
+ htab->root.iplt->output_offset);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (h->needs_copy)
|
|
{
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
|
|
|
|
/* This symbol needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
|
|
&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
|
|| h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak));
|
|
|
|
s = htab->srelbss;
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
|
|
rel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.value
|
|
+ h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_ARM_COPY);
|
|
elf32_arm_add_dynreloc (output_bfd, info, s, &rel);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. On VxWorks,
|
|
the _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ symbol is not absolute: it is relative
|
|
to the ".got" section. */
|
|
if (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
|
|
|| (!htab->vxworks_p && h == htab->root.hgot))
|
|
sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
arm_put_trampoline (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab, bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
void *contents,
|
|
const unsigned long *template, unsigned count)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned ix;
|
|
|
|
for (ix = 0; ix != count; ix++)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long insn = template[ix];
|
|
|
|
/* Emit mov pc,rx if bx is not permitted. */
|
|
if (htab->fix_v4bx == 1 && (insn & 0x0ffffff0) == 0x012fff10)
|
|
insn = (insn & 0xf000000f) | 0x01a0f000;
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, insn, (char *)contents + ix*4);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd * output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info * info)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd * dynobj;
|
|
asection * sgot;
|
|
asection * sdyn;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
|
|
|
sgot = htab->root.sgotplt;
|
|
sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
|
|
|
|
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *splt;
|
|
Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
|
|
|
|
splt = htab->root.splt;
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (htab->symbian_p || sgot != NULL);
|
|
|
|
dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
|
|
dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
|
|
|
|
for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
|
|
const char * name;
|
|
asection * s;
|
|
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
|
|
|
|
switch (dyn.d_tag)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int type;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p
|
|
&& elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DT_HASH:
|
|
name = ".hash";
|
|
goto get_vma_if_bpabi;
|
|
case DT_STRTAB:
|
|
name = ".dynstr";
|
|
goto get_vma_if_bpabi;
|
|
case DT_SYMTAB:
|
|
name = ".dynsym";
|
|
goto get_vma_if_bpabi;
|
|
case DT_VERSYM:
|
|
name = ".gnu.version";
|
|
goto get_vma_if_bpabi;
|
|
case DT_VERDEF:
|
|
name = ".gnu.version_d";
|
|
goto get_vma_if_bpabi;
|
|
case DT_VERNEED:
|
|
name = ".gnu.version_r";
|
|
goto get_vma_if_bpabi;
|
|
|
|
case DT_PLTGOT:
|
|
name = ".got";
|
|
goto get_vma;
|
|
case DT_JMPREL:
|
|
name = RELOC_SECTION (htab, ".plt");
|
|
get_vma:
|
|
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
if (!htab->symbian_p)
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
|
|
else
|
|
/* In the BPABI, tags in the PT_DYNAMIC section point
|
|
at the file offset, not the memory address, for the
|
|
convenience of the post linker. */
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->filepos;
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
get_vma_if_bpabi:
|
|
if (htab->symbian_p)
|
|
goto get_vma;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DT_PLTRELSZ:
|
|
s = htab->root.srelplt;
|
|
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size;
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DT_RELSZ:
|
|
case DT_RELASZ:
|
|
if (!htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
/* My reading of the SVR4 ABI indicates that the
|
|
procedure linkage table relocs (DT_JMPREL) should be
|
|
included in the overall relocs (DT_REL). This is
|
|
what Solaris does. However, UnixWare can not handle
|
|
that case. Therefore, we override the DT_RELSZ entry
|
|
here to make it not include the JMPREL relocs. Since
|
|
the linker script arranges for .rel(a).plt to follow all
|
|
other relocation sections, we don't have to worry
|
|
about changing the DT_REL entry. */
|
|
s = htab->root.srelplt;
|
|
if (s != NULL)
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_val -= s->size;
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
/* Fall through. */
|
|
|
|
case DT_REL:
|
|
case DT_RELA:
|
|
/* In the BPABI, the DT_REL tag must point at the file
|
|
offset, not the VMA, of the first relocation
|
|
section. So, we use code similar to that in
|
|
elflink.c, but do not check for SHF_ALLOC on the
|
|
relcoation section, since relocations sections are
|
|
never allocated under the BPABI. The comments above
|
|
about Unixware notwithstanding, we include all of the
|
|
relocations here. */
|
|
if (htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
|
type = ((dyn.d_tag == DT_REL || dyn.d_tag == DT_RELSZ)
|
|
? SHT_REL : SHT_RELA);
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_val = 0;
|
|
for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (output_bfd); i++)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr
|
|
= elf_elfsections (output_bfd)[i];
|
|
if (hdr->sh_type == type)
|
|
{
|
|
if (dyn.d_tag == DT_RELSZ
|
|
|| dyn.d_tag == DT_RELASZ)
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_val += hdr->sh_size;
|
|
else if ((ufile_ptr) hdr->sh_offset
|
|
<= dyn.d_un.d_val - 1)
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_val = hdr->sh_offset;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DT_TLSDESC_PLT:
|
|
s = htab->root.splt;
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
|
|
+ htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt);
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DT_TLSDESC_GOT:
|
|
s = htab->root.sgot;
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
|
|
+ htab->dt_tlsdesc_got);
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
/* Set the bottom bit of DT_INIT/FINI if the
|
|
corresponding function is Thumb. */
|
|
case DT_INIT:
|
|
name = info->init_function;
|
|
goto get_sym;
|
|
case DT_FINI:
|
|
name = info->fini_function;
|
|
get_sym:
|
|
/* If it wasn't set by elf_bfd_final_link
|
|
then there is nothing to adjust. */
|
|
if (dyn.d_un.d_val != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry * eh;
|
|
|
|
eh = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (info), name,
|
|
FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
|
if (eh != NULL && eh->target_internal == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
{
|
|
dyn.d_un.d_val |= 1;
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in the first entry in the procedure linkage table. */
|
|
if (splt->size > 0 && htab->plt_header_size)
|
|
{
|
|
const bfd_vma *plt0_entry;
|
|
bfd_vma got_address, plt_address, got_displacement;
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate the addresses of the GOT and PLT. */
|
|
got_address = sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset;
|
|
plt_address = splt->output_section->vma + splt->output_offset;
|
|
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
/* The VxWorks GOT is relocated by the dynamic linker.
|
|
Therefore, we must emit relocations rather than simply
|
|
computing the values now. */
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
|
|
|
|
plt0_entry = elf32_arm_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, plt0_entry[0],
|
|
splt->contents + 0);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, plt0_entry[1],
|
|
splt->contents + 4);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, plt0_entry[2],
|
|
splt->contents + 8);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, got_address, splt->contents + 12);
|
|
|
|
/* Generate a relocation for _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
|
|
rel.r_offset = plt_address + 12;
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_ARM_ABS32);
|
|
rel.r_addend = 0;
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (htab) (output_bfd, &rel,
|
|
htab->srelplt2->contents);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
got_displacement = got_address - (plt_address + 16);
|
|
|
|
plt0_entry = elf32_arm_plt0_entry;
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, plt0_entry[0],
|
|
splt->contents + 0);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, plt0_entry[1],
|
|
splt->contents + 4);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, plt0_entry[2],
|
|
splt->contents + 8);
|
|
put_arm_insn (htab, output_bfd, plt0_entry[3],
|
|
splt->contents + 12);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
/* The displacement value goes in the otherwise-unused
|
|
last word of the second entry. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, got_displacement, splt->contents + 28);
|
|
#else
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, got_displacement, splt->contents + 16);
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* UnixWare sets the entsize of .plt to 4, although that doesn't
|
|
really seem like the right value. */
|
|
if (splt->output_section->owner == output_bfd)
|
|
elf_section_data (splt->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
|
|
|
|
if (htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma got_address
|
|
= sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset;
|
|
bfd_vma gotplt_address = (htab->root.sgot->output_section->vma
|
|
+ htab->root.sgot->output_offset);
|
|
bfd_vma plt_address
|
|
= splt->output_section->vma + splt->output_offset;
|
|
|
|
arm_put_trampoline (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
splt->contents + htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt,
|
|
dl_tlsdesc_lazy_trampoline, 6);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
|
|
gotplt_address + htab->dt_tlsdesc_got
|
|
- (plt_address + htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt)
|
|
- dl_tlsdesc_lazy_trampoline[6],
|
|
splt->contents + htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt + 24);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
|
|
got_address - (plt_address + htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt)
|
|
- dl_tlsdesc_lazy_trampoline[7],
|
|
splt->contents + htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt + 24 + 4);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->tls_trampoline)
|
|
{
|
|
arm_put_trampoline (htab, output_bfd,
|
|
splt->contents + htab->tls_trampoline,
|
|
tls_trampoline, 3);
|
|
#ifdef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x00000000,
|
|
splt->contents + htab->tls_trampoline + 12);
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p && !info->shared && htab->root.splt->size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Correct the .rel(a).plt.unloaded relocations. They will have
|
|
incorrect symbol indexes. */
|
|
int num_plts;
|
|
unsigned char *p;
|
|
|
|
num_plts = ((htab->root.splt->size - htab->plt_header_size)
|
|
/ htab->plt_entry_size);
|
|
p = htab->srelplt2->contents + RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
|
|
for (; num_plts; num_plts--)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
|
|
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_IN (htab) (output_bfd, p, &rel);
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_ARM_ABS32);
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (htab) (output_bfd, &rel, p);
|
|
p += RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_IN (htab) (output_bfd, p, &rel);
|
|
rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_ARM_ABS32);
|
|
SWAP_RELOC_OUT (htab) (output_bfd, &rel, p);
|
|
p += RELOC_SIZE (htab);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fill in the first three entries in the global offset table. */
|
|
if (sgot)
|
|
{
|
|
if (sgot->size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (sdyn == NULL)
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
|
|
else
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
|
|
sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset,
|
|
sgot->contents);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents + 4);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents + 8);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd, struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals;
|
|
|
|
i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
|
|
|
|
if (EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (i_ehdrp->e_flags) == EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN)
|
|
i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_ARM;
|
|
else
|
|
i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = 0;
|
|
i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = ARM_ELF_ABI_VERSION;
|
|
|
|
if (link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
if (globals != NULL && globals->byteswap_code)
|
|
i_ehdrp->e_flags |= EF_ARM_BE8;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static enum elf_reloc_type_class
|
|
elf32_arm_reloc_type_class (const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
|
|
{
|
|
switch ((int) ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
|
|
{
|
|
case R_ARM_RELATIVE:
|
|
return reloc_class_relative;
|
|
case R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT:
|
|
return reloc_class_plt;
|
|
case R_ARM_COPY:
|
|
return reloc_class_copy;
|
|
default:
|
|
return reloc_class_normal;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Set the right machine number for an Arm ELF file. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_section_flags (flagword *flags, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
|
|
{
|
|
if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
|
|
*flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_CONTENTS;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_arm_update_notes (abfd, ARM_NOTE_SECTION);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return TRUE if this is an unwinding table entry. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
is_arm_elf_unwind_section_name (bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const char * name)
|
|
{
|
|
return (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ELF_STRING_ARM_unwind)
|
|
|| CONST_STRNEQ (name, ELF_STRING_ARM_unwind_once));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set the type and flags for an ARM section. We do this by
|
|
the section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_fake_sections (bfd * abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr, asection * sec)
|
|
{
|
|
const char * name;
|
|
|
|
name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
|
|
|
|
if (is_arm_elf_unwind_section_name (abfd, name))
|
|
{
|
|
hdr->sh_type = SHT_ARM_EXIDX;
|
|
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
|
|
}
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Handle an ARM specific section when reading an object file. This is
|
|
called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
|
|
type. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,
|
|
const char *name,
|
|
int shindex)
|
|
{
|
|
/* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
|
|
at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
|
|
sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
|
|
names for all the ARM specific sections, so we will probably get
|
|
away with this. */
|
|
switch (hdr->sh_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case SHT_ARM_EXIDX:
|
|
case SHT_ARM_PREEMPTMAP:
|
|
case SHT_ARM_ATTRIBUTES:
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static _arm_elf_section_data *
|
|
get_arm_elf_section_data (asection * sec)
|
|
{
|
|
if (sec && sec->owner && is_arm_elf (sec->owner))
|
|
return elf32_arm_section_data (sec);
|
|
else
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
typedef struct
|
|
{
|
|
void *finfo;
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info;
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
int sec_shndx;
|
|
int (*func) (void *, const char *, Elf_Internal_Sym *,
|
|
asection *, struct elf_link_hash_entry *);
|
|
} output_arch_syminfo;
|
|
|
|
enum map_symbol_type
|
|
{
|
|
ARM_MAP_ARM,
|
|
ARM_MAP_THUMB,
|
|
ARM_MAP_DATA
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Output a single mapping symbol. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_output_map_sym (output_arch_syminfo *osi,
|
|
enum map_symbol_type type,
|
|
bfd_vma offset)
|
|
{
|
|
static const char *names[3] = {"$a", "$t", "$d"};
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
|
|
|
|
sym.st_value = osi->sec->output_section->vma
|
|
+ osi->sec->output_offset
|
|
+ offset;
|
|
sym.st_size = 0;
|
|
sym.st_other = 0;
|
|
sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_NOTYPE);
|
|
sym.st_shndx = osi->sec_shndx;
|
|
sym.st_target_internal = 0;
|
|
elf32_arm_section_map_add (osi->sec, names[type][1], offset);
|
|
return osi->func (osi->finfo, names[type], &sym, osi->sec, NULL) == 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Output mapping symbols for the PLT entry described by ROOT_PLT and ARM_PLT.
|
|
IS_IPLT_ENTRY_P says whether the PLT is in .iplt rather than .plt. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_output_plt_map_1 (output_arch_syminfo *osi,
|
|
bfd_boolean is_iplt_entry_p,
|
|
union gotplt_union *root_plt,
|
|
struct arm_plt_info *arm_plt)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
bfd_vma addr, plt_header_size;
|
|
|
|
if (root_plt->offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (osi->info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (is_iplt_entry_p)
|
|
{
|
|
osi->sec = htab->root.iplt;
|
|
plt_header_size = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
osi->sec = htab->root.splt;
|
|
plt_header_size = htab->plt_header_size;
|
|
}
|
|
osi->sec_shndx = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(osi->info->output_bfd, osi->sec->output_section));
|
|
|
|
addr = root_plt->offset & -2;
|
|
if (htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, addr))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, addr + 4))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (htab->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, addr))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, addr + 8))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, addr + 12))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, addr + 20))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_boolean thumb_stub_p;
|
|
|
|
thumb_stub_p = elf32_arm_plt_needs_thumb_stub_p (osi->info, arm_plt);
|
|
if (thumb_stub_p)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_THUMB, addr - 4))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
#ifdef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, addr))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, addr + 12))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
#else
|
|
/* A three-word PLT with no Thumb thunk contains only Arm code,
|
|
so only need to output a mapping symbol for the first PLT entry and
|
|
entries with thumb thunks. */
|
|
if (thumb_stub_p || addr == plt_header_size)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, addr))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Output mapping symbols for PLT entries associated with H. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_output_plt_map (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
|
|
{
|
|
output_arch_syminfo *osi = (output_arch_syminfo *) inf;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *eh;
|
|
|
|
if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
|
/* When warning symbols are created, they **replace** the "real"
|
|
entry in the hash table, thus we never get to see the real
|
|
symbol in a hash traversal. So look at it now. */
|
|
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
|
|
|
|
eh = (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
|
return elf32_arm_output_plt_map_1 (osi, SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (osi->info, h),
|
|
&h->plt, &eh->plt);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Output a single local symbol for a generated stub. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_output_stub_sym (output_arch_syminfo *osi, const char *name,
|
|
bfd_vma offset, bfd_vma size)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
|
|
|
|
sym.st_value = osi->sec->output_section->vma
|
|
+ osi->sec->output_offset
|
|
+ offset;
|
|
sym.st_size = size;
|
|
sym.st_other = 0;
|
|
sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
|
|
sym.st_shndx = osi->sec_shndx;
|
|
sym.st_target_internal = 0;
|
|
return osi->func (osi->finfo, name, &sym, osi->sec, NULL) == 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
arm_map_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry * gen_entry,
|
|
void * in_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
asection *stub_sec;
|
|
bfd_vma addr;
|
|
char *stub_name;
|
|
output_arch_syminfo *osi;
|
|
const insn_sequence *template_sequence;
|
|
enum stub_insn_type prev_type;
|
|
int size;
|
|
int i;
|
|
enum map_symbol_type sym_type;
|
|
|
|
/* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
|
|
stub_entry = (struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
|
|
osi = (output_arch_syminfo *) in_arg;
|
|
|
|
stub_sec = stub_entry->stub_sec;
|
|
|
|
/* Ensure this stub is attached to the current section being
|
|
processed. */
|
|
if (stub_sec != osi->sec)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
addr = (bfd_vma) stub_entry->stub_offset;
|
|
stub_name = stub_entry->output_name;
|
|
|
|
template_sequence = stub_entry->stub_template;
|
|
switch (template_sequence[0].type)
|
|
{
|
|
case ARM_TYPE:
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_stub_sym (osi, stub_name, addr, stub_entry->stub_size))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
case THUMB16_TYPE:
|
|
case THUMB32_TYPE:
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_stub_sym (osi, stub_name, addr | 1,
|
|
stub_entry->stub_size))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
BFD_FAIL ();
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
prev_type = DATA_TYPE;
|
|
size = 0;
|
|
for (i = 0; i < stub_entry->stub_template_size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (template_sequence[i].type)
|
|
{
|
|
case ARM_TYPE:
|
|
sym_type = ARM_MAP_ARM;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case THUMB16_TYPE:
|
|
case THUMB32_TYPE:
|
|
sym_type = ARM_MAP_THUMB;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DATA_TYPE:
|
|
sym_type = ARM_MAP_DATA;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
BFD_FAIL ();
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (template_sequence[i].type != prev_type)
|
|
{
|
|
prev_type = template_sequence[i].type;
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (osi, sym_type, addr + size))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
switch (template_sequence[i].type)
|
|
{
|
|
case ARM_TYPE:
|
|
case THUMB32_TYPE:
|
|
size += 4;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case THUMB16_TYPE:
|
|
size += 2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case DATA_TYPE:
|
|
size += 4;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
BFD_FAIL ();
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Output mapping symbols for linker generated sections,
|
|
and for those data-only sections that do not have a
|
|
$d. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_output_arch_local_syms (bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
void *finfo,
|
|
int (*func) (void *, const char *,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *,
|
|
asection *,
|
|
struct elf_link_hash_entry *))
|
|
{
|
|
output_arch_syminfo osi;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab;
|
|
bfd_vma offset;
|
|
bfd_size_type size;
|
|
bfd *input_bfd;
|
|
|
|
htab = elf32_arm_hash_table (info);
|
|
if (htab == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
check_use_blx (htab);
|
|
|
|
osi.finfo = finfo;
|
|
osi.info = info;
|
|
osi.func = func;
|
|
|
|
/* Add a $d mapping symbol to data-only sections that
|
|
don't have any mapping symbol. This may result in (harmless) redundant
|
|
mapping symbols. */
|
|
for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds;
|
|
input_bfd != NULL;
|
|
input_bfd = input_bfd->link_next)
|
|
{
|
|
if ((input_bfd->flags & (BFD_LINKER_CREATED | HAS_SYMS)) == HAS_SYMS)
|
|
for (osi.sec = input_bfd->sections;
|
|
osi.sec != NULL;
|
|
osi.sec = osi.sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
if (osi.sec->output_section != NULL
|
|
&& ((osi.sec->output_section->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
|
|
!= 0)
|
|
&& (osi.sec->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LINKER_CREATED))
|
|
== SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
|
|
&& get_arm_elf_section_data (osi.sec) != NULL
|
|
&& get_arm_elf_section_data (osi.sec)->mapcount == 0
|
|
&& osi.sec->size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
osi.sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(output_bfd, osi.sec->output_section);
|
|
if (osi.sec_shndx != (int)SHN_BAD)
|
|
elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* ARM->Thumb glue. */
|
|
if (htab->arm_glue_size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
osi.sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (htab->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
ARM2THUMB_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
osi.sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(output_bfd, osi.sec->output_section);
|
|
if (info->shared || htab->root.is_relocatable_executable
|
|
|| htab->pic_veneer)
|
|
size = ARM2THUMB_PIC_GLUE_SIZE;
|
|
else if (htab->use_blx)
|
|
size = ARM2THUMB_V5_STATIC_GLUE_SIZE;
|
|
else
|
|
size = ARM2THUMB_STATIC_GLUE_SIZE;
|
|
|
|
for (offset = 0; offset < htab->arm_glue_size; offset += size)
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, offset);
|
|
elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, offset + size - 4);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Thumb->ARM glue. */
|
|
if (htab->thumb_glue_size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
osi.sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (htab->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
osi.sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(output_bfd, osi.sec->output_section);
|
|
size = THUMB2ARM_GLUE_SIZE;
|
|
|
|
for (offset = 0; offset < htab->thumb_glue_size; offset += size)
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_THUMB, offset);
|
|
elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, offset + 4);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* ARMv4 BX veneers. */
|
|
if (htab->bx_glue_size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
osi.sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (htab->bfd_of_glue_owner,
|
|
ARM_BX_GLUE_SECTION_NAME);
|
|
|
|
osi.sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(output_bfd, osi.sec->output_section);
|
|
|
|
elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Long calls stubs. */
|
|
if (htab->stub_bfd && htab->stub_bfd->sections)
|
|
{
|
|
asection* stub_sec;
|
|
|
|
for (stub_sec = htab->stub_bfd->sections;
|
|
stub_sec != NULL;
|
|
stub_sec = stub_sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Ignore non-stub sections. */
|
|
if (!strstr (stub_sec->name, STUB_SUFFIX))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
osi.sec = stub_sec;
|
|
|
|
osi.sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(output_bfd, osi.sec->output_section);
|
|
|
|
bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, arm_map_one_stub, &osi);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Finally, output mapping symbols for the PLT. */
|
|
if (htab->root.splt && htab->root.splt->size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
osi.sec = htab->root.splt;
|
|
osi.sec_shndx = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
|
|
(output_bfd, osi.sec->output_section));
|
|
|
|
/* Output mapping symbols for the plt header. SymbianOS does not have a
|
|
plt header. */
|
|
if (htab->vxworks_p)
|
|
{
|
|
/* VxWorks shared libraries have no PLT header. */
|
|
if (!info->shared)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, 0))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, 12))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!htab->symbian_p)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, 0))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
#ifndef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_DATA, 16))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ((htab->root.splt && htab->root.splt->size > 0)
|
|
|| (htab->root.iplt && htab->root.iplt->size > 0))
|
|
{
|
|
elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->root, elf32_arm_output_plt_map, &osi);
|
|
for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds;
|
|
input_bfd != NULL;
|
|
input_bfd = input_bfd->link_next)
|
|
{
|
|
struct arm_local_iplt_info **local_iplt;
|
|
unsigned int i, num_syms;
|
|
|
|
local_iplt = elf32_arm_local_iplt (input_bfd);
|
|
if (local_iplt != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
num_syms = elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd).sh_info;
|
|
for (i = 0; i < num_syms; i++)
|
|
if (local_iplt[i] != NULL
|
|
&& !elf32_arm_output_plt_map_1 (&osi, TRUE,
|
|
&local_iplt[i]->root,
|
|
&local_iplt[i]->arm))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Mapping symbols for the lazy tls trampoline. */
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_DATA,
|
|
htab->dt_tlsdesc_plt + 24))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
if (htab->tls_trampoline != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Mapping symbols for the tls trampoline. */
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_ARM, htab->tls_trampoline))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
#ifdef FOUR_WORD_PLT
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_output_map_sym (&osi, ARM_MAP_DATA,
|
|
htab->tls_trampoline + 12))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate target specific section data. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
|
|
{
|
|
_arm_elf_section_data *sdata;
|
|
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
|
|
|
|
sdata = (_arm_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
|
if (sdata == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Used to order a list of mapping symbols by address. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
elf32_arm_compare_mapping (const void * a, const void * b)
|
|
{
|
|
const elf32_arm_section_map *amap = (const elf32_arm_section_map *) a;
|
|
const elf32_arm_section_map *bmap = (const elf32_arm_section_map *) b;
|
|
|
|
if (amap->vma > bmap->vma)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
else if (amap->vma < bmap->vma)
|
|
return -1;
|
|
else if (amap->type > bmap->type)
|
|
/* Ensure results do not depend on the host qsort for objects with
|
|
multiple mapping symbols at the same address by sorting on type
|
|
after vma. */
|
|
return 1;
|
|
else if (amap->type < bmap->type)
|
|
return -1;
|
|
else
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add OFFSET to lower 31 bits of ADDR, leaving other bits unmodified. */
|
|
|
|
static unsigned long
|
|
offset_prel31 (unsigned long addr, bfd_vma offset)
|
|
{
|
|
return (addr & ~0x7ffffffful) | ((addr + offset) & 0x7ffffffful);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Copy an .ARM.exidx table entry, adding OFFSET to (applied) PREL31
|
|
relocations. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
copy_exidx_entry (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *to, bfd_byte *from, bfd_vma offset)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned long first_word = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, from);
|
|
unsigned long second_word = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, from + 4);
|
|
|
|
/* High bit of first word is supposed to be zero. */
|
|
if ((first_word & 0x80000000ul) == 0)
|
|
first_word = offset_prel31 (first_word, offset);
|
|
|
|
/* If the high bit of the first word is clear, and the bit pattern is not 0x1
|
|
(EXIDX_CANTUNWIND), this is an offset to an .ARM.extab entry. */
|
|
if ((second_word != 0x1) && ((second_word & 0x80000000ul) == 0))
|
|
second_word = offset_prel31 (second_word, offset);
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, first_word, to);
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, second_word, to + 4);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Data for make_branch_to_a8_stub(). */
|
|
|
|
struct a8_branch_to_stub_data {
|
|
asection *writing_section;
|
|
bfd_byte *contents;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Helper to insert branches to Cortex-A8 erratum stubs in the right
|
|
places for a particular section. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
make_branch_to_a8_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry,
|
|
void *in_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
|
|
struct a8_branch_to_stub_data *data;
|
|
bfd_byte *contents;
|
|
unsigned long branch_insn;
|
|
bfd_vma veneered_insn_loc, veneer_entry_loc;
|
|
bfd_signed_vma branch_offset;
|
|
bfd *abfd;
|
|
unsigned int target;
|
|
|
|
stub_entry = (struct elf32_arm_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
|
|
data = (struct a8_branch_to_stub_data *) in_arg;
|
|
|
|
if (stub_entry->target_section != data->writing_section
|
|
|| stub_entry->stub_type < arm_stub_a8_veneer_lwm)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
contents = data->contents;
|
|
|
|
veneered_insn_loc = stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma
|
|
+ stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->target_value;
|
|
|
|
veneer_entry_loc = stub_entry->stub_sec->output_section->vma
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ stub_entry->stub_offset;
|
|
|
|
if (stub_entry->stub_type == arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx)
|
|
veneered_insn_loc &= ~3u;
|
|
|
|
branch_offset = veneer_entry_loc - veneered_insn_loc - 4;
|
|
|
|
abfd = stub_entry->target_section->owner;
|
|
target = stub_entry->target_value;
|
|
|
|
/* We attempt to avoid this condition by setting stubs_always_after_branch
|
|
in elf32_arm_size_stubs if we've enabled the Cortex-A8 erratum workaround.
|
|
This check is just to be on the safe side... */
|
|
if ((veneered_insn_loc & ~0xfff) == (veneer_entry_loc & ~0xfff))
|
|
{
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: error: Cortex-A8 erratum stub is "
|
|
"allocated in unsafe location"), abfd);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
|
|
{
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_b:
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond:
|
|
branch_insn = 0xf0009000;
|
|
goto jump24;
|
|
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx:
|
|
branch_insn = 0xf000e800;
|
|
goto jump24;
|
|
|
|
case arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl:
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int i1, j1, i2, j2, s;
|
|
|
|
branch_insn = 0xf000d000;
|
|
|
|
jump24:
|
|
if (branch_offset < -16777216 || branch_offset > 16777214)
|
|
{
|
|
/* There's not much we can do apart from complain if this
|
|
happens. */
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: error: Cortex-A8 erratum stub out "
|
|
"of range (input file too large)"), abfd);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* i1 = not(j1 eor s), so:
|
|
not i1 = j1 eor s
|
|
j1 = (not i1) eor s. */
|
|
|
|
branch_insn |= (branch_offset >> 1) & 0x7ff;
|
|
branch_insn |= ((branch_offset >> 12) & 0x3ff) << 16;
|
|
i2 = (branch_offset >> 22) & 1;
|
|
i1 = (branch_offset >> 23) & 1;
|
|
s = (branch_offset >> 24) & 1;
|
|
j1 = (!i1) ^ s;
|
|
j2 = (!i2) ^ s;
|
|
branch_insn |= j2 << 11;
|
|
branch_insn |= j1 << 13;
|
|
branch_insn |= s << 26;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
BFD_FAIL ();
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bfd_put_16 (abfd, (branch_insn >> 16) & 0xffff, &contents[target]);
|
|
bfd_put_16 (abfd, branch_insn & 0xffff, &contents[target + 2]);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Do code byteswapping. Return FALSE afterwards so that the section is
|
|
written out as normal. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
|
asection *sec,
|
|
bfd_byte *contents)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int mapcount, errcount;
|
|
_arm_elf_section_data *arm_data;
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *globals = elf32_arm_hash_table (link_info);
|
|
elf32_arm_section_map *map;
|
|
elf32_vfp11_erratum_list *errnode;
|
|
bfd_vma ptr;
|
|
bfd_vma end;
|
|
bfd_vma offset = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
|
|
bfd_byte tmp;
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
|
|
|
if (globals == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* If this section has not been allocated an _arm_elf_section_data
|
|
structure then we cannot record anything. */
|
|
arm_data = get_arm_elf_section_data (sec);
|
|
if (arm_data == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
mapcount = arm_data->mapcount;
|
|
map = arm_data->map;
|
|
errcount = arm_data->erratumcount;
|
|
|
|
if (errcount != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int endianflip = bfd_big_endian (output_bfd) ? 3 : 0;
|
|
|
|
for (errnode = arm_data->erratumlist; errnode != 0;
|
|
errnode = errnode->next)
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma target = errnode->vma - offset;
|
|
|
|
switch (errnode->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case VFP11_ERRATUM_BRANCH_TO_ARM_VENEER:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma branch_to_veneer;
|
|
/* Original condition code of instruction, plus bit mask for
|
|
ARM B instruction. */
|
|
unsigned int insn = (errnode->u.b.vfp_insn & 0xf0000000)
|
|
| 0x0a000000;
|
|
|
|
/* The instruction is before the label. */
|
|
target -= 4;
|
|
|
|
/* Above offset included in -4 below. */
|
|
branch_to_veneer = errnode->u.b.veneer->vma
|
|
- errnode->vma - 4;
|
|
|
|
if ((signed) branch_to_veneer < -(1 << 25)
|
|
|| (signed) branch_to_veneer >= (1 << 25))
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: error: VFP11 veneer out of "
|
|
"range"), output_bfd);
|
|
|
|
insn |= (branch_to_veneer >> 2) & 0xffffff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ target] = insn & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 1)] = (insn >> 8) & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 2)] = (insn >> 16) & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 3)] = (insn >> 24) & 0xff;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case VFP11_ERRATUM_ARM_VENEER:
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_vma branch_from_veneer;
|
|
unsigned int insn;
|
|
|
|
/* Take size of veneer into account. */
|
|
branch_from_veneer = errnode->u.v.branch->vma
|
|
- errnode->vma - 12;
|
|
|
|
if ((signed) branch_from_veneer < -(1 << 25)
|
|
|| (signed) branch_from_veneer >= (1 << 25))
|
|
(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: error: VFP11 veneer out of "
|
|
"range"), output_bfd);
|
|
|
|
/* Original instruction. */
|
|
insn = errnode->u.v.branch->u.b.vfp_insn;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ target] = insn & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 1)] = (insn >> 8) & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 2)] = (insn >> 16) & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 3)] = (insn >> 24) & 0xff;
|
|
|
|
/* Branch back to insn after original insn. */
|
|
insn = 0xea000000 | ((branch_from_veneer >> 2) & 0xffffff);
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 4)] = insn & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 5)] = (insn >> 8) & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 6)] = (insn >> 16) & 0xff;
|
|
contents[endianflip ^ (target + 7)] = (insn >> 24) & 0xff;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
abort ();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (arm_data->elf.this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
|
|
{
|
|
arm_unwind_table_edit *edit_node
|
|
= arm_data->u.exidx.unwind_edit_list;
|
|
/* Now, sec->size is the size of the section we will write. The original
|
|
size (before we merged duplicate entries and inserted EXIDX_CANTUNWIND
|
|
markers) was sec->rawsize. (This isn't the case if we perform no
|
|
edits, then rawsize will be zero and we should use size). */
|
|
bfd_byte *edited_contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (sec->size);
|
|
unsigned int input_size = sec->rawsize ? sec->rawsize : sec->size;
|
|
unsigned int in_index, out_index;
|
|
bfd_vma add_to_offsets = 0;
|
|
|
|
for (in_index = 0, out_index = 0; in_index * 8 < input_size || edit_node;)
|
|
{
|
|
if (edit_node)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int edit_index = edit_node->index;
|
|
|
|
if (in_index < edit_index && in_index * 8 < input_size)
|
|
{
|
|
copy_exidx_entry (output_bfd, edited_contents + out_index * 8,
|
|
contents + in_index * 8, add_to_offsets);
|
|
out_index++;
|
|
in_index++;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (in_index == edit_index
|
|
|| (in_index * 8 >= input_size
|
|
&& edit_index == UINT_MAX))
|
|
{
|
|
switch (edit_node->type)
|
|
{
|
|
case DELETE_EXIDX_ENTRY:
|
|
in_index++;
|
|
add_to_offsets += 8;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case INSERT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND_AT_END:
|
|
{
|
|
asection *text_sec = edit_node->linked_section;
|
|
bfd_vma text_offset = text_sec->output_section->vma
|
|
+ text_sec->output_offset
|
|
+ text_sec->size;
|
|
bfd_vma exidx_offset = offset + out_index * 8;
|
|
unsigned long prel31_offset;
|
|
|
|
/* Note: this is meant to be equivalent to an
|
|
R_ARM_PREL31 relocation. These synthetic
|
|
EXIDX_CANTUNWIND markers are not relocated by the
|
|
usual BFD method. */
|
|
prel31_offset = (text_offset - exidx_offset)
|
|
& 0x7ffffffful;
|
|
|
|
/* First address we can't unwind. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, prel31_offset,
|
|
&edited_contents[out_index * 8]);
|
|
|
|
/* Code for EXIDX_CANTUNWIND. */
|
|
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x1,
|
|
&edited_contents[out_index * 8 + 4]);
|
|
|
|
out_index++;
|
|
add_to_offsets -= 8;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
edit_node = edit_node->next;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/* No more edits, copy remaining entries verbatim. */
|
|
copy_exidx_entry (output_bfd, edited_contents + out_index * 8,
|
|
contents + in_index * 8, add_to_offsets);
|
|
out_index++;
|
|
in_index++;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!(sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) && !(sec->flags & SEC_NEVER_LOAD))
|
|
bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section,
|
|
edited_contents,
|
|
(file_ptr) sec->output_offset, sec->size);
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Fix code to point to Cortex-A8 erratum stubs. */
|
|
if (globals->fix_cortex_a8)
|
|
{
|
|
struct a8_branch_to_stub_data data;
|
|
|
|
data.writing_section = sec;
|
|
data.contents = contents;
|
|
|
|
bfd_hash_traverse (&globals->stub_hash_table, make_branch_to_a8_stub,
|
|
&data);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (mapcount == 0)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (globals->byteswap_code)
|
|
{
|
|
qsort (map, mapcount, sizeof (* map), elf32_arm_compare_mapping);
|
|
|
|
ptr = map[0].vma;
|
|
for (i = 0; i < mapcount; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
if (i == mapcount - 1)
|
|
end = sec->size;
|
|
else
|
|
end = map[i + 1].vma;
|
|
|
|
switch (map[i].type)
|
|
{
|
|
case 'a':
|
|
/* Byte swap code words. */
|
|
while (ptr + 3 < end)
|
|
{
|
|
tmp = contents[ptr];
|
|
contents[ptr] = contents[ptr + 3];
|
|
contents[ptr + 3] = tmp;
|
|
tmp = contents[ptr + 1];
|
|
contents[ptr + 1] = contents[ptr + 2];
|
|
contents[ptr + 2] = tmp;
|
|
ptr += 4;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 't':
|
|
/* Byte swap code halfwords. */
|
|
while (ptr + 1 < end)
|
|
{
|
|
tmp = contents[ptr];
|
|
contents[ptr] = contents[ptr + 1];
|
|
contents[ptr + 1] = tmp;
|
|
ptr += 2;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case 'd':
|
|
/* Leave data alone. */
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
ptr = end;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
free (map);
|
|
arm_data->mapcount = -1;
|
|
arm_data->mapsize = 0;
|
|
arm_data->map = NULL;
|
|
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Mangle thumb function symbols as we read them in. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_swap_symbol_in (bfd * abfd,
|
|
const void *psrc,
|
|
const void *pshn,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *dst)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!bfd_elf32_swap_symbol_in (abfd, psrc, pshn, dst))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* New EABI objects mark thumb function symbols by setting the low bit of
|
|
the address. */
|
|
if ((ELF_ST_TYPE (dst->st_info) == STT_FUNC
|
|
|| ELF_ST_TYPE (dst->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
&& (dst->st_value & 1))
|
|
{
|
|
dst->st_value &= ~(bfd_vma) 1;
|
|
dst->st_target_internal = ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (ELF_ST_TYPE (dst->st_info) == STT_ARM_TFUNC)
|
|
{
|
|
dst->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (dst->st_info), STT_FUNC);
|
|
dst->st_target_internal = ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (ELF_ST_TYPE (dst->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
|
|
dst->st_target_internal = ST_BRANCH_LONG;
|
|
else
|
|
dst->st_target_internal = ST_BRANCH_TO_ARM;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mangle thumb function symbols as we write them out. */
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_swap_symbol_out (bfd *abfd,
|
|
const Elf_Internal_Sym *src,
|
|
void *cdst,
|
|
void *shndx)
|
|
{
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym newsym;
|
|
|
|
/* We convert STT_ARM_TFUNC symbols into STT_FUNC with the low bit
|
|
of the address set, as per the new EABI. We do this unconditionally
|
|
because objcopy does not set the elf header flags until after
|
|
it writes out the symbol table. */
|
|
if (src->st_target_internal == ST_BRANCH_TO_THUMB)
|
|
{
|
|
newsym = *src;
|
|
if (ELF_ST_TYPE (src->st_info) != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
newsym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (src->st_info), STT_FUNC);
|
|
if (newsym.st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Do this only for defined symbols. At link type, the static
|
|
linker will simulate the work of dynamic linker of resolving
|
|
symbols and will carry over the thumbness of found symbols to
|
|
the output symbol table. It's not clear how it happens, but
|
|
the thumbness of undefined symbols can well be different at
|
|
runtime, and writing '1' for them will be confusing for users
|
|
and possibly for dynamic linker itself.
|
|
*/
|
|
newsym.st_value |= 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
src = &newsym;
|
|
}
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_symbol_out (abfd, src, cdst, shndx);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Add the PT_ARM_EXIDX program header. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_segment_map *m;
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
|
|
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".ARM.exidx");
|
|
if (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
/* If there is already a PT_ARM_EXIDX header, then we do not
|
|
want to add another one. This situation arises when running
|
|
"strip"; the input binary already has the header. */
|
|
m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
|
|
while (m && m->p_type != PT_ARM_EXIDX)
|
|
m = m->next;
|
|
if (!m)
|
|
{
|
|
m = (struct elf_segment_map *)
|
|
bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
|
|
if (m == NULL)
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
m->p_type = PT_ARM_EXIDX;
|
|
m->count = 1;
|
|
m->sections[0] = sec;
|
|
|
|
m->next = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
|
|
elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map = m;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We may add a PT_ARM_EXIDX program header. */
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
elf32_arm_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
|
{
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
|
|
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".ARM.exidx");
|
|
if (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
else
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
|
|
file. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
|
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
|
|
flagword *flagsp, asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
|
|
{
|
|
if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0
|
|
&& ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
|
|
elf_tdata (info->output_bfd)->has_ifunc_symbols = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (elf32_arm_hash_table (info)->vxworks_p
|
|
&& !elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep,
|
|
flagsp, secp, valp))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* We use this to override swap_symbol_in and swap_symbol_out. */
|
|
const struct elf_size_info elf32_arm_size_info =
|
|
{
|
|
sizeof (Elf32_External_Ehdr),
|
|
sizeof (Elf32_External_Phdr),
|
|
sizeof (Elf32_External_Shdr),
|
|
sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
|
|
sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela),
|
|
sizeof (Elf32_External_Sym),
|
|
sizeof (Elf32_External_Dyn),
|
|
sizeof (Elf_External_Note),
|
|
4,
|
|
1,
|
|
32, 2,
|
|
ELFCLASS32, EV_CURRENT,
|
|
bfd_elf32_write_out_phdrs,
|
|
bfd_elf32_write_shdrs_and_ehdr,
|
|
bfd_elf32_checksum_contents,
|
|
bfd_elf32_write_relocs,
|
|
elf32_arm_swap_symbol_in,
|
|
elf32_arm_swap_symbol_out,
|
|
bfd_elf32_slurp_reloc_table,
|
|
bfd_elf32_slurp_symbol_table,
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in,
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out,
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in,
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out,
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in,
|
|
bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
#define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_arm
|
|
#define ELF_TARGET_ID ARM_ELF_DATA
|
|
#define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_ARM
|
|
#ifdef __QNXTARGET__
|
|
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x1000
|
|
#else
|
|
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x8000
|
|
#endif
|
|
#define ELF_MINPAGESIZE 0x1000
|
|
#define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
|
|
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_mkobject elf32_arm_mkobject
|
|
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_copy_private_bfd_data elf32_arm_copy_private_bfd_data
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data elf32_arm_merge_private_bfd_data
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags elf32_arm_set_private_flags
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_print_private_bfd_data elf32_arm_print_private_bfd_data
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create elf32_arm_link_hash_table_create
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_free elf32_arm_hash_table_free
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup elf32_arm_reloc_type_lookup
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup elf32_arm_reloc_name_lookup
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_find_nearest_line elf32_arm_find_nearest_line
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_find_inliner_info elf32_arm_find_inliner_info
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_new_section_hook elf32_arm_new_section_hook
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_is_target_special_symbol elf32_arm_is_target_special_symbol
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_final_link elf32_arm_final_link
|
|
|
|
#define elf_backend_get_symbol_type elf32_arm_get_symbol_type
|
|
#define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook elf32_arm_gc_mark_hook
|
|
#define elf_backend_gc_mark_extra_sections elf32_arm_gc_mark_extra_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_gc_sweep_hook elf32_arm_gc_sweep_hook
|
|
#define elf_backend_check_relocs elf32_arm_check_relocs
|
|
#define elf_backend_relocate_section elf32_arm_relocate_section
|
|
#define elf_backend_write_section elf32_arm_write_section
|
|
#define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol elf32_arm_adjust_dynamic_symbol
|
|
#define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections elf32_arm_create_dynamic_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol elf32_arm_finish_dynamic_symbol
|
|
#define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections elf32_arm_finish_dynamic_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections elf32_arm_size_dynamic_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_always_size_sections elf32_arm_always_size_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_2_index_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_post_process_headers elf32_arm_post_process_headers
|
|
#define elf_backend_reloc_type_class elf32_arm_reloc_type_class
|
|
#define elf_backend_object_p elf32_arm_object_p
|
|
#define elf_backend_section_flags elf32_arm_section_flags
|
|
#define elf_backend_fake_sections elf32_arm_fake_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_section_from_shdr elf32_arm_section_from_shdr
|
|
#define elf_backend_final_write_processing elf32_arm_final_write_processing
|
|
#define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol elf32_arm_copy_indirect_symbol
|
|
#define elf_backend_size_info elf32_arm_size_info
|
|
#define elf_backend_modify_segment_map elf32_arm_modify_segment_map
|
|
#define elf_backend_additional_program_headers elf32_arm_additional_program_headers
|
|
#define elf_backend_output_arch_local_syms elf32_arm_output_arch_local_syms
|
|
#define elf_backend_begin_write_processing elf32_arm_begin_write_processing
|
|
#define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook elf32_arm_add_symbol_hook
|
|
|
|
#define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
|
|
#define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
|
|
#define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
|
|
#define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
|
|
#define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 0
|
|
#define elf_backend_may_use_rel_p 1
|
|
#define elf_backend_may_use_rela_p 0
|
|
#define elf_backend_default_use_rela_p 0
|
|
|
|
#define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
|
|
|
|
#undef elf_backend_obj_attrs_vendor
|
|
#define elf_backend_obj_attrs_vendor "aeabi"
|
|
#undef elf_backend_obj_attrs_section
|
|
#define elf_backend_obj_attrs_section ".ARM.attributes"
|
|
#undef elf_backend_obj_attrs_arg_type
|
|
#define elf_backend_obj_attrs_arg_type elf32_arm_obj_attrs_arg_type
|
|
#undef elf_backend_obj_attrs_section_type
|
|
#define elf_backend_obj_attrs_section_type SHT_ARM_ATTRIBUTES
|
|
#define elf_backend_obj_attrs_order elf32_arm_obj_attrs_order
|
|
#define elf_backend_obj_attrs_handle_unknown elf32_arm_obj_attrs_handle_unknown
|
|
|
|
#include "elf32-target.h"
|
|
|
|
/* VxWorks Targets. */
|
|
|
|
#undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
|
|
#define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM bfd_elf32_littlearm_vxworks_vec
|
|
#undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
|
|
#define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-littlearm-vxworks"
|
|
#undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
|
|
#define TARGET_BIG_SYM bfd_elf32_bigarm_vxworks_vec
|
|
#undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
|
|
#define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-bigarm-vxworks"
|
|
|
|
/* Like elf32_arm_link_hash_table_create -- but overrides
|
|
appropriately for VxWorks. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
|
|
elf32_arm_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
|
|
|
|
ret = elf32_arm_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
|
|
if (ret)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab
|
|
= (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *) ret;
|
|
htab->use_rel = 0;
|
|
htab->vxworks_p = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return ret;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker)
|
|
{
|
|
elf32_arm_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
|
|
elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#undef elf32_bed
|
|
#define elf32_bed elf32_arm_vxworks_bed
|
|
|
|
#undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create elf32_arm_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
|
|
#undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
|
|
#define elf_backend_final_write_processing elf32_arm_vxworks_final_write_processing
|
|
#undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
|
|
#define elf_backend_emit_relocs elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
|
|
|
|
#undef elf_backend_may_use_rel_p
|
|
#define elf_backend_may_use_rel_p 0
|
|
#undef elf_backend_may_use_rela_p
|
|
#define elf_backend_may_use_rela_p 1
|
|
#undef elf_backend_default_use_rela_p
|
|
#define elf_backend_default_use_rela_p 1
|
|
#undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
|
|
#define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
|
|
#undef ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
|
|
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x1000
|
|
|
|
#include "elf32-target.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
|
|
object file when linking. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd * ibfd, bfd * obfd)
|
|
{
|
|
flagword out_flags;
|
|
flagword in_flags;
|
|
bfd_boolean flags_compatible = TRUE;
|
|
asection *sec;
|
|
|
|
/* Check if we have the same endianess. */
|
|
if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
if (! is_arm_elf (ibfd) || ! is_arm_elf (obfd))
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_merge_eabi_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* The input BFD must have had its flags initialised. */
|
|
/* The following seems bogus to me -- The flags are initialized in
|
|
the assembler but I don't think an elf_flags_init field is
|
|
written into the object. */
|
|
/* BFD_ASSERT (elf_flags_init (ibfd)); */
|
|
|
|
in_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
|
|
out_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
|
|
|
|
/* In theory there is no reason why we couldn't handle this. However
|
|
in practice it isn't even close to working and there is no real
|
|
reason to want it. */
|
|
if (EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (in_flags) >= EF_ARM_EABI_VER4
|
|
&& !(ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC)
|
|
&& (in_flags & EF_ARM_BE8))
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler (_("error: %B is already in final BE8 format"),
|
|
ibfd);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
|
|
{
|
|
/* If the input is the default architecture and had the default
|
|
flags then do not bother setting the flags for the output
|
|
architecture, instead allow future merges to do this. If no
|
|
future merges ever set these flags then they will retain their
|
|
uninitialised values, which surprise surprise, correspond
|
|
to the default values. */
|
|
if (bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd)->the_default
|
|
&& elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags == 0)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
|
|
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = in_flags;
|
|
|
|
if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
|
|
&& bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
|
|
return bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd));
|
|
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Determine what should happen if the input ARM architecture
|
|
does not match the output ARM architecture. */
|
|
if (! bfd_arm_merge_machines (ibfd, obfd))
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
|
|
/* Identical flags must be compatible. */
|
|
if (in_flags == out_flags)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
|
|
/* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections. If
|
|
not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it
|
|
cannot actually cause any incompatiblity. Do not short-circuit
|
|
dynamic objects; their section list may be emptied by
|
|
elf_link_add_object_symbols.
|
|
|
|
Also check to see if there are no code sections in the input.
|
|
In this case there is no need to check for code specific flags.
|
|
XXX - do we need to worry about floating-point format compatability
|
|
in data sections ? */
|
|
if (!(ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC))
|
|
{
|
|
bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
|
|
bfd_boolean only_data_sections = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
|
|
{
|
|
/* Ignore synthetic glue sections. */
|
|
if (strcmp (sec->name, ".glue_7")
|
|
&& strcmp (sec->name, ".glue_7t"))
|
|
{
|
|
if ((bfd_get_section_flags (ibfd, sec)
|
|
& (SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
|
|
== (SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
|
|
only_data_sections = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
null_input_bfd = FALSE;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (null_input_bfd || only_data_sections)
|
|
return TRUE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Complain about various flag mismatches. */
|
|
if (!elf32_arm_versions_compatible (EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (in_flags),
|
|
EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (out_flags)))
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: Source object %B has EABI version %d, but target %B has EABI version %d"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd,
|
|
(in_flags & EF_ARM_EABIMASK) >> 24,
|
|
(out_flags & EF_ARM_EABIMASK) >> 24);
|
|
return FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Not sure what needs to be checked for EABI versions >= 1. */
|
|
/* VxWorks libraries do not use these flags. */
|
|
if (get_elf_backend_data (obfd) != &elf32_arm_vxworks_bed
|
|
&& get_elf_backend_data (ibfd) != &elf32_arm_vxworks_bed
|
|
&& EF_ARM_EABI_VERSION (in_flags) == EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN)
|
|
{
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_26) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_26))
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B is compiled for APCS-%d, whereas target %B uses APCS-%d"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd,
|
|
in_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_26 ? 26 : 32,
|
|
out_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_26 ? 26 : 32);
|
|
flags_compatible = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT))
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT)
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B passes floats in float registers, whereas %B passes them in integer registers"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
else
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B passes floats in integer registers, whereas %B passes them in float registers"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
|
|
flags_compatible = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_VFP_FLOAT) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_VFP_FLOAT))
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_flags & EF_ARM_VFP_FLOAT)
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B uses VFP instructions, whereas %B does not"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
else
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B uses FPA instructions, whereas %B does not"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
|
|
flags_compatible = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_MAVERICK_FLOAT) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_MAVERICK_FLOAT))
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_flags & EF_ARM_MAVERICK_FLOAT)
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B uses Maverick instructions, whereas %B does not"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
else
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B does not use Maverick instructions, whereas %B does"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
|
|
flags_compatible = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifdef EF_ARM_SOFT_FLOAT
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_SOFT_FLOAT) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_SOFT_FLOAT))
|
|
{
|
|
/* We can allow interworking between code that is VFP format
|
|
layout, and uses either soft float or integer regs for
|
|
passing floating point arguments and results. We already
|
|
know that the APCS_FLOAT flags match; similarly for VFP
|
|
flags. */
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_APCS_FLOAT) != 0
|
|
|| (in_flags & EF_ARM_VFP_FLOAT) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_flags & EF_ARM_SOFT_FLOAT)
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B uses software FP, whereas %B uses hardware FP"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
else
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("error: %B uses hardware FP, whereas %B uses software FP"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
|
|
flags_compatible = FALSE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
/* Interworking mismatch is only a warning. */
|
|
if ((in_flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK) != (out_flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK))
|
|
{
|
|
if (in_flags & EF_ARM_INTERWORK)
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("Warning: %B supports interworking, whereas %B does not"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_bfd_error_handler
|
|
(_("Warning: %B does not support interworking, whereas %B does"),
|
|
ibfd, obfd);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return flags_compatible;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Symbian OS Targets. */
|
|
|
|
#undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
|
|
#define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM bfd_elf32_littlearm_symbian_vec
|
|
#undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
|
|
#define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-littlearm-symbian"
|
|
#undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
|
|
#define TARGET_BIG_SYM bfd_elf32_bigarm_symbian_vec
|
|
#undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
|
|
#define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-bigarm-symbian"
|
|
|
|
/* Like elf32_arm_link_hash_table_create -- but overrides
|
|
appropriately for Symbian OS. */
|
|
|
|
static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
|
|
elf32_arm_symbian_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
|
|
{
|
|
struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
|
|
|
|
ret = elf32_arm_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
|
|
if (ret)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *htab
|
|
= (struct elf32_arm_link_hash_table *)ret;
|
|
/* There is no PLT header for Symbian OS. */
|
|
htab->plt_header_size = 0;
|
|
/* The PLT entries are each one instruction and one word. */
|
|
htab->plt_entry_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_symbian_plt_entry);
|
|
htab->symbian_p = 1;
|
|
/* Symbian uses armv5t or above, so use_blx is always true. */
|
|
htab->use_blx = 1;
|
|
htab->root.is_relocatable_executable = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
return ret;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section
|
|
elf32_arm_symbian_special_sections[] =
|
|
{
|
|
/* In a BPABI executable, the dynamic linking sections do not go in
|
|
the loadable read-only segment. The post-linker may wish to
|
|
refer to these sections, but they are not part of the final
|
|
program image. */
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, 0 },
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, 0 },
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, 0 },
|
|
/* These sections do not need to be writable as the SymbianOS
|
|
postlinker will arrange things so that no dynamic relocation is
|
|
required. */
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC },
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC },
|
|
{ STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC },
|
|
{ NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
elf32_arm_symbian_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
|
|
{
|
|
/* BPABI objects are never loaded directly by an OS kernel; they are
|
|
processed by a postlinker first, into an OS-specific format. If
|
|
the D_PAGED bit is set on the file, BFD will align segments on
|
|
page boundaries, so that an OS can directly map the file. With
|
|
BPABI objects, that just results in wasted space. In addition,
|
|
because we clear the D_PAGED bit, map_sections_to_segments will
|
|
recognize that the program headers should not be mapped into any
|
|
loadable segment. */
|
|
abfd->flags &= ~D_PAGED;
|
|
elf32_arm_begin_write_processing (abfd, link_info);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bfd_boolean
|
|
elf32_arm_symbian_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
|
|
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
|
{
|
|
struct elf_segment_map *m;
|
|
asection *dynsec;
|
|
|
|
/* BPABI shared libraries and executables should have a PT_DYNAMIC
|
|
segment. However, because the .dynamic section is not marked
|
|
with SEC_LOAD, the generic ELF code will not create such a
|
|
segment. */
|
|
dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
|
|
if (dynsec)
|
|
{
|
|
for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
|
|
if (m->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
if (m == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
|
|
m->next = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
|
|
elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map = m;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Also call the generic arm routine. */
|
|
return elf32_arm_modify_segment_map (abfd, info);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
|
|
or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
|
|
|
|
static bfd_vma
|
|
elf32_arm_symbian_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i, const asection *plt,
|
|
const arelent *rel ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
|
{
|
|
return plt->vma + 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (elf32_arm_symbian_plt_entry) * i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
#undef elf32_bed
|
|
#define elf32_bed elf32_arm_symbian_bed
|
|
|
|
/* The dynamic sections are not allocated on SymbianOS; the postlinker
|
|
will process them and then discard them. */
|
|
#undef ELF_DYNAMIC_SEC_FLAGS
|
|
#define ELF_DYNAMIC_SEC_FLAGS \
|
|
(SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
|
|
|
|
#undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
|
|
|
|
#undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
|
|
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create elf32_arm_symbian_link_hash_table_create
|
|
#undef elf_backend_special_sections
|
|
#define elf_backend_special_sections elf32_arm_symbian_special_sections
|
|
#undef elf_backend_begin_write_processing
|
|
#define elf_backend_begin_write_processing elf32_arm_symbian_begin_write_processing
|
|
#undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
|
|
#define elf_backend_final_write_processing elf32_arm_final_write_processing
|
|
|
|
#undef elf_backend_modify_segment_map
|
|
#define elf_backend_modify_segment_map elf32_arm_symbian_modify_segment_map
|
|
|
|
/* There is no .got section for BPABI objects, and hence no header. */
|
|
#undef elf_backend_got_header_size
|
|
#define elf_backend_got_header_size 0
|
|
|
|
/* Similarly, there is no .got.plt section. */
|
|
#undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
|
|
#define elf_backend_want_got_plt 0
|
|
|
|
#undef elf_backend_plt_sym_val
|
|
#define elf_backend_plt_sym_val elf32_arm_symbian_plt_sym_val
|
|
|
|
#undef elf_backend_may_use_rel_p
|
|
#define elf_backend_may_use_rel_p 1
|
|
#undef elf_backend_may_use_rela_p
|
|
#define elf_backend_may_use_rela_p 0
|
|
#undef elf_backend_default_use_rela_p
|
|
#define elf_backend_default_use_rela_p 0
|
|
#undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
|
|
#define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 0
|
|
#undef ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
|
|
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x8000
|
|
|
|
#include "elf32-target.h"
|